A Book For Ielts

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 220

Preface

This is a self-study publication with two audio-cassettes for students preparing for
the Academic Module of the International English Language Testing System
(IELTS), which is administered by The British Council, the University of Cambridge
Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES) and by IELTS Australia.
The book covers the four modules of the IELTS exam: listening, reading, writing and
speaking. Special features of the book are: the reading exercises, the detailed Keys
for these exercises, the wide range of exercises to help you prepare for Writing Task
1, and the detailed Key for the Reading Tests.
The publication may also be used as a course book, or as a supplement to a course
book.
So that you may repeat the exercises in this book, we would advise you to avoid
marking the text.
This new edition incorporates the changes to the speaking module introduced in
J uly 2001.
Sam McCarter, Jul i e Easton and Judi th Ash
2003
Contents
Page
Preface iii
Acknowledgements iv
Listening Module 1
Introduction 2
Listening Test 1 3
Listening Test 2 9
Listening Test 3 15
Listening Test 4 20
Reading Exercises 25
Introduction 26
1. How to read, or how to read efficiently? 28
2. Learning to read organisation 29
3. More about reading organisation 30
4. A summary of functions 31
5. Recognising paragraph types 32
6. Simultaneous functions 34
7. Reading control 35
8. Spot the difference! 36
9. Learning to concentrate 37
10. Predicting organisation 1 38
11. Predicting organisation 2 39
12. Focus on paragraph headings 40
13. Foreground and background information 42
14. Increasing your reading speed - 43
15. More about speed 45
16. Words that slow you down 47
17. Problems with meaning 48
18. An introduction to Yes 50
19. An introduction to No 51
20. Meaning in a text 52
21. Yes, No or Not Given 1? 53
22. Yes, No or Not Given 2? 54
Reading Tests
Test 1 56
Test 2 66
Test 3 75
Test 4 83
Section on Writing 91
Introduction 92
Graphs and diagrams for Task 1
1. Looking for patterns 94
2. Language graphs 98
3. Which chart? 100
v
4. A maze in graph form 102
5. Draw your own graph 103
6. Graph comprehension 104
7. Improving a text 105
8. The language of comparison and contrast 106
9. Graphs and charts combined 108
10. It is predicted that... 110
11. More comparison and contrast 112
12. More complex terms 114
13. Some common language mistakes 116
14. How many correct sentences are there? , 117
15. Questionnaire 1 ; - 118
16. Questionnaire 2 120
17. Tables 122
18. Map language and verb tenses 123
19. Process language 125
20. The process of making a newspaper 126
Essay writing for Task 2
21. Understanding essay titles 128
22. Plans for essays 130
23. Same general subject - different focus 132
24. A model essay 134
Writing Tests
Test 1 135
Test 2 136
Test 3 137
Section on Speaking 139
Introduction 140
1. Eliciting information 141
2. Example of extended discourse No.1 145
3. Example of extended discourse No.2 147
4. Your future plans 148
5. Put meaning into your future 149
Keys
Listening Tests 151
Reading Exercises 167
Reading Tests 179
Writing - Graphs and Diagrams 203
Writing - Essays 210
Writing-Tests 211
Speaking * 213
About the authors
Sam McCarter is a lecturer in academic and medical English at Southwark College,
where he organises IELTS courses for overseas doctors and other health personnel,
and courses in medical English - including preparation for the OSCE component of the
PLAB.
Sam is also the creator and organiser of the Nuffield Self-access Language Project for
Overseas Doctors and works as a freelance consultant in medical English specialising
in tropical medicine.
Jul i e Easton is a lecturer in academic and medical English at Southwark College,
teaching on courses preparing doctors for the IELTS and the OSCE. J ulie has
considerable experience in both areas.
Judith Ash is a former lecturer in academic and medical English at Southwark
College. She now writes freelance and is working on distance learning programmes for
IELTS.
About Southwark College
Southwark College has an international reputation as a centre for teaching IELTS and
medical English. The College is situated in the centre of London.
Telephone: 0207 815 1600 and Fax: 0207 261 1301.
Listening Module
I ntroduction
P ractice Tests I - 4
A book for IELTS
1
Listening Practice Tests
I ntroducti on to the Listening Modul e
In the IELTS exam, the Listening Test forms the first part of the exam and lasts for about 30 minutes.
In each test, there are four main sections, for which you have to answer a total of approximately 40 questions.
Each main section is divided into two and, sometimes, three sub-sections. Before each of these sub-sections,
you have time to read the questions and you are advised to write your answers in the question booklet. At
the end of each section, you have half a minute to check your answers.
At the end of the full listening test, you have 10 minutes to transfer your answers^to the Answer Sheet. Usually,
the listening exercises become more difficult as you move from Sections 1to 4.
You will hear the test onl y ONCE.
- A
The range of question types may include the following: ; 5
- multiple choice questions
- short-answer questions
- sentence completion
- summary/notes/flow chart/diagram/table completion
- labelling a diagram which has numbered parts
- matching
Situations
Answer sheet
The first two sections are usually of a social nature. Section 1usually contains a conversation, e.g.
between two people in a shop, and Section 2 a monologue, e.g. a radio broadcast or a talk. Section
3 is usually a conversation in an educational or training context, e.g. a tutorial about a particular
subject. In this section, there can be up to four speakers. Section 4 is a monologue, such as a
lecture or talk on a subject of general academic interest.
It is important to remember that the test is designed to test your listening comprehension skills. The
answers to all of the questions are on the tape. You do not need any knowledge of the topic to be
able to answer the questions.
After the end of the tape, ten minutes are given for you to transfer your answers to the Answer
Sheet.
Hints on listening Common problem areas with this part of the IELTS exam include the following:
Misreading
instructions
Changing
Anticipation/
prediction
Concentration
P ractice
It is important that you read all the instructions very carefully so that you are clear about what is
required for the answer to each of the questions. The instructions are usually clear and easy to
follow, and an example is given in some cases.
It is worth pointing out here that candidates often fail to read the instructions carefully or just glance
at them. Students rely on the fact that the instructions are exactly the same in the Test as they are
in the textbook(s) they have been practising with.
Sometimes, the speaker may give a piece of information and then change his or her mind. So
always watch out for this.
When you are speaking to people normally in your own language, it is possible to predict what the
person you are talking to is going to say. It is easier in this situation to do so, because you are part
of the conversation and know the context. When you are just listening, it is just a little harder,
because you are not actively involved in developing the context. However, you can do it with just
a little extra concentration.
*+
It is important to concentrate from the beginning. Some candidates think that the first section is
going to be easy and do not listen carefully enough. They miss a few answers which affects their
final score. If you are aiming for a high score, like a 7 or a 7.5 you should be aiming to answer all
the questions in the first two sections correctly, as they are the easiest.
If you do not have access to many IELTS textbooks to practise, use listening exercises from the
other Cambridge exams, e.g. for the First Certificate and the Cambridge Advanced. The listening
exercises are not the same but they give you similar practice. Also listen to the radio and watch
TV, and if possible speak to people in English.
2
A book for IELTS
P racti ce Tests
Listening
P ractice Test 1: Section 1
Complete the Account Details using NO MORE THAN TWO WORDS for each blank space.
Account Detail s
Example:
Account holder: No
Di scount offered.
Fi rst year students:
(1)
Name: Nasreen (2)
Address:
(3)
Compton Street, London.
Mansions,
Postcode: SE (4)
Telephone number: 0181 (5)
Questions 6- 8
Put a tick in the spaces below, if the information is correct. Or fill in the blank with the correct information, if
it is wrong. The first one has been done for you as an example.
Example ^ ______ 7_______________
Physics in the Age
of
Technology
Experimental
Science
A Stern
j29^50^>o
,_TOut Of
ly Stock
y
Simon Blair
& Vi ol et Boyd
6____________ 8.
S- = A' -- - /
Mathematics in Physics for the first
Physics year student
\ 27.95^> j 2<r ^ >
P rofessor I Lovatt A Laska
/
A book for IELTS
3
Listening
Practice Tests
Questions 9 & 10
Circle the appropriate letter.
9. To collect the books the student must bring
A three forms of identification.
B two forms of identification.
C one form of identification.
D two forms of identification and the university confirmation letter.
10. The books will be kept
A in the Chemistry Department in the basement.
B in the Physics Department in the baserrfent.
C in the Physics Department on the first floor.
D in the Maths Department in the basement.
4
A book for IELTS
P racti ce Tests
Listening
P ractice Test 1: Section 2
Circle the appropriate letter.
1 1 . There are_________
_________________ student counsellors at the university.
A six B four C five D three
12. The speaker has come to talk about the____________________ .
A Student Union B Student Welfare Service
C student health D Student Accommodation Service
13. The number of main sites is . . .
A three B four C five D six
14. Where on this site is the student
counsellors office?
Questions 15- 20
Complete the notes below using NO MORE THAN THREE WORDS for each answer.
15. The information leaflet is available almost____________________ .
16. The Helpline in the evenings and weekends is dependent on the____________
17. The Helpline is staffed at the weekends for____________________ .
18. Students contact the Student Welfare Service for a ___________________ .
19. If the counsellors cannot help you, they will put you in touch with____________
20. The Service gives____________________ to all volunteers on the Helpline.
A book for IELTS
5
Listening Practice Tests
P ractice Test 1: Section 3
Questions 21- 23
USE NO MORE THAN THREE WORDS to answer the following questions:
21. On what topic did J im write his essay? _____________________________________
22. Besides the OECD statistics, what other figures did J im use?
23. At the beginning of his essay, what does J im say the 19th century Luddites and people
today are worried about?
Questions 24 - 27
In J ims essay, there are 3 reasons for peopl es fears and 2 reasons why peopl es fears are unj ustified.
In each case below, choose the option which accurately describes the point. The first one is an example.
Example: The first reason for fear:
J a IT affects service and traditional industries
b Electricity affects service and traditional industries
24. The second reason for fear:
a The introduction of IT is more demanding than other technologies
b The introduction of IT is happening more quickly than for previous technologies
25. The third reason for fear:
a IT makes it easier to change jobs
b IT makes it easier for employers to move jobs around
26. The first reason why peoples fears are unjustified:
a There has been a continuous rise in people in work and income in rich countries
b Technological advance has industrialised rich countries
27. The second reason why peoples fears are unjustified:
a New jobs are not upsetting old ones
b New jobs are replacing old ones
6
A book for IELTS
P racti ce Tests
Listening
Quest i ons 28 30

Circle the appropriate letter.


2 8 . New technology does not always reduce employment, because
A people do not need to work as hard as before.
B new products are a necessity.
C it can create new demand.
D it can slow down output.
29. In his conclusion, Jim says that IT should not destroy jobs, if
A there is a balance.
B the workforce are favourable.
C the workforce are businessmen.
D the workforce have a good education and they are skilled.
30. The phrase, a favourable business climate, means an environment where
A there is not too much in the way of protectionism.
B there are many restrictions, rules and regulations.
C minimum wage levels are too high. *
D restrictions on work practices exist.
A book for IELTS
7
Listening
Practice Tests
P ractice Test 1: Section 4
Questions 31- 37
Complete the notes using NO MORE THAN THREE WORDS for your answer.
31. The speaker is a specialist in_____________________ .
32. The speaker is giving the_____________________of the term.
33. The focus of her talk is the purpose of____________________ .
34. Good design leads to_____________________ .
35. One facet of the role of design is to make sure that products do the job they are
36. People are persuaded to buy products by_________and__________________ .
37. A shopper may buy a personal stereo for its____________________as well as its trendy
appearance.
Questions 38- 4 1
Circle the appropriate letter.
38. The role of the designer is becoming more important, because ...
A the progress of technology is slightly faster than it was.
B there are possibilities for new ideas.
C products break more easily these days.
D every model has to be updated more quickly.
39. In the medical field, the designer is engaged in ...
A developing a range of new equipment.
B old equipment that is developing.
C everything related to hospital portering equipment.
D advising inventors.
40. Designers can help manufacturers by ...
A exporting their designs.
B helping to make their products attractive.
C making their products appreciated by other manufacturers.
D training them to appreciate design.
41. Design is important in life, because ...
A existing is more than living.
B it is part of our attitude.
C it improves the quality of our daily life.
D we do not want things that do not look good, even if they do not work.
8
A book for IELTS
Practice Tests
Listening
P ractice Test 2: Section 1
Circle the appropriate letter.
Example: Angela would like to order
A some chocolates. {(^some chocolates and some flowers.
B some flowers. D some sweets.
1. Which picture shows the kind of flowers Angela would like to order?
B
r
A book for IELTS
9
Listenihg
Practice Tests
2. Which box of chocolates does Angela order?
A
D
3. Angela would like to send
A a mixture of chocolates, mostly liqueurs.
B a box of liqueurs.
C a mixture of chocolates, mostly white chocolates and some liqueurs.
D a mixture of chocolates, mostly white, but no liqueurs.
4. The cost of delivering both items is
A 90 pence
B 38
C 19
D 9
10
A book for IELTS
P ractice Tests
Listening
Complete the following Order Form by USING NO MORE THAN THREE WORDS to complete each blank
space:
ORDER FORM
Name: Angel a Love
Address: 144a Orchard Heights
Marsh Dri ve
Edinburgh
Telephone number:
Credit card number:
Switch card number:
Sendees name:
Sendees address:
Message (if any):
Any other details:
0963 371 555
N/A_____
569 000(5)
Mrs (6)
27 (7) _
884 223 7
Cardi ff CA13 8YU
Congratulati ons on (8)______________________/
Just l et me know when you are out on the road. Love Angie
Deli very Date: (9)___________
(10) Deli ver between________ and ____________ i n the morning.
A book for IELTS
1 1
sterling
Practice Tests
P ractice Test 2: Section 2
Questions 11- 13
Circle the appropriate answer.
11. Information about the sports facilities can be found on
A billboards in parts of the campus.
B notice-boards throughout the campus.
The speaker is
A showing a map on a screen.
B talking about a map in a leaflet.
The university sports complex is
A in Burse Road.
B on the right of the police station.
12.
13.
C posters in the campus.
D maps all over the campus.
C referring to a diagram on a screen.
D talking about a map on the wall.
C in Thames Street.
D opposite the city library.
Questions 14 - 17
Tick the four other facilities below which are mentioned as future devel opments in the university sports
complex. One (C) has been marked for you as an example. Write your answers in Boxes 14-17 on your
answer sheet.
FACILITIES
A Two badminton courts
B Three squash courts
C A sauna (Example)
D A full-sized Olympic swimming pool
E A dance theatre____________
F A bar __________
G An ice-skating rink _
H A cafeteria ________
I Two courts for tennis
J A soft-ball court ___
K A modern gym ____
Questions 18- 20
Circle the correct letter.
18. Choose the correct location (A,B.C, or D)
for the sports ground on the map below.
Sports ground = A, B, C, or D?
19. The direct bus to the sports field is the
A 553 C 43
B 33 D 53
20. The last bus at night is
A around half past 12 in the morning.
B at 2.30 a.m.
C at 1.30 a.m.
D at midnight.
12
A book for IELTS
Practice Tests
Listening
P ractice Test 2: Section 3
Questi ons 21- 26
USING NO MORE THAN THREE WORDS for each space complete the details about
the FBT Award below.
FBT Award
The FBT Award gives students money to____ 21______ .
Conditi ons to be met:
Applicants have to:
be in their_____ 22 _____ year.
be a British or Commonwealth citizen.
be among the_____ 23_____ in their year in the final exams.
hand in the application by the_____24_____ .
be under_____ 25____ at the end of their course.
give the names of____ 26______ referees.
Questions 27- 30
Circle the appropriate answer.
27. The award Sandra is applying for is
A awarded twice a year.
B not as hard to get as the one Derek is after.
C not for as much money as the FBT Award.
0 much harder to obtain than the one Derek is after.
28. To apply for the Bisiker Award, students have to
A write a 5,000 word outline of their project and complete a detailed application form.
B write a 5,000 word outline of their project and complete a form with their details.
C fill in a short application form.
D write a 50,000 word outline of their project and fill in a form with their details.
29. The lecturer puts great emphasis on
A the need for the summary to be original.
B making five copies of the application.
C having it read through by someone before submitting it.
D studying previous applications.
30. The lecturer also lays great emphasis on the fact that
A the Bisiker Award is not much harder to get than the one Derek is after.
B the application should, if possible, be typed, neat and bound with a ring binder.
C there is no need to type the application.
D the application has to be typed, be very neat and bound with a ring binder.
A book for IELTS
13
Li st eni r
_________ '9
Practice Tests
P ractice Test 2: Section 4
i
Questions 31-36
Comp,|ete the |ecture notes below. Use NO MORE THAN THREE WORDS to complete each space.
Europe goes grey
refers to the _31
in Europe since the 60s.
P roj ecti ons
- by 2029 approximately_______32_______% of the UK population will be over retirement age.
- roughly 23% of the population of_______33_______will be 65 or over by 2020.
- the number of centenarians in the UK will be increasing by_______34_______percent per year
in the 21st century.
*
Reasons for increased life-span:
a. better diet
b. better housing
c. the_______ 35_______ of health care
The b)jrth rate in Europe has fallen as a consequence of:
a. _______ 36_______
b. education of women
c. more women working
Questi ons 37-40
Circle the correct letter.
37. The speaker says that the elderly
A generally need care.
B can be both happy and retired.
C vary in their situations and needs.
D worry about who will care for them.
38. Unlike in the past, today families
A dont care about their grandparents.
B tend to live in the same area.
C dont take care of grandparents.
D share the care of the elderly.
39. As regards the elderly, financial assistance is
needed to
A pay the wages of carers.
B help independent old people.
C create new medical services.
D increase the level of pensions.
>
40. The speaker suggests that in the future
A people should be helped to prepare
financially for their old age.
B existing houses of the elderly should be adapted.
C retirement ages should be increased.
D people should respect the elderly more.
14
A book for IELTS
P ractice Tests
Listening
P ractice Test 3: Section 1
Complete the questionnaire below using NO MORE THAN THREE WORDS for each space.
Questionnaire
Example
Year:____ 2nd
Subjects: Chinese and (1). Age: (2)_
Type of accommodation: flat off-campus ____
(Please tick) - flat on-campus * /
Name of block (if applicable): (3).
room on-campus
room off-campus
ACTI VI TI ES Number of times per month student takes part
D = 910 4= 1-2 B = 3-5 c=6- a
Write A, B, C, or D below
Sports
(4) B
Basketball (5)
Football c
Clubs
(6) A
Amateur dramatics
(7)
Questions 8- 10
Circle the appropriate letter.
8. How much of
his income
does the
student
spend on
socialising?
A
B
C
D
B
A book for IELTS
15
Listening
Practice Tests
9. How much of his income does the student spend on accommodation and food?
B
10. Apart from books, what does the student spend the rest of his money on?
A small luxuries like chocolate and cakes.
B lots of luxuries.
C food.
D small luxuries.
16
A book for IELTS
Practice Tests
Listening
P ractice Test 3: Section 2
Quest i ons 11- 13
Complete the notes below about the Hoverplane using NO MORE THAN THREE WORDS.
Hoverpl ane
The hoverplane will be able to travel at a maximum speed of____11____ per hour.
The craft is efficient, because it uses one____12__ of the normal fuel of a ferry.
The larger planned version will be able to carry____13_____ and freight at 300 kilometres an hour.
Questions 14 - 16
Answer the questions below according to the information you hear about a new computer-based police
communication system.
For each blank space use NO MORE THAN THREE WORDS.
P olice Communicati on System
14. What can a radio scanner warn a criminal about? _________________
15. With the new police system, what will take the place of most radio traffic?
16. What may be transmitted to police cars in future?
Questions 17- 20
According to the information you hear about chickens and electricity, complete the summary below. Use no
more than TWO WORDS to complete each blank space.
Chickens and Electricity
Dung is a _____ 17_____ of the chicken farm. A British firm has proved that the
answer to communities needs for electric power is profitable. So, at the moment,
it has_____ 18_____ stations in Britain, which are powered by dung, and other
European countries are showing interest.
In many countries,_____ 19_____ is a headache so the company is solving two
problems at one time, namely: burning dung to make much needed fertiliser and
producing cheap_____ 20_____ .
A book for IELTS
17
Listening
Practice Tests
P ractice Test 3: Section 3
t
Circle the appropriate answer.
21. Dave thinks the last tutorial
A was exciting and Sarah disagrees.
B was not exciting and Sarah disagrees.
C wasnt very interesting, but Sarah does.
D was good and Sarah feels she has to agree.
22. Sarah states that she understood
A a very small part of the tutorial.
B all of the tutorial.
C most of the tutorial, but parts of it were incomprehensible.
D none of the tutorial.
23. Sarah and Dave have just attended a tutorial on
A study skills for English Literature.
B reading in literature.
C writing in literature.
D general studies.
Questions 24 - 27
Listen and complete the table below with the appropriate numbers.
Sarah Dave Terry Arnold
Pages per hour 25/30 (24)__________ 120 (25)______
Books per week 1 (26)__________ (27)_______ 20
Questi ons 28- 30
Using NO MORE THAN THREE WORDS for each blank space, complete the sentences below.
Terry thinks it is important to develop ones reading speed to_____ (28)_____ .
Terry felt_____ (29)_____ after his first tutorial with Dr Pratt.
When Terry first arrived at university, his reading speed was_____ (30)______ pages
per hour.
Questions 21- 23
18
A book for IELTS
Practice Tests
Listening
P ractice Test 3: Section 4
Circle the correct letter.
31. What four qualities do actresses and actors need to survive?
A fear, determination, persistence and ability to accept a challenge.
B hunger, thirst, persistence and talent.
C hunger, determination, talent and persistence.
D anxiety, doggedness, talent and persistence.
32. The unemployment rate in the acting profession is
A around 70 percent.
B between 80 and 90 per cent.
C not mentioned in the lecture.
D over 90 per cent.
33. Actors, on average, work
A 10 weeks per year.
B 11 weeks per year.
C 7 weeks per year.
D 12 weeks per year.
*
34. Actresses, on average, work
A 14 weeks per year.
B 17 weeks per year.
C 7 weeks per year.
D 12 weeks per year.
Complete the lecture notes below. Use NO MORE THAN FOUR WORDS to complete each space.
Finding an agent Except in special circumstances, agents have to see actors or actresses in some
kind of .35.
For example, they can send a show-reel with their .36.
Equity Cards Getting work without an Equity Card is______37______.The main disadvantage of the new system
is that there are more people going for the_____38_____.
Photographs Photographs are essential and they have to be_____39_____, black and white and the size
of a_____40_____.
A book for IELTS
19
Listening
Practice Tests
P ractice Test 4 : Section 1
Circle^the correct answer.
1.
Example:
The student...
The final destination is
A Amman, J ordan.
B Ankara, Turkey.
A is Arabic.
B is studying Arabic.
C Alexandria, Egypt.
D Athens, Greece.
C is studying Hebrew and Arabic.
D is studying English and Arabic.
2. The student must reach his destination by
A 12th September. C 27th September.
B 31st August. D 20th September.
3. The student decides finally to leave on
A 21st August. C 20th September.
B 20th August. \ D 27th August.
4 . The student wants to go to Paris by
B
r<rv
+
D
20
A book for IELTS
Practics Tests Listening
5 . The student is afraid of
Questions 6- 9
. C
^_ _ T U N N EL _ ^
m V -
B
Tick the f o u r pieces of information below which give correct details about the rest of the journey.
Then write the answers A-H in Boxes 6-9 on your answer sheet.
A The student is planning to fly from Paris to Vienna. ___
B The student is planning to fly to Athens via Budapest from Vienna.
C The student has not sorted out his visa requirements. _____
D The Vienna leg of the journey will cost 142.80. _____
E The student will spend three days in Athens. _____
F The student wants to go from Piraeus to Alexandria by ferry. ____
G The student wants to fly from Piraeus to Alexandria. _______
H The student wants to travel to Vienna overnight. _____
Complete the blank space below.
10* The booking reference is _
A book for IELTS
21
Liste
Ding
Practice T ests
P ractice Test 4 : Section 2
QLiestions 11- 16
Complete the table below as you listen. Use either A NUMBER or NO MORE THAN THREE WORDS to
each space.
Number of participants in the survey 4373
Radio
South
Radio
Soap
New Wake- up
start time
The (15)
Approval
rating
(11) % 17% 87% 15%
Di sapproval
rating
(121 % 64% M3) % 25%
Dont knows Not mentioned 19% Not mentioned 60%
Li steners
comments
Excellent Vulgar
and puerile
(14)_______ L _
(16)
Questions 17- 20
Circle the correct answer.
17. Regarding the message Voicebox, the number of complaints
A has gone up and down in recent weeks. C has remained static.
B has gone down. D has risen in recent weeks.
18. The praise for the music on the Wake-up show has come
A only from Australia. C from all over South-east Asia.
B only from New Zealand. D from all over Asia.
19. Regarding English Worldwide, the number of listeners
A has increased ten times. C has decreased tenfold.
B has remained fairly static. D will increase in the future.
20. The radio station broadcasts
A 14 hours per day. C 24 hours per day.
B 19 hours per day. D 22 hours per day.
22
A book for IELTS
Practics Tests
Listening
P ractice Test 4 : Section 3
Quest i ons 21- 25
Circle the correct letter.
21. Regarding the tutorials, Lorraine ...
A finds them very useful.
B is hesitant about saying what she thinks.
C states that they are useless.
D thinks they could be improved.
22. Farilla...
A has two daughters who have been causing her trouble.
B is a single parent with a daughter in her teens.
C is an immature student.
D is a teenager.
23. Farilla feels that...
A her eldest daughter is to blame for the family problems.
B her youngest daughter is to blame for her family problems.
C her husband is to blame for her family problems
D her taking the course is the cause of her family problems.
24 . When he was 16, Stevie took on a job ...
A because he desperately needed the money.
B for no real reason.
C to help his mother out.
D to help his brother.
25. Dr Goldfinch suggests that Farilla should...
A get her daughters a job.
B speak to Stevies mum.
C give up the course.
D explain the situation to her daughters.
Questions 26- 30
Complete the notes below. Use NO MORE THAN THREE WORDS to complete each blank space.
Stevi es probl em
Stevie had to have his_____ 26_____ ready for Friday. However, his computer
_____ 27_____ and, unfortunately, he didnt have a copy on disk, but does have a
_____ 28_____ .
He has to get his OHPs ready; submit a ____29_____ to Dr J ohnson; and give in the full
paper after the seminar. If he doesnt do everything on time, he will lose_____ 30_____ .
A book for IELTS
23
Listening Practice Tests
P ractice Test 4 : Section 4
Questions 31- 33
I
Below is a list of steps (A-l), four of which the speaker took in her career. The first step is A. What are the
next three steps? Write your answers in the correct order in Boxes 31-33 on your answer sheet.
Career steps
A took an MA in music.
D followed a course in
journalism.
G a music critic on a national
newspaper on a retainer.
Questions 34 - 36
The speaker mentions four disadvantages to being a music critic. One has been marked for you. Tick the
other three disadvantages. Write your answers in Boxes 34-36 on your answer sheet.
Di sadvantages
A being pestered by the concert-goers while working
B being bothered by enthusiastic accountants
C the loneliness
D having to deal with people on the telephone
E the low pay
F being glamorous
G meeting uninteresting people
H writing reviews of concerts within tight time limits
Question 37
Circle the correct letter.
37. As regards travelling, the speaker...
A enjoys it a little.
B goes abroad ten times a year.
C visits other European countries at least ten times a year.
D goes to Iceland regularly.
Questions 38- 4 0
Using NO MORE THAN THREE WORDS for each space, complete the blanks below.
38. Michael Ignatieffs TV series dealt with the__________ .
39. The critics job is to foster the talent of___________ .
4 0. As people are so unsure of themselves, what a critic says can act as an objective
B worked as a proof-reader. C was a freelance features writer.
E entered the editorial field. F became a full-time
music critic
H became a part-time I became a sub-editor for an
music critic. educational publication.
24
A book for IELTS
A book for IELTS
25
Reading
Exercises 1 to 22
I NTRODUCTI ON
The Reading Test in IELTS lasts for 60 minutes.
There are three reading passages, which may include pictures, graphs, tables or diagrams. The reading
passages are of different length, from approximately 500 to 1,000 words. The total for the three passages is
between 1,500 and 2,500. Each reading passage has several different types of questions, which may be
printed either before or after the passage. Often the texts and the questions become more difficult as you
read from Passage 1to 3.
Question type
You may have to answer any of the following question types:
- multiple choice questions
- gap-filling exercises
- matching paragraph headings with paragraphs in the Reading Passage
- matching the two parts of split sentences
- short answers to open questions
- Yes/No/Not Given statements
- the completion of - sentences
- summaries
- diagrams
- tables
- flow charts
- notes
P roblems
Candidates have a number of problems with this part of the IELTS exam, which may include the following:
Misreading i nstructi ons
It is important that you read all the instructions very carefully so that you are clear about what is required for
the answer to each of the questions. The instructions are usually clear and easy to follow, and, in some cases,
there is an example.
Candidates think that the instructions will be exactly the same as the textbook or other material they have
been using to prepare for the exam. This may not always be the case, so make sure you read the instructions
carefully in the exam itself.
Ti ming
Candidates often achieve a lower score than expected in this component of the IELTS exam, because they
spend too much time on some sections and do not finish the test. It is very important to attempt to finish the
test. You will not have time to read and enjoy the passages; instead, you should learn to work out what the
question you are doing requires and find each answer as quickly as possible.
Candidates often find it difficult to leave a question that they cannot answer. This is understandable, but in
the IELTS it is disastrous. While you are not answering a difficult question you could be answering two or
three, or even more, easier ones. Then you can come back to those you have left blank afterwards.
26
A book for IELTS
Exercises 1to 22
Reading
Topi cs
The reading passage topics vary, but are all of an academic nature. Candidates sometimes panic when they
are faced with a reading passage on a subject about which they know nothing at all. It is important to
remember that the answers to all of the questions are in the text itself. You do not need any specialist
knowledge of the topic to be able to answer the questions. The test is designed to test your reading
comprehension skills, not your knowledge of any particular subject.
Answer s h eet s
You must complete the answer sheet within 60 minutes. You will not have extra time to transfer your answers
from the question paper to your answer sheet. Candidates often think that, because they have time to transfer
their answers in the listening section, the same thing happens in the reading section. It doesnt.
Students often ask what is the best way to read for the exam.
Below are some hints about what you can do.
Read as widely as you can, e.g. newspapers, journals, specialist magazines and so on. if you are
preparing for a particular academic subject at university e.g. law, medicine, engineering, you should
make sure that you develop the skills of reading with speed outside your subject area.
As you read, look for patterns in the organisation of the texts. The different types of paragraphs are
finite, but their arrangement can make them appear infinite in variety. See Reading Exercises 5,12
and 13.
When you are reading, try to train yourself to read to understand the meaning of the passage rather than
just reading the words. See Reading Exercises 1- 11.
As you read, always practise predicting what you are about to read.
See Reading Exercises 10 and 11.
As you read generally, try to summarise a paragraph by giving it a brief heading. This will then come to
you automatically with practice. See Reading Exercises 12 and 13.
Learn to increase your speed while still reading the organisation and meaning of a passage. See
Reading Exercises 14 - 16.
Students often focus on words they do not know. This is dangerous in the exam, as it wastes time. You
have to learn to let go and look at the overall meaning. See Reading Exercise 16.
Spend a specific period each day reading.
Dont try to focus on all of the above at one time. Even focusing on one for a short period of time each
day is tiring.
A book for IELTS
27
Reading Exercises 1 to 22
Exer ci se 1: How to read, or how to read effi ci entl y?
When people are taught to read, generally speaking, they learn to read wo r d s . To read efficiently, however,
you ajso need to read at another level: you need to be able to read meaning, an d organisation in a text. As
the reading section of the IELTS exam primarily tests your understanding of meaning and your ability to find
your way around a text, it is, therefore, not enough just to be capable of reading words alone.
This Exercise helps you to begin developing different strategies to read a text fast and efficiently. The exercise
looks at the organisation in a paragraph. Read the paragraph below s l o wl y , and then answer the questions
which follow.
The building, completed in l 785, was erected by the enigmatic
Frederick Hervey, Earl of Bristol and Bishop of Derry, in honour of Mrs
Mussenden, the Earl's cousin. The Earl Bishop used the folly, which
became known as the Mussenden Temple, as a library. Standing
dangerously on the edge of a sheer drop into the North Sea, the temple
dominates the coastline to the West. The structure's classical simplicity,
with its dome and Corinthian columns, is in stark contrast to the
haunting Celtic landscape.
1. There are four sentences in the text. Which sentences give you the information below?
A The function of the building.
B The physical structure of the library.
C The location of the building.
D The history of the building.
2. None of the phrases in number 1above can be used as titles for the paragraph. Why?
3. The author wrote the paragraph ...
A to describe the Mussenden Temple.
B to describe the Celtic landscape.
C to express his opinion of the madness of Frederick Hervey.
D to describe the function of the library.
4. The writer uses a series of synonyms in the paragraph. Which words are they?
5. What is the purpose of these words?
6. What type of paragraph is it?
A Is it argumentative?
B Is it a cause and effect paragraph?
C Does it express an opinion?
D Is it descriptive?
7. Below is a list of titles. Which is the most appropriate title for the paragraph?
A The enigmatic Frederick Hervey.
B The mystery of the Celtic landscape.
C The Mussenden Temple.
D The classicism of Frederick Herveys folly.
8. What is the relationship between the first sentence and the second?
9. What is the relationship between the third sentence and the fourth?
28
A book for IELTS
Exercises 1 to 22
Reading
10. There is a division in the text. Where does it occur?
1 1. What is the relationship between the two parts of text on either side of the division?
12. Look at the following sentence:
The building, erected by the enigmatic Frederick Hervey, Earl of Bristol and Bishop of Derry,
in honour of Mrs Mussenden, the Earls cousin, was completed in 1785.
Compare this with the first sentence in the paragraph above.
What has happened to the information in the sentence?
What is the main information in the sentence above?
Exercise 2: Learning to read organisation
You can see from the previous exercise that to read a text effectively, you need to be able to read organisation.
You need, therefore, to learn to see a text in a different way.
In the passage below, there are 105 words. Each of the words has a meaning. These words and meanings
are then divided into five sentences. Each sentence has, in turn, a specific meaning, which comes from the
sum of the words in the sentence. This meaning is different from the sum of the individual parts, i.e. the words
of each sentence. Take the following sentence, for example:
Museums and art galleries should be free of charge to the general public.
If you add all the words together (13 words), the total is a proposal or suggestion about the issue of charges
for museums or art galleries. You can see that when you put the words together you get something different:
meaning at another level. And not just one meaning! The sentence does, in fact, have other meanings, but
you will see that later (see Reading Exerci ses 5- 8).
Another way of looking at the sentence is that the words proposal and suggestion are summaries of the
sentence. If you then add up the meanings of the sentences in a paragraph, you will have a different level of
meaning. In other words, the sum of the meaning of the sentences, can help you work out the title of a
paragraph.
Obviously, therefore, it is more economical to be able to read the organisation of the meaning of a paragraph
and dip into sentences, where necessary. Individual words then become much less important. This exercise
develops further the basic techniques about organisation that you learnt in the previous exercise.
Read the statements below and study the paragraph which follows. Decide which statements about the
paragraph are t rue or fal se.
a the paragraph talks about drivers and their opinions,
b the paragraph has no focus sentence.
c the paragraph contains three examples which illustrate drivers high opinion of themselves,
d the second sentence is a transition sentence.
e you could remove the second sentence and put For exampl e, at the beginning of sentence 3.
f the basic organisation in this paragraph is: problem/solution.
g the paragraph needs more text markers like then, i ndeed etc
h the author wrote the paragraph to show what happens when drivers are
arrogant about their driving abilities.
i a suitable title is: Dri ver arrogance and t he consequences.
A book for IELTS
29
Reading Exercises 1 to 22
Drivers often have an over-inflated opinion of their own driving abilities
and think that most other people on the road fall well below their own
high standards. Some even take it upon themselves to show their fellow
road users how to drive. Car drivers commonly treat the road as a
stage where they show other motorists how skilful they are by
out-manoeuvring them. Another frequent sight on the road is an irate
man hanging out of the window of his car instructing another driver
on the art of road-craft. A similar situation is the football stadium full
of referees, yelling instructions at the man in black.
Exercise 3: More about reading organisation
This exercise gives you more practice in reading organisation. Read the following paragraph as quickly as
you can:
For many people, all the frustrations they face in their daily lives are
relieved on the battlefields of the road. The cashier in the bank, or at
the post-office, is also frequently the object of vented anger. And how
often do we read in the newspaper dramatic stories about trolley rage
in the supermarket, phone rage, air rage and so on? Admittedly, we
do have the tendency to take out our pent-up emotions on others. But,
surely, a better way to deal with these situations would be simply
learning how to control our feelings.
Now decide which of the statements about the paragraph are true or false:
a the first sentence gives the focus or topic of the paragraph,
b the purpose of the paragraph is to show how people relieve their frustrations,
c the structure of the paragraph is as follows:
Specific Specific Specific General Opinion
example example example statement
\ \ __ ________
1
Concession Contrast
d the fourth sentence is a generalisation or general statement, which acts as a summary
of the examples in the previous three sentences.
e the fifth sentence is judgmental.
f this is a l i st or and paragraph.
30
A book for IELTS
Exercises 1to 22
Reading
g All of the following are suitable titles for the paragraph:
(i) Relieving frustration
(ii) The best way to relieve frustration
(iii) The best way to deal with emotion in fraught situations
(iv) Dealing with frustration
Exer ci se 4: A summary of functions
You saw in Exercise 2 that it is possible to summarise a sentence in a paragraph by giving it a name. These
summaries then help you to read more efficiently as you are learning automatically to summarise sentences,
and then larger chunks of text, i.e. paragraphs.
In this exercise, you are going to identify the meaning of sentences and paragraphs.
Baboons in trees
(i) Let us use a tree as a vehicle for our explanation, where the tree
represents the way of thinking, (ii) Some thinkers, content to stick to
the mainstream, stay on the trunk of the tree, while others with a bit
more daring move out onto the sturdier boughs, (iii) The reckless few,
not satisfied with sitting complacently on the branches, have to move
out to the flimsier twigs and branches, (iv) These are the radical
thinkers, the iconoclasts, the people who do not fit in. (v) However,
they are not the dangerous ones, (vi) Beware the truly menacing type
of thinker: the predator who sits like a baboon on the stronger
branches, waiting for the twigs to thicken and become stronger, (vii)
Once the way has been prepared, it is the baboons who move in,
taking credit for and stealing the ideas of those who dare.
1. There are seven sentences in the text above. Below, there is a List of Functi ons (A- M).
Decide which function is suitable for each sentence and why. Some of the functions do not
describe any of the sentences.
For example, for Sentence i, the answer is G.
Li st of Functi ons
A giving another example H a contrast
B making a proposal 1 giving an advantage
C giving a solution J making a criticism
D stating a consequence K giving a fuller explanation of the
E drawing a conclusion; a development of previous example
the previous sentence L giving examples; an expansion
F stating a cause of the focus sentence
G a focus or topic sentence/statement M a warning; an example
A book for IELTS
31
Reading Exercises 1to 22
2- Which one of the banks of functions (A- D) below relates to the text above?
A focus sentence B.
A focus sentence
Example 1 Solution 1
Example 2 Solution 2
Explanation An expansion
Example 3 A contrast
A warning A warning
Explanation/Conclusion Conclusion
A focus sentence D. A focus sentence
Consequence 1 Cause 1
Consequence 2 Cause 2
An expansion An expansion
A contrast A contrast
A warning A warning
Conclusion Conclusion
3. What type of paragraph is it?
4 . Is the text an and paragraph?
5. Which, if any, of the texts in the previous exercises is it similar to?
6. Would it have been better to put a few more markers, e.g. for example, moreover,
in the paragraph?
7. Where does the writer take the title from and why is it a good title?
Exercise 5: Recognising paragraph types
It is possible after some practice to recognise different types of paragraph. You have already looked at three
types, perhaps without realising it, in the previous exercises: a description, cause and effect, etc.. This
exercise gives you some more specific practice.
If you feel, at this stage, that your reading is slowing down rather than becoming faster, then that is a good
sign. It means that you are trying to absorb a new mechanism. If necessary, leave the exercises and repeat
them again, another time.
Alternatively, use the Key to help you complete the parts of the exercises you cannot do. The main thing is
that you learn to acquire the mechanism rather than just learning words. This applies to all the exercises.
Read P aragraph 1 below and decide which of following statements about the paragraph are false.
a The author wrote the paragraph to show the effects of too many data on peoples ability to work,
b The paragraph is purely descriptive.
c The author wrote the paragraph to give examples of the different types of data that people receive,
d The sentence, The repercussions are grave, is not a transition sentence in the paragraph,
e The text is basically a list paragraph.
f The writer has organised the paragraph around the principle of cause and effect,
g The sentence, The repercussions are grave, acts as a divider between the two parts of the text,
h The third sentence gives the focus of the paragraph.
i The last sentence is a conclusion of the information in the first three sentences,
j Only one of the following titles is suitable: Overwhelmed by data; The effects of too much
information; Increasing amounts of data.
32
A book for IELTS
Exerci ses 1to 22
Reading
P aragraph 1
Daily, people are being bombarded with a mountain of facts and
figures. At one time, it was possible to cope with the influx of
information. Now, office workers find themselves assailed not just by
written information, but also by ever increasing volumes of data
through the Internet, electronic mail, voice boxes and the answering
machine. The repercussions are grave. People feel so overwhelmed
that they are unable to work normally, with the upshot being that they
feel helpless and find it impossible to extract the information needed
from the constant flood of detail.
Read the paragraph below as qui ckl y as you can.
P aragraph 2
The relationship between success and failure is more intricate than
people generally realise. Failure is seen as something that should be
avoided. It is frowned upon and reviled; so much so, in fact, that we
all avoid doing certain things, if we are afraid of failing. Instead, people
should be taught the value of failure and how to use it as a stepping
stone to success. We buy a classic novel or the latest best-seller and
we are not told how many times the author was refused before the
book came into print. Likewise, we are not told how many auditions
an actor went to before he or she became a star. More emphasis
obviously needs to be laid upon the necessity to fail in order to achieve
success!
Now answer the foll owing questi ons about the paragraph, as qui ckl y as you can:
a What type of paragraph is it? Is it a cause and effect paragraph? An explanation?
A description? Or is it a general/specific paragraph?
b Is it a paragraph which contains a list of information, i.e. is it an and paragraph?
c Where is the focus of the paragraph?
d Is it similar to the text in Exercise 1, 2 or 3?
e Which sentence shows why the writer wrote the paragraph?
f Which of the questions below does the paragraph answer?
(i) What is failure?
(ii) What makes people happy?
(iii) How are failure and success linked?
(iv) What effect does success have on people?
g Which, if any, of the titles below is acceptable?
(i) Failure as a learning process
(ii) Making society a happier place
(iii) The need to avoid failure
(iv) Failure as a route to success
A book for IELTS
33
Reading Exercises 1to 22
Exer ci se 6: Simultaneous functions
This exercise takes the idea in Exercise 5 a step further. Students often do not realise that meaning and
organisation also operate at different levels at the same time. In this exercise, you are going to look at this
idea. Read the paragraph below and then the Lists of Functions. Decide which list of functions best
describes ach sentence. Two of the lists do not relate to any of the sentences.
If you have to look at the Key to help you complete the exercise, then leave it and try to do it another time.
Example: The answer for Sentence 1is C. For an explanation look at the Key.
The teachi ng of thi nki ng
(1) If you are of the opinion that reading, writing and numeracy are
taught badly, then what about the art of thinking? (2) Generally
speaking, people are not taught how to think at all. (3) There is a very
laisser faire, non-interventionist approach to education that
encourages students to discover things for themselves, when they are
all crying out for some prescriptive guidance. (4) What appears to have
escaped the theorists is the basic concept of the need to learn rules in
order to break them. (5) When it comes to thinking, no guidelines are
given; students are either just taught facts or left to fend for themselves.
(6) If only a little thought were given to teaching young people some
mechanisms for thinking: the 'how' ratherthan the 'what'! (7) Children
would then be able to absorb and use knowledge better. (8) For it is
not knowledge itself that bestows power, but the ability to process and
manipulate knowledge: in other words, being able to think.
Lists of functions
A reformulation of the central problem; making a criticism; stating a reason
B returning to the focus of the paragraph; stating a specific problem; a criticism; an opinion
C a topic sentence; an organising sentence; posing a question
D a conclusion; a general statement
E describing the present situation; giving background information; stating a general problem;
an explanation; a reformulation of the previous sentence
F a hypothetical result; a certain result; a development
G a strong recommendation; a conclusion
H a wish; a regret; a solution; sarcasm; a complaint; a criticism; giving a solution; a proposal
I an advantage
J giving a reply describing the present situation; giving background information; a contrast
34
A book for IELTS
Exerci ses 1to 22
Reading
Exerci se 7: Reading control
Reading and, at the same time, keeping the understanding of a text under control is difficult, especially if you
have to do it in another language. As you read, you have to deal with words and the sum of the words:
meaning. Unfortunately, the words often interfere with the meaning, because you cannot climb on top of them
to look down at the text from above. If you can overcome this problem, you can read the organisation of a
text, and control your interpretation. It will then be possible to follow the meaning without your concentration
wandering. This exercise will help you to start doing this.
Read the paragraph below and then read the Lists of functions describing each sentence. Some of the
functions in each list are not suitable. Decide which ones are not sui tabl e and why.
The first one has been done for you as an example.
A case f or t rol l ey buses and trams
(1) Not that long ago, trolley buses and trams were being condemned
as rather out-moded forms of transport. (2) Yet, now they are being
hailed as the answer to the ills afflicting modern transport systems. (3)
A vast swathe of South London from Tooting on the Northern Line to
Croydon is being linked by a new tram system. (4) Motorists do not
like it, because the roads are in the process of being churned up in
preparation for the tramlines. (5) When the trams are finally up and
running, private car owners say the system will lead to more one-way
systems, further hindering freedom of movement and increasing the
congestion that they were designed to overcome. (6) These points
certainly present a strong argument against the tram system. (7)
Nonetheless, provided the system is as efficient and cheap to use as
planned, many people feel the service will be a resounding success.
Lists of functions
Example: The items below in bold italics in No. 1are wrong.
1. stating a disadvantage; stating the main argument against; stating the focus of the
paragraph, giving general background information
2. stating an advantage; stating the main argument for; making a general statement; stating
a contrast; stating the focus of the paragraph; making a criticism
3. giving an example; giving general background information; stating an argument for;
making a proposal
4. stating an argument against; stating a reservation; stating a result; giving a reason
against; stating a disadvantage
5. stating a subjective argument against; giving an opinion; stating a reservation; stating
an objective argument against; stating a result or implication
6. summarising the arguments against; summarising the disadvantages; stating an opinion
7. restating the focus of the paragraph; a contrast; stating an argument for; stating an
opinion; stating a tentative result based on a condition; drawing a conclusion
A book for IELTS
35
Reading
Exercises 1 to 22
Exercise 8: Spot the difference
When you are reading a text about a particular subject, it is often difficult to see what the difference is between
the contents of different paragraphs. There are basically two reasons for this. First of all, it may be difficult
to see the difference between the general subject and the focus in each paragraph. The second problem is
trying to read a text with concentration and prevent ones mind from wandering from the focus of the paragraph
to related ideas in ones head. This can lead to misinterpretation. When we are writing, we often find it difficult
to focus on the title we have been asked to write about. A similar problem arises in reading.
In this exercise, you are going to analyse the organisation of two very similar paragraphs. Each has the same
general subject and most of the information is the same. However, the paragraphs have different meanings
and foci.
Read P assage 1 below and then from the Function bank after the passage decide which
functions best describe each sentence in the paragraph. Note that each sentence may have
more than one function. You may use some items from the bank more than once.
Then read P assage 2 and compare the organisation of the text at paragraph level.
Decide what the similarities and differences are.
If you need to, read the Key to help you do the exercise,
then leave the exercise for a while and come back to it later.
P assage 1
(1) The government recently invited the water industry and interested
parties to make suggestions about how to save water. (2) Debatable
though it is, one of the most common ideas put forward was to meter
all homes in the country. (3) Many people feel that installing water
meters nationwide would turn out to be expensive. (4) However, the
longer the delay in doing so, the greater the cost is likely to be, both
in terms of water wasted and money. (5) Metering would, in all
probability, be the single most important step, simply because it would
make people aware of the amount of water they are using, thereby
reducing consumption. (6) To many people, this course of action lets
water companies off the hook and transfers responsibility to the
consumer. (7) Yet, most are of the opinion that nationwide metering
needs to be introduced.
Functi on bank
giving a reason; a contrast; stating a probability; an objective conclusion;
a hypothetical implication; stating/describing a suggestion; making a suggestion;
a result; a reservation; a development; a focus sentence; a subjective conclusion;
an organising sentence; a real implication; expressing an opinion; stating a fact.
36
A book for IELTS
Exerci ses 1 to 22
Reading
P assage 2
(1) The government recently invited the water industry and interested
parties to state how they thought water could be saved. (2)
Controversial though it is, one of the most common recommendations
the government should initiate is to meter all homes in the country. (3)
Installing water meters nationwide is, no doubt, an expensive
proposition. (4) However, the longer the delay in doing so, the greater
the cost will be, both in terms of water wasted and money. (5) Metering
is the single most important step, simply because it will certainly make
people aware of the amount of water they are using, thereby reducing
consumption. (6) People may be dismissive of this course of action.
(7) Yet, I feel that it ought to be taken.
Exercise 9: Learning to concentrate
One of the greatest problems that you will face as you do the reading texts in IELTS is holding different bits
of information in your head at the same time. The reading tests are in booklet form and you have to flick back
and forward between the exercise and the text. Often, students forget the information they are looking at as
they move between the two. All you have to do is listen to the volume of the rustling of paper as students do
a test to see how difficult they find it!
It is, therefore, more economical for you to learn to hold and manipulate information as you read. This is
another aspect of controlling a text.
This exercise helps you to do just that. It also helps you:
to read and to predict the text which follows.
to predict the direction of a text.
and to see how a text matches a title.
Read the following three titles:
(i) Clonings bright future
(ii) The unacceptable face of cloning
(iii) The dangers of cloning
Now look at the reading maze below. At each number, choose the text which develops the meaning of title
(i). Then repeat the process for each title.
For example, the first sentence for (i) is 1C and the second is 2B.
1. Cloning is such an emotive
subject that it is impossible to
approach the matter with an
open mind.
B
The few obvious benefits of human
cloning apart, there is a downside
to the cloning of human beings.
There is no denying that
mankind will profit
considerably from the
cloning of human beings.
A book for IELTS
37
Reading Exercises 1to 22
A
2. Is it, perhaps, the fact that
people are created without
parents that horrifies many
of us?
3. For example, parents may
want to have a child with above
average intelligence, who is
physically perfect and free
from disease.
4 . Certain disease traits that
may be removed from the
human gene pool could some
time in the future be necessary
in our fight against illness.
5. To those who do not believe
in an active God, cloning
violates nature.
6. And the agony that most, if
not all, childless couples are
now forced to endure would be
swept away for ever.
7. What will happen to those
babies who are not sold? Will
they be used for spareparts,
or killed?
8. No doubt, such a prospect
will horrify some, but it will be
a delight to most people.
B
The process gives us the
opportunity to maximise
certain valued human traits.
Many of us find the process
totally unpalatable for several
reasons.
By cloning persons with these
characteristics, the future infant
would be guaranteed to possess
them.
Conversely, the very characteristics
that are now highly desirable
may turn out to be harmful and
dangerous for coming generations.
Or is it perhaps the vision of
batteries of babies being
produced in some factory that
arouses our horror?
The thought of human beings
produced in such farms like
chickens for spare-parts is
not that far-fetched.
Thus, the way will be paved
for the rather dangerous
prospect of a race of perfectly
modelled human beings.
C
The process is unquestionably
a landmark in the development
of science, but it is not
the panacea to the worlds ills,
as some scientists would
have us believe.
Cloning threatens the very
survival of the human species.
The general belief is that an
infant who has not been created
by human sexual congress is a
violation of Gods will and will
not have a divine soul.
Which parent will want to deny
their future off-spring such
an inheritance?
Moreover, babies with a
sell-by-date may well in future
be bought in shops much as
pets are today.
There is also the strong
possibility that we shall be
able to create a race of
humans free from all disease
and handicap.
Identical twins are clones, but
we have not heard of twins
being used as an organ
bank for their siblings, yet.
Exercise 10: Predicting organisation 1
As you have seen briefly in the previous exercise, once you are familiar with the organisation of a paragraph,
it is possible to predict the direction of other paragraphs and texts that you read. This is because there is a
limit to the different types of paragraph. If you look at other areas of language, you can see that this happens
all the time. How often, in your own language, can you predict what someone is going to say? Sometimes,
you can even give the exact words. Predicting when you come to reading is no different.
In this exercise, you are going to try to predict the contents of a paragraph.
To help you, look at the following information:
the paragraph is an example paragraph.
the fourth sentence contains the focus.
the first three sentences are general information which make up an introduction.
38
A book for IELTS
Exerci ses 1 to 22
Reading
Now read the first four sentences of the passage:
try to predict what you think the function and content of the rest of the sentences are,
after the focus sentence. Think of common examples.
write your list on a piece of paper.
read the text and compare your list with the text.
Life at a fast er pace
I blame the fast forward button on the video recorder. How often have
you found yourself reaching for the remote control when you find a
programme slow or boring? Frequently? Life has to be lived at a much
faster pace nowadays. Microwaves enable meals to be prepared in
minutes. Computers allow work to be done at a quicker rate than even
a few years ago. So much faster, in fact, that people feel that they will
be left behind unless they quicken up. People hurtle along on ever
faster forms of transport. Planes carry people across the world in ever
shorter times. Trains speed along like rockets through the countryside.
We have to do everything and get there much more quickly than ever
before. No part of our lives is free from the drive to get things done
more quickly.
Exerci se 11: Predicting organisation 2
This exercise is the same as the previous one.
In this exercise, you are going to try to predict the contents of a paragraph.
To help you, look at the following information:
the paragraph is a result paragraph predicting the negative consequences of
introducing trams and trolley buses.
the paragraph in this exercise uses the same information in Exercise 7, but
the paragraph takes a different direction. Go back and read the text.
read the title to help you work out the direction of the passage.
Without reading the passage:
try to predict what you think the function and contents of the paragraph are.
write your list on a piece of paper.
read the text and compare your list with the text.
A book for IELTS
39
Reading Exercises 1 to 22
No to t rol l ey buses and trams!
Trolley buses and trams, rather out-moded forms of transport, are
mistakenly being hailed as the answer to the ills afflicting modern
transport systems. A vast swathe of South London from Tooting on the
Northern Line to Croydon is being churned up to build a new tram
system. Motorists obviously don't like it, because the roads are in the
process of being ripped up in preparation for the tramlines being laid.
When the trams are finally up and running, most people will be against
the idea, because the system will lead to more one-way systems, thus
hindering their freedom of movement and most certainly increasing
the congestion that it was designed to get rid of. Then, when the
problems start arising, they will have to start dismantling the whole
network again at great inconvenience to the motoring public!
Exercise 12: Focus on paragraph headings
Students find the exercise where they have to give a heading to a paragraph in the IELTS exam particularly
difficult. However, you have already had some practice at analysing paragraph headings. Perhaps, you can
see that there is a relationship between paragraph structure and the heading of a paragraph. In some cases,
this may be overt, i.e. obvious, but, in many instances, it may be covert, i.e. hidden.
Below, there are five independent paragraphs and a List of headings. Read the paragraphs as quickly as
you can. As you read, try to find the main focus and then the direction of the paragraph. Try also to write a
suitable title of your own on a separate piece of paper. Then look at the List of headings at the end of the
exercise and find the correct heading for each paragraph. Note that some of the alternatives are distracters.
1. P aragraph headi ng: ___________________
The segregation of boys and girls at secondary school level only stores up problems for the
future. First of all, such an environment does not provide young people of both sexes with
realistic preparation for the society in which they will be expected to function when they become
adults. In single sex schools, it is not uncommon for both girls and boys to grow up with
misconceptions about the opposite sex; for the former, there is the romantic Mills and Boon
hero, and the notion of the alluring goddess for the latter. And, thirdly, young people who are
brought up in single sex schools have difficulty functioning socially with members of the
opposite sex.
2. P aragraph headi ng: ___________________
Some people mistakenly believe rather strongly that segregating girls and boys at secondary
school level is unnatural. Their argument is that such an environment does not provide young
people of both sexes with realistic preparation for the society in which they will be expected to
function when they become adults. However, speaking from the point of view of someone who
has had to undergo the trials of a non-segregated school, I feel, single sex schools, are much
better for girls. It has been demonstrated time and time again that girls at secondary level
flourish in surroundings where they are not held back academically by an army of pestering,
immature boys.
40
A book for IELTS
Exerci ses 1 to 22
Reading
3. P ar agr aph h ea d i n g : _______________________
The segregation of boys and girls at secondary school level is not exactly natural, as such an
environment does not provide young people of both sexes with realistic preparation for the
society in which they will be expected to function when they become adults. In single sex
schools, it is not uncommon for both girls and boys to grow up with misconceptions about the
opposite sex; for the former, there is the romantic Mills and Boon hero, and the notion of the
alluring goddess for the latter. By contrast, in a co-educational setting, there is not the slightest
possibility that such illusions will survive.
4 . P ar agr ap h h ead i n g : _______________________
Change causes problems, not least because it upsets peoples routine and makes them feel
uneasy. A good example is the introduction of technology in the workplace. The Luddite in all of
us comes out as we are faced with adapting to the onslaught of technological change at work. In
the early 19th century, the Luddites revolted against the introduction of what was new
technology in their time by breaking machinery which replaced workers. The pace of change
today is much faster, and thereby more unsettling. Thousands of workers in factories have been
replaced by computers and robots; now voice recognition programmes threaten to replace
secretaries; computerised switchboards receptionists and computer video packages instructors
and teachers. What area of life is safe from the advance of machines?
5. P aragraph headi ng: ___________________
Change causes problems, but the belief that it destroys peoples jobs and lives is totally
unfounded. The Luddite in all of us comes out as we are faced with adapting to the onslaught of
technological change at work. In the early 19th century, the Luddites revolted against the
introduction of what was new technology in their time by breaking machinery which replaced
workers. The pace of change today is much faster, which can be unsettling. However, it is now
clear that, far from destroying work, thousands of jobs have been created in factories as the
power of technological change is harnessed. Witness the development of silicon valleys
throughout the world. The fear that robots and computers will replace people in all areas is
clearly a myth.
List of headings
A A 19th Century revolt
B No reason to fear technology
C The unsettling effect of change
D Machines v. factory workers
E Various effects of segregation
F The main argument against segregation
G Attacking the Luddites
H Teenagers notions about sex
I A modern copy of the Luddites
J A passionate defence of modernisation
K The need for segregation
L The creation of distorted ideas about sex
M Dysfunctional behaviour in girls
A book for IELTS
4 1
Reading Exercises 1to 22
Exercise 13: Foreground and background information
You saw in the previous exercise that working out the heading of a paragraph is basically about organisation.
You need to be able to see the thread of information going through the text connecting the information to a
heading.
Most people think of analysing the title as a forward-looking exercise. Yet, when a writer is writing he is
constantly looking backwards to his plan or guidelines (in this case the title). When you are writing an essay
in the IELTS, you need to look back at the title constantly to make sure you are writing the correct essay. If
the examiner cannot match your essay to the essay question in the exam, you have a problem. The same
applies in the case of paragraph headings.
This exercise gives you more practice with paragraph headings. This time each paragraph has a heading.
Read the paragraphs and decide why the heading is correct. Make a photocopy of the texts and underline
the words and phrases that give you the theme of the paragraph. If you can, make a rough plan to help you
see the layout of each paragraph.
Look at the Key for the previous exercise before you attempt this one. The plan will help you see why the
writer wrote each paragraph.
Note the paragraphs are not connected to each other. You will also find that several of them are similar to,
but not the same as, paragraphs you have already read.
In this exercise, like the last one, if you need to use the Key to help you understand the mechanism, feel free
to do so. However, try to do the exercise first without any help.
1. Heading: Hooked on change
Change causes problems, not least the anxiety it generates among those whose very livelihood is
threatened. Yet, there are people who seem to thrive on change, enjoying the constant flow of
challenges. There is a bit of the Luddite in all of us when we are faced with adapting to the
onslaught of technological developments at work. In the early 19th century, the Luddites revolted
against the introduction of what was new technology in their time by breaking machinery which was
replacing workers. The pace of change today is much faster, a situation in which certain types of
people flourish. To them the constant movement involved in change is like a drug. They become
addicted very quickly, harnessing the power of technological advances and creating new
opportunities, not just for themselves, but for others as well.
2. Heading: Welcome to new technology
Change causes problems, not least because it upsets peoples routine and makes them feel
uneasy. A good example is the introduction of technology in the workplace. The Luddite in all of us
comes out as we are faced with adapting to the onslaught of technological change at work. In the
early 19th century, the Luddites revolted against the introduction of new technology. The pace of
change today is much faster, and thereby more unsettling. But the belief that it destroys peoples
jobs and lives is totally unfounded. Thousands of workers in old-fashioned factories may have been
replaced by computers and robots; it is now clear, however, that, far from destroying work, many
more jobs have been created in factories as the power of technological change is harnessed.
Witness the development of silicon valleys throughout the world. The advances in the field of
technology should, therefore, be embraced with open arms rather than feared.
t
3. Heading: The North/South driving divide
Another interesting observation is how standards of driving seem to deteriorate markedly as you
travel down the country. A much more calm and relaxed manner of driving is noticeable to those
visitors to Northern cities like Bradford, Leeds, Manchester and Carlisle. There does not seem to be
the same mad rush and lack of respect for other road users that is all too apparent in areas like the
42
A book for IELTS
Exercises 1to 22
Reading
South-east and London. It is a strange experience to drive down the M1 from the North and feel the
traffic gradually start to speed up, with tailgaters appearing in your rear mirror more regularly and
undertaking becoming more commonplace the nearer you approach London. In the two to three
hours drive South, the journey changes from a pleasant drive at a respectable pace to a mad
aggressive rush as the traffic hurtles towards London. Is this yet another example of the differences
between the North and South? If so, it is one Northerners should be proud of.
4 Headi ng: Peace at the wheel
Another interesting observation is how much more relaxing it is to travel around in the North. A
calm and relaxed manner of driving is noticeable to those visiting cities like Bradford, Leeds,
Manchester and Carlisle. There does not seem to be the same mad rush and lack of respect for
other road users that is all too apparent in areas like the South-east and London. It is a strange
experience to drive up the M1 from the South and feel the traffic gradually slow down, with fewer
tailgaters appearing in your rear mirror and undertaking becoming less frequent. The tension at the
wheel subsides: and a car journey changes into a very pleasant drive at a respectable pace.
5. Heading: The stupidity of ageism
Age discrimination is rife among the business community. The folly inherent in this process is
nothing less than a criminal act. It does not seem to have dawned on employers that the workplace
is changing. The number of people dealing with knowledge compared with manual workers is
increasing. In the near future, we may find companies clamouring over each other to attract old
people as the demographic make-up of the working population changes. Some companies already
have a policy of employing older people in their stores, and they have seen a marked turn-around
in sales. Could this possibly have something to do with a thing called experience?
6. Heading: The need for legislation to protect older people
Age is commonly used as a criterion to prevent people from entering a job and, indeed, to rid an
establishment of excess personnel. Young people are seen as being fitter physically and mentally,
and as costing less. The experience of older people is overlooked. A dose of ageism is needed
here, but ageism where there is discrimination in favour of old people. Some companies already
have a policy of employing older people in their stores, and they have seen a marked turn around in
sales. So, perhaps there is a case for legislating in favour of old people in the workplace.
Exerci se 14 : Increasing your reading speed
In Reading Exercises 1- 13, you looked at reading a passage from the point of organisation and meaning.
We have pointed out that this may have slowed your reading down, as learning any new skill does. With
practice, however, the mechanisms can help to increase your speed as well as efficiency in reading and
examining a text.
You also need, however, to have a range of strategies to help you read quickly. Increasing ones reading
speed in ones native language is difficult enough; in a second, or possibly third or fourth, it is even more
difficult.
Below is a list of mini-exercises to help you focus on increasing your speed.
1. One way to increase your speed is by learning to pick out the most important words in a
sentence which will give you a summary of the meaning. Look at the following sentences:
A recent study of t op execut i ves shows that compani es are wast i ng val uabl e t i me and
resources, because managers are being subj ected to unaccept abl e l evel s of stress by
of f i ce pol i t i cs and i ncreased pressure. This si tuati on is f ur t her compounded by long
hours, i nf requent breaks and sl eepl essness.
What is the difference between the words that are highlighted and the ones which are not?
A book for IELTS
43
Reading
Exercises 1 to 22
2. Read the text in 1above again and then read the following text:
A recent study of top executives shows that companies are wasting valuable time and
resources, because managers are being subjected to unacceptable levels of stress by office
politics and increased pressure. This situation is further compounded by long hours,
infrequent breaks and sleeplessness.
What is the difference between the highlighted words this time and the original?
3. Read the texts below as quickly as you can and mark the words which act as stepping stones
and summarise the text for you.
(A) Participation in the Euro, the new European currency, hinged on whether the criteria
set out in the Maastricht Treaty were adhered to strictly. Several countries would like to have
seen some of the qualifying conditions relaxed, but that did not happen, as the banks were
against any slackening of monetary control. What remains to be seen is whether the
governments concerned can stick to the stringent monetary goals they have set themselves.
(B) The swingeing cuts introduced by the government have created quite a fracas, but
many people believe that they are necessary for the future health of the country. The main
target areas appear to be spending on welfare, defence and the road network.
(C) One member of the public, a Gladys C Roach, who took part in the survey, stated that
she felt it was dangerous to shop in the department store as it was so full of tempting food. She
added that she always had to make sure that she went there to shop only on a full stomach.
Otherwise, she would spend a fortune.
4 . Understanding the relationship between the parts of sentences will also help you. What is the
relationship between the parts within the sentences below?
a The underlying rate of inflation has remained the same as last month,
under-mining the governments attempts to curb interest rate rises.
b Progress in the talks to settle the dispute has been slow: agreement has
only been reached on one item in the list of differences between the two sides.
c The frost wreaked such havoc among the early blossoms at Farkleberry,
that there was much consternation at the big house.
d Although he had created a very innovative and effective programme, it was in
danger of being destroyed through ignorance and jealousy.
e He had created such an innovative and effective programme, that it was in
danger of being destroyed through ignorance and jealousy.
5. Another way to help you read quickly is to learn to recognise the relationship in meaning
between sentences. What is the relationship between the pairs of sentences below?
a This shows, say many teachers, that standards of English for many secondary school
pupils and university students have declined over recent years. The answer is, obviously,
that the teaching of grammar should be made compulsory in secondary school and on
relevant teacher training courses.
b This shows, say many teachers, that standards of English for many secondary school
pupils and university students have declined over recent years. The answer is, perhaps, to
make the teaching of grammar compulsory in secondary school and on relevant teacher
training courses.
c This shows, say many teachers, that standards of English for many secondary school
pupils and university students have declined over recent years. The danger is, obviously, that
the teaching of grammar is made compulsory in secondary school and on relevant teacher
training courses.
d The number of ships being repaired in the dockyard has declined steadily since the
end of the 60s. Only five ships were repaired or refitted last year as against 30 in 1968.
44
A book for IELTS
Exercises 1 to 22
Reading
6. In the text in 5a above, isolate the two main pieces of information. For the first you may
use only five words; for the second you may use only eight.
Exerci se 15: More about speed
Exercise 15 contains some more strategies to help you increase your speed.
1. What is the main information in each of the texts below? Read and decide as quickly as you can.
a In a paper to be published in the next issue of the J ournal, Farilla Bartlett, the eminent
anthropologist, of the University of London, argues that the launch of the anti-smoking
campaign will fail miserably.
b In detailed studies of the sleep patterns of males, the researchers recorded that the
amount of deep sleep declines with age, thus leading to a reduction in the bodys
rejuvenation process.
c Scumbling, the use of dry brush to create a hazy effect on paper surfaces not previously
covered with a colour wash, is a simple, but subtle technique.
2. Understanding the basic layout of a sentence can also help you find your way round a text and
hence read more efficiently and quickly. Sentences in English are basically divided between
old and new information. Look at the following example:
A woman entered a bui lding. Suddenl y, she saw a large cat. The ani
mal was eating a mouse. The cat looked at the woman. The woman
l ifted a stick and walked away from the cat
You can look at the information as follows:
New New
A woman entered a building.
Old New
[Suddenly], she saw a large cat.
Old New
The animal was eating a mouse.
Old Old
The cat looked at the woman.
Old New
The woman lifted a stick
Old New
and [The woman] walked away from
Notice how the information generally jumps back and forward from Old to New, except in the first
and last part of the text! An economical way of reading text is to train yourself to read only the New
information as you already know the Old.
A book for IELTS
45
Reading
Exercises 1 to 22
In the texts below, find the Old and New information.
(a) A car was driving slowly along a road. It turned into the drive of a
large white house. The car stopped just short of the front door, but the
driver did not get out.
(b) Her first acting break in a major film was doing a voice-over in a spy
film. This led to a string of similar jobs doing work on adverts.
(c) Mr Maguire made a number of predictions for the future of further edu
cation in the UK. His forecasts are seriously flawed. They are much too
optimistic to be credible.
(d) A woman with a manic grin entered a building. Suddenly, the building
collapsed. When the dust settled, she walked into another building. Her
grin was now even more hideous.
(e) The governments version of events was not believed by anyone. It
was seen by most people as a cover-up. The whole affair serves to illus
trate the fears people have of politicians inclination to abuse power.
3. As you have seen in the reading exercises you have done so far, it is helpful to know how
a text is organised. If you are able to see how text is organised in general it will help you to
move through the reading passages in IELTS quickly and effectively.
Look at the organisation of the text below. What is the essential information in the sentence?
Can you divide the information into three main blocks? Paraphrase the sentence and begin:
Statisti cs show...
Accordi ng to the statisti cs avail abl e on homel essness, what drives
young people away from home is the threat of vi ol ence from those
within the household.
4 . It is difficult for all of us to hold several pieces of information in our heads at the same time
about a text and extract detail. You can, however, practise doing this. Look at the texts below
and answer the questions which follow:
(a) Lacking the natural resilience of her mother, Muriel, Mavis, recently
devastatingly rebuffed by her aunt Maureen, fell into a long and agonising
period of depression.
Who became depressed?
(b) Unlike Mr Richardson and Mrs Frome, the previous directors, the new
directors, Mrs Allinson, Mr Frome (no relation to Mrs Frome) and Miss Vin
cent, decided to terminate the contract that had been signed by the
above-mentioned Mr Richardsons father prior to his son and one of his
daughters taking over as directors of the company.
What is the relationship between Mr Richardson and Mrs Frome?
46
A book for IELTS
Exercises 1 to 22 Reading
5. Look at the following text and complete the sentence which follows:
In a tense hour- long Whitehall meeting the day before yesterday, Mrs Cartiebury, sitting
with Sir Charles Drew and Charles Drewmore, the chairman and chief executive of Silver,
Finch & Finch, respectively, the main auditors employed by the Ombudsman, and
Samantha AM, Head of the P ersonal I nvestment Authority, which is overseeing the
multi- billion mis- selling review, laid down the rules.
The rules__________________ by Mrs Cartiebury.
Exerci se 16: Words that slow you down
Students often complain that they find it difficult to read a text because they do not know certain words. These
words do not stop you from understanding a text. What stops you is focusing on individual words and not the
overall meaning. There is a saying in English that the devil is in the detail. He is there, so do not let him hold
you back!
Below is a series of short texts and sentences. Each text contains a blank space where a word which would
normally cause difficulty has been left out.
After each text, there is a sentence in a box to complete like the questions you have in the IELTS exam. Do
not try to complete the blank spaces in the first text in the exercise, as the original words are rather difficult.
The exercise aims to show you how irrelevant individual words can be to your understanding of a text.
Example
Students are often totally__________ when they come across words that they do not know in a text
Words that _________frequently confuse students.
The missing words in the box are: they do not know. You do not need to know the missing word.
Now complete the blank spaces in the boxes under each Text below using no more than four words from
the first Text in each case.
1. The_________ in the reading passage distracts people so much that they cannot read the text
comfortably. Certain words, like waves interfering with a radio transmission, affect students ability
to extract the meaning from a passage, because they are unable to leave the words they do not
know alone. They do not realise that it is possible to understand the meaning without knowing
every single term.______________________________________ _____________
Certain terminology prevents people from reading a text__________.
2. In writing and reading,_________ is a basic form of connecting a text. Examples of such
reference are words like: it, they, synonyms etc. __________________________
Referring backwards in written text is an elementary form of__________.
3._________ in her attempts to modernise the company while trying to satisfy the investors and
the financial markets at the same time, she reluctantly decided to_________ her resignation.
She resigned from her post because her endeavours to__________were opposed.
A book for IELTS
47
Reading Exercises 1to 22
4. It seems that the_________ instruments were thrown into the rubbish pit rather than
being taken back for mending.
The instruments that did not work were thrown into
5. institutions soon run into trouble when they find that they cannot pay for the
day-to-day administration of their establishments.
Bodies which do not control their spending
6. They thought that the plot that they had________ was foolproof, but they were soon found out
and severely punished.
Their plot was not
7. The style seen here in this church is the_________ of the achievement reached at the height of
the Italian Renaissance._____________________________________
The church represents the style of _________ at its height.
8. The difficulties experienced over the last few weeks have been_________ by the introduction of
new measures to combat the rise in crime. The recent rights riots have only served to exacerbate
an already difficult situation.
The new measures to fight the have made the situation worse.
9. The situation will easily be rectified by a _________ programme focusing on the most pressing
aspects of the problem.
The programme can focus on the __________of the problem.
10. The distinction between both sides of an argument can often become quite
There is a grey area between both___________.
Exerci se 17: Problems with meaning
This exercise is an attempt to illustrate a problem that students have as they try to analyse the reading texts
in IELTS, particularly Yes/ No/ Not Given exercises. It is a problem that they do not realise exists and which
interferes with their analysis of the texts. As you have seen in previous Exercises, particularly Reading
Exercises 5 and 6, sentences can have several meanings at the same time.
Likewise, there are two basic mechanisms at work as you are analysing a text. Look at the following pair of
sentences:
A Growth will slow down in the near future.
B It is predicted that the pace of growth will decline.
At a glance, the sentences have the same meaning. You see that Sentence B is a paraphrase of Sentence
A. Obviously, it does not contain all the information that is in Sentence A. It is not exact enough, because it
does not specifically mention a time (in the near future). It is, nevertheless, a paraphrase of Sentence A.
48
A book for IELTS
Exerci ses 1 to 22 Reading
Now look at the same sentences the other way round:
B It is predicted that the pace of growth will decline.
A Growth will slow down in the near future.
Sentence A does not paraphrase Sentence B, because it adds additional information to the information in
Sentence B! Remember that in the exam you are analysing the text using the sentences in the exercises.
You are not analysing the exercises using the text. The danger, of course, is that students, consciously or
sub-consciously, read also from the reading passage to the exercise, as they look from the statement in the
exercise to the information in the text. This, as we have seen, can give you the wrong answer!
Now compare the above pair of sentences with the following:
A The dog gave chase to the cat.
B It was the cat that was pursued by the dog.
A has the same meaning as B and vice versa!
In this exercise, you have pairs of sentences 1-15. Read the sentences as quickly as you can and decide
whether the sentences in each pair have exactly the same meaning. You will probably have to do this exercise
several times. If necessary, use the Key to help you.
1. A The man sank his teeth into the dogs ear.
B It was the dogs ears that were bitten off by the man.
2. A Joseph stopped smoking cigarettes.
B Joseph stopped to smoke.
3. A Mohamed was too optimistic about the future.
B Mohamed was not that hopeful about the future.
4. A Everyone should take up some form of exercise to help them relax.
B It is necessary for everybody to get involved in some form of exercise to help unwind.
5. A Various instruments were studied as part of the research.
B A variety of instruments were studied during the research.
6. A Few people grasp this point at the first attempt.
B There are not many who understand this straight-off.
7. A Its going to rain soon.
B The forecast is for rain.
8. A Adapting to change induces a number of unpleasant side effects.
B Depression and physical illness are brought on by having to adapt to change, which is
never a pleasant or easy experience. Change also induces stress and unhappiness.
9. A The final contract did not fully meet the unions demands.
B What was approved in the end fell short of what the union had asked for.
10. A Parents fear that standards at all levels of education, but especially at secondary
school, are falling.
B Parents are afraid that not enough attention is being paid to education at primary
school level.
11. A If only the fire brigade had arrived sooner the building would have been saved.
B It is regrettable that the building was destroyed because the fire brigade did not
arrive sooner.
12. A There is a slim possibility that the accused may not have committed the murder.
B It is highly likely that it was the accused who committed the murder.
13. A Everyone is aware that the centre has improved significantly.
B It is not widely appreciated that the centre has got better.
14. A He is only 65.
B It is surprising that he is 65 years of age.
15. A The stolen vase is priceless.
B The value of the vase that was taken is beyond price.
A book for IELTS
49
Reading Exercises 1 to 22
Exerci se 18: An introduction to Yes
This exercise helps you focus on the technique required to answer the Yes/ No/ Not Given type of question
in the exam. It is more important for you to learn the analytical process in this type of question than to find
the correct answer. The exercise has, therefore, been designed in such a way that you need to hold
information in your head while you try to find the correct answer. You may need to do the exercise several
times.
In the column on the left, you have 14 statements. On the right, there are 17 statements (a- q). How many
statements on the eft can you find that have a statement with the same meaning in the right-hand column?
For example, the answer for Sentence 14 is (a).
1. All that is necessary to ensure the future viability of the
He is a perfect example of what people now
Project has been done.
a.
think of as the old-fashioned type of police
2. What surprised the government most was the rapidity officer.
with which their fortunes were reversed.
b. It looked as if there was going to be a
3. Why the second report has been hushed up is not
downpour, when the train set off.
entirely clear.
c. The government was discomfited by the
4. Why the previous report was hushed up is patently
reversal of their fortunes.
obvious. d. Not all of us find it difficult to separate our
5. The ability to separate emotion from rationality is a rarity.
emotion from our reason.
6. The governments discomfort at their misfortune was not
e. The reason for burying the second report is
completely unknown.
surprising.
f. The speed with which matters deteriorated
7. Intelligence can surely be nurtured and developed in took the government aback.
most individuals.
9-
The motives behind the suppression of the
8. Doctors are mads not born.
second report are not 100% dear.
9. The government were attacked for not acting promptly to
h. Doctors are born not made.
sort out the situation. i. Learned people are more often than not
10. As the train departed, the sky was promising a heavy
1
superstitious.
burst of rain.
No stone was left unturned to protect the
future Project.
11. Superstition is far from being rare among educated
people.
k. Criticism was levelled at the government for
not acting more quickly to resolve the matter.
12. The government should have acted sooner to take the
1. The reason for hushing up the previous report
pressure out of the situation.
is generally unknown.
13. There is nothing new under the sun.
m. Everything has been done to make sure the
14. He epitomises everyones idea of the old breed of
Project will survive.
policeman.
n. The overwhelming majority of people are
incapable of keeping emotion apart from their
rational side.
o. The qualities necessary to be a physician are
not inherited, but taught.
P-
It was raining as the train left.
q-
Everything seems the same.
A book for IELTS
Exercises 1 to 22 Reading
Exerci se 19: An introduction to No
This exercise helps you focus on the technique required to answer No in the Yes/ No/ Not Given type of
question in the exam. As in the previous exercise, it is more important for you to learn the analytical process
in this type of question than to find the correct answer. The exercise has, therefore, been designed in such
a way that you need to hold information in your head while you try to find the correct answer. You may need
to do the exercise several times.
In the column on the left, you have 9 texts. On the right, there are some words and phrases (a- t) are suitable
parts of the text on the left with these words and phrases so that they disagree with or contradict the original
texts. Some statements may be changed in more than one way. One cannot be changed.
One sentence has been done for you as an example. Try not to mark the text so that you can repeat the
exercise.
r
1. The company made a healthy profit from the sale of its a duplicity
publishing arm.
b unbelievably pessimistic
[ Answer = j]
c atypical
2. Fertile fields flecked with blood-red poppies sped past the
d police
carriage window.
e not sanguine enough
3. Re-negotiating the new treaty has been hampered by the
4
As he lay dying,
fact that several of the governments involved are facing
T
general elections at the present time.
9
deplorable
4. The behaviour of the policeman was commendable in all
h advertising
respects. i slightly covered
5. His honesty is typical of the new breed of politician. ^ j
small
6. His predictions for the future of the welfare state in many
k felt unbelievably optimistic
European countries are seriously flawed. They are too 1 crawled slowly by
optimistic to be credible.
m hindered
7. The story is obviously apocryphal. Nonetheless, it serves
n integrity
to illustrate the fears people have surrounding the
o true
problem.
p big loss
8. In the very middle of his life, he found himself in the dark
wood of despair.
q
have just won a plebiscite
9. Travelling with a purpose is better than travel for travels
r pessimistic
sake.
s
t
leg
old
A book for IELTS
51
Reading
Exercises 1to 22
Exerci se 20: Meaning in a text
This exercise gives you some more practice with paraphrase at sentence level. Read through the passage
below, which has 9 sentences. Then read the texts (A- Q), which follow, and replace each sentence below
with one of the texts (A- Q) with the same meaning. There are more texts in the list than you can use.
(1) What is the difference between knowledge and experience? (2)
Knowledge is basically information that is stored in the brain. (3) The
process for this is one way - from an outside source like a book or the
TV to the brain. (4) Experience is something altogether different. (5) It
is a process whereby stored knowledge of any kind is moved around
the brain. (6) Take learning to drive a car. (7) We can read all there
is to know about driving, but until we start connecting and using the
different pieces of knowledge we have acquired, the information is
useless. (8) So, to make the information we have in our brains useful,
we need to be able to manipulate it. (9) The examples are endless.
List of texts
A Information is basically knowledge we have learned or acquired.
B The difference between knowledge and experience.
C A good example here is learning to drive a car.
D Knowledge is not that different from experience.
E People need to be capable of applying the knowledge they have for it to be of any benefit.
F The number of examples is limited.
G Is there a difference between knowledge and experience?
H Experience is a very different animal.
I Experience entails moving different pieces of knowledge in the brain.
J Knowledge is not the same as experience.
K In this process, information in the brain is moved around, e.g. learning to drive.
L A basic definition of knowledge is information or facts that we have learned or acquired.
M Knowledge is an external resource.
N If we learn a lot of information about driving, but do not use it, the data are then useless.
O Knowledge is different from experience in that the former is a static, passive entity,
whereas experience requires knowledge to be activated.
P People acquire knowledge from sources outside, not inside themselves.
Q This can be exemplified time and time again.
Exercises 1to 22 Reading
Exerci se 21: Yes, No, or Not Given 1
This exercise and the next one focus on the tricky question of deciding whether a statement in relation to a
text is Yes/ No/ Not Given.
In the exercise below, each text is followed by three statements. For each alternative, write:
Yes if the statement agrees with the information in the text
No if the statement contradicts the information in the text
Not Gi ven if it is impossible to say whether the statement agrees
with or contradicts the information in the text
1. Many lecturers find their jobs very rewarding.
a Many lecturers are well paid,
b All lecturers get something positive from their work,
c The majority of lecturers get satisfaction from their work.
2. Computers are gaining in popularity, despite their cost.
a Computers are getting cheaper,
b Computers are expensive.
c Computers used to be more popular than they are now.
3. As a result of increasing affluence, an ever larger number of families now have two cars.
a Most families nowadays have two cars,
b People are getting richer,
c Cars are becoming more expensive.
4. Educational standards in schools have, in general, been gradually improving.
a Schools have been getting better,
b The education in schools has not been improving,
c Educational standards are not as unsatisfactory as they used to be.
5. In families, the traditional roles of men and women are often reversed if the man becomes unemployed.
a Unemployment can affect the way that families operate.
b In families where the woman has a job, men and women usually have traditional roles,
c Unemployment does not affect the role of a man in the family.
6. Although the hazards of boxing have been well publicised, the government has yet to
introduce a total ban on the sport.
a The government does not want to ban boxing,
b The hazards of boxing are not very well-known,
c A ban on boxing has not been introduced yet.
7. There is as much money to be made from the sale of umbrellas on rainy days, as there is from cold drinks
when the temperature rises.
a Cold drinks sell well when it gets warmer,
b When it rains, older people buy umbrellas,
c The author is a shopkeeper.
8. While it has been acknowledged for many years that an increasing number of animals are bound to become
extinct, it is only recently that the problem has been addressed by politicians.
a Recently people have been writing to our politicians about animals becoming extinct,
b We have known for a long time that more species of animals will disappear,
c Politicians have been fighting animal extinction for many years.
A book for IELTS
53
Reading Exercises 1 to 22
9. Most people would be amazed if they realised how many different types of insect life exist in their very own
garden.
a The majority of gardeners are not surprised at the range of insect life in their garden,
b It is impossible to count the different types of insect life in a garden,
c There are more types of insect life in the average garden than most people think.
10. In the busy modem world we live in, it is very easy to take for granted many of the things our forebears had
to struggle to achieve: adequately heated housing and sufficient food on the table, to name but two.
a In the past, not all houses were heated,
b Our lives are better than those of people in the past,
c Two things today are better than they used to be.
Exerci se 22: Yes, No, or Not Given 2
This exercise gives you further practice with deciding whether a statement is Yes/ No/ Not Given, but this
time in longer texts.
In the exercise below, each text is followed by three statements.
For each alternative write:
Yes if the statement agrees with the information in the text
No if the statement contradicts the information in the text
Not Gi ven if it is impossible to say whether the statement agrees
with or contradicts the information in the text
Read the text as quickly as you can, and then try to answer the statements without looking at the text again.
If you find this too difficult, then read the text again.
1. Good health is something that people assume is a right to which everybody should be entitled.
However, the means of maintaining good health are not always at the disposal of every citizen, this
particularly being the case in societies where a two-tier health service is in operation. The unfortunate
consequence here is that the financially disadvantaged also tend to become disadvantaged in terms
of the standard of health care they receive.
a In some societies, the health care an individual receives depends on how wealthy you are.
b Poor people tend to have more health problems,
c Nearly everybody believes good health is a basic human right.
2. For students in full-time education one of the major worries is how to make ends meet. Studying and,
therefore, receiving no income, they need to obtain financial support from somewhere. The first option is,
for those who are eligible, a government grant: although this may have to be paid back at a later date.
Reliance on parental support or a bank loan are also possible avenues open to some, but not all, students.
It Is important, however, to match the financial arrangements carefully to the individual concerned.
a Part-time students are not as anxious about money as full-time students,
b The author thinks that financial support from parents is easily available for most students,
c Full-time students have little money, because they do not work.
t
3. The myriad of new sporting activities which have recently sprung up means that any individual who is
considering taking up a different form of exercise is very much spoilt for choice. From scuba diving to
skateboarding, and from abseiling to snow boarding, the young and fit throw themselves with enthusiasm
into these new sporting pursuits. Caution, however, is to be advised for the hitherto unsporty individual,
54
A book for IELTS
Exercises 1to 22
Reading
who risks serious injury if physically unprepared for, or incapable of coping with, the physical challenges
many such activities involve.
a The writer thinks the sporting activities mentioned should be attempted only by young people,
b Many new sports are physically demanding,
c Recently there have not been many new sporting activities.
4. In any inner-city area, there are certain to be problems associated with a great number of people
living in close proximity to each other. Whilst it may be possible for people in such communities to exist
perfectly amicably, it is more common for there to be a certain amount of tension and animosity brooding
beneath the surface. Flare-ups that result in injury, and even violent death, are not uncommon
occurrences, as frequent newspaper reports bear witness.
a People in inner-city, high-rise flats live in a permanent state of tension,
b Densely populated inner city areas are breeding grounds for all kinds of dubious activities,
c In inner city areas, tension has led to violent gun battles.
5. The taking of exams is a ritual that all students encounter throughout their academic career, whether it be at
school level or at a higher academic level, for example, at college or university. Many theories and
methods have been propounded as to the best way to ensure exam success, but all students need to be
reminded that a consistent approach to studying is certainly not inconsequential in achieving exam
success.
a Exam success is a consequence of a consistent approach to studying,
b Passing exams is a problem only for pupils at school.
c Several hypotheses have been put forward about the best way to pass exams.
A book for IELTS
55
Reading
Test 1
56
A book for IELTS
Test 1 Reading Tests
You should spend about 20 minutes on Questions 1- 15, which are based on P assage 1 below.
A rose by any other name would smell as sweet
In the past few years, the trend has been away from hybrid tea and floribunda roses towards shrub and
species roses. While this change has, in part, been driven by recent fashions in garden design coupled
with adroit marketing, there is no doubt that shrub and species roses offer a number of cultural
advantages. Of course, there are aesthetic considerations too: some growers preferring the wide colour
range and high-centred blooms of the hybrid teas, while others choose shrub roses, because they
integrate more easily into an overall garden design. This is largely a question of taste and lies beyond
the scope of the present article.
Before examining the cultural advantages of shrub roses, mention should be made of their diversity
and antiquity. There are three distinct races of rose, which can be traced back to the Middle Ages: the
gallicas, the albas, and the damasks. Gallica roses were first recorded in the 13th century, and probably
the most famous of all, Gallica officinalis, is among the flowers depicted on the famous Ghent Altarpiece,
painted by the Flemish artist Jan Van Eyck in the 14th century. Another gallica, Rosa mundi, with its
characteristic red and white petals has been cultivated for at least six centuries. Albas too have a long
history. Alba x semiplena is the worlds oldest working* rose and is still grown in the Kazanluk region
of Bulgaria for its highly scented petals, which are harvested each June to make the perfume, attar of
roses. Damasks, as the name implies, were thought to have come from Damascus. Their origin is more
obscure, but they are certainly related to wild roses still growing in parts of the Middle East and Iran.
There are in cultivation more recently introduced varieties of roses too, such as Bourbons, hybrid musks,
and hybrid perpetuals as well as rugosas, which originate in the Far East.
As a result of this genetic diversity, shrub roses have two major cultural advantages for the
horticulturalist, and the amateur gardener: resistance to disease and tolerance of a wide variety of
climate and soil types. Many shrub roses show resistance to fungal diseases such as black spot and rust,
to which hybrid teas are highly susceptible. Rugosas are particularly disease-free. In poor soil conditions,
shrub roses, having deep vigorous root systems, are more tolerant of drought and do not suffer to the
same extent from nutrient deficiency diseases. For the horticulturalist, this means that less time and
money need be spent on applying fertilisers or spraying for disease. Similarly, there are some shrub
roses which will grow well in shady or windy conditions, or even against a north-facing wall. Large
specimen shrubs may be found growing happily in the most unpromising situations.
However, there are other practical issues to consider. Where space is at a premium, it is important
to remember that the majority of shrub roses, which do not require regular hard pruning in order to
encourage them to flower, will eventually grow into large bushes up to two metres high, with a spread
of two to three metres. For small gardens, hybrid teas, rarely growing more than one metre tall, are
more practical. The size and density of shrub roses can, however, be an advantage where a large
permanent bush is required. Some varieties are sufficiently dense as to be suitable for hedging.
Another factor is length of flowering period. Many shrub roses have a short, but spectacular flowering
season. The famous old rose Cuisse de Nymphe, for example, is covered in succulent pink blossom for
about a month in midsummer, but does not bloom again. There are, however, other varieties, which are
repeat or perpetual flowering, including Madame Isaac Pereire, probably the most intensely fragrant
rose of all. Moreover, there are a number of varieties with attractive ferny foliage and graceful, arching
habit. This contrasts with the upright stance and coarse leathery leaves of hybrid teas. Species roses
also produce bright red fruits (hips) in September-October, and their leaves often acquire attractive
autumn tints.
All these factors need to be taken into consideration when choosing a rose for a particular site. Shrub
roses are long-lived, easy to propagate, and require less pruning and maintenance than a hybrid tea. A
detailed catalogue of varieties will give details of colour, flowering period, size, preferences of soil and
aspect, optimum planting times, and general cultural requirements.
A book for IELTS
57
Reading Tests
Test 1
QUESTI ONS 1- 3
Use NO MORE ThAN THREE WORDS from the passage to complete each blank in the diagram below.
Fi r s t ____ 6 ____
in 13th Cent ur y
Ther e are t hr ee
Or i gi n obscure e.g. Alba x semiplena
whi ch has____ 5 ___
QUESTI ONS 7- 13
Complete the text beiow, which is a summary of paragraphs 3, 4 and 5. Choose your answers from the
Word List below the summary and write them in Boxes 7-13 on your answer sheet.
There are more words or phrases than spaces, so you will not be able to use them all. You may use each
word or phrase only (jnce.
Factors governing the choice of rose
Example: The_____________________________________________________ (Example)_of shrub roses can be an advantage when a
large permanent bush is required.
Answer: size
58
A book for IELTS
Test 1
Reading Tests
There are di fferent types of shrub roses, some of which are abl e to resi st di sease
and ot hers whi ch sui t di verse cl i mat es and soil s, f eat ur es t hat ar e of
________(7)________to both horticulturalists and gardeners, as, in the long run,
such adaptabil ity saves both time and money. The ________(8)________is
another factor that needs to be taken into account when choosing a rose.
________(9)________shrub r oses________ (10)________without having to be cut
back regularl y. I n fact, they c an ________(11)________grow to a hei ght of nearl y
two metres and up to three met r es________(12)________. So for small gardens
hybrid teas are more practi cal, because they rarel y grow more than one metre
tall. The length of the floweri ng season al so____________________________ (13)______the choice of
rose, as does the shape of the plant.
Word List
gives across spread
most beneficial spacing
majority slowly over
in the end also circumference
area available dictates blossom
benefit always advantage
size
QUESTI ONS 14 & 15
Choose the appropriate letters A- D and write them in Boxes 14 & 15 on your answer sheet.
14. Which of the statements below is true about Madame Isaac Pereire?
A It is one of the most fragrant roses of all roses.
B It is impossible to say whether the writer is talking about shrub roses or all roses when
he says it is probably the most intensely fragrant rose of all.
C It is probably the most intensely fragrant shrub rose.
D It flowers only once per year.
15. The flowering season of shrub roses ...
A is short but spectacular.
B is repetitive.
C is perpetual.
D varies.
A book for IELTS
59
Reading Tests Test 1
You should spend about 20 minutes on Questions 16- 29, which are based on P assage 2 below.
Road rage all the rage!
To many people the term 'Road Rage'
describes a relatively modern concept of
drivers 'getting worked up due to some
incident whilst on the road and resorting to
physical violence or damage to property.
Most people would say that this has only really
become a problem in the last five years or so.
It has certainly attracted great media interest
in recent times, but it has, in fact, been part
of motoring for quite some time now.
A psychologist, employed by the Royal
Automobile Club (RAC), defines 'Road Rage',
thus: 'unchecked behaviour designed to
cause harm to another road user; behaviour
which is not normally in the behavioural
repertoire of the person. 'Road Rage' is an
altering of an individual's personality whilst
driving caused by a process of
dehumanisation. This dehumanisation is
caused by road use frustrations and an
artificial sense of insulation, protection and
empowerment provided by the car. This leads
the person to behave in a way designed to
cause harm or endanger other road users^.
Most motorists can remember an
occasion at some time in their motoring
career when an impatient, or short-tempered,
driver has 'cut them or someone else up' with
an aggressive display of driving, forcing the
victim to take evasive action to avoid a
collision. At the time, they probably thought:
what a Oreadful piece of driving; and mentally
clapped themselves on the back for being
such controlled, calm drivers. Media
attention, focused on particularly gruesome
incidents, has bestowed a certain notoriety on
this sort of driving. As a professional driver in
inner London and a motorcycle instructor, I
have witnessed such driving all too often over
the years.
The 1996 Lex Report on motoring,
published by Lex Service PLC, the UK's leading
vehicle retailing and leasing group, provides
us with some startling statistics. In the last 12
months, there have been: 1.8 million
instances of people who have been forced to
pull over or off the road; 800,000 instances of
people being physically threatened; 500,000
people in their cars being deliberately driven
into; 250,000 people attacked by other
drivers; and 250,000 people having their cars
deliberately damaged by another driver. A
survey also carried out by Lex confirms that up
to 80% of motorists have been the victims of
'Road Ragje' and that driver confrontation is
on the increase.
The RAC has also much to say on the topic.
One of their surveys reveals that as many as
90% of motorists have suffered at the hands
of seriously anti-social drivers and that the
effects upon them have in many cases been
wholly disproportionate to the level of threat
or actual violence inflicted.
The examples are both chilling and legion:
a driver had his nose bitten off following a row
with another motorist; a 78 year-old man was
killed after being punched by a man half his
age; an RAC patrolman, flagged down on
the motorway by a motorist, was violently
assaulted and verbally abused by the
motorist. The list goes on and on ...
The 1991 Road Traffic Act takes a very dim
view indeed of dangerous and careless
driving and, as with assaults, provides stiff
60
A book for IELTS
Test 1 Reading Tests
custodial sentences for those guilty of such
crimes, To date, however, there is no such
offence in the statute books known as 'Road
Rage'. There can be assaults or criminal
damage, followed or preceded by
dangerous driving, but no offence that
incorporates both - a change in the law
which the public are clamouring for in the
face of increasing anarchy on the roads.
Conversely, the Association of Chief Police
Officers denies that 'Road Rage' exists; or,
indeed, that there is a trend. There have been
suggestions from the same quarter that
'media interest and reporting are, in fact,
creating the problem by causing unnecessary
anxiety in the minds of the motoring public in
a direct analogy with fear of crime'.
Most of us probably imagine violence on
the road to be an entirely male preserve, as
men are naturally more competitive and
aggressive, especially when it comes to
driving. Melanie Flowers of Oxford Brookes
University, however, has the following to say:
'Women can be more aggressive in cars than
they ever would be when they are walking
along the street. In fact, you could even argue
that smaller or weaker people, who might be
victims when they are out of their cars, often
feel they can even things up a bit when they
are behind the wheel. When you are driving
you're judged by your car rather than your
physical attributes. It makes some women feel
stronger than they really are'.
An interesting study, but how often do you
see women fighting at the roadside or kicking
in body panels?
If all this is a general reflection of the driver
of the 90s, then the professionals have an
uphill struggle. But they are tackling the
problem head on. The RAC and Auto Express,
a motoring journal, have joined forces in a
Campaign Against Rage (CAR). They aim to
promote driver courtesy, offer advice on
avoiding 'Road Rage', and even Rage
Rehabilitation for violent offenders in an
attempt to avoid re-offence.
The courts are looking at stiffer penalties.
And the RAC is suggesting that sign-posting be
improved to try and stop city drivers losing their
way, a constant source of annoyance and
aggression, and they have also proposed the
introduction of variable message signs that
can help improve driver behaviour. Some
police traffic control cars are now equipped
with these message signs on the roof or rear
of their vehicles,
And the future? The Autoclass survey,
published in 1997, shows that parents are
creating the next generation of road-ragers.
The research among 10-16 year-olds found
that 62 per cent of fathers and 55 per cent of
mothers get angry while driving.
One thing is a certainty: the Road Rage
phenomenon is not going to disappear
overnight, even after stiffer sentencing or
improved driver training.
QUESTI ONS 16 & 17
Using the information in the passage, complete the table below. Write your answers in Boxes 16 & 17 on
your answer sheet.
P ercentage of motorists affected by Road Rage
The Lex Report - up to _______ 16________ %
RAC Survey - up to _______ 17________ %
A book for IELTS
61
Reading Tests Test 1
QUESTI ONS 18- 23
the information in Reading P assage 2? In Boxes 18- 23, write:
if the statement agrees with the information in the passage
if the statement contradicts the information in the passage
if there is no information about the statement in the passage
Exampl e: The Lex Report was published in 1997.
Answer: No
18. Road Rage is not in itself a vi ol ati on of the law.
19. According to a psychol ogist empl oyed by the RAC, cars give thei r dri vers an
unreal feel ing of being safe.
20. Motorcycling is an exciti ng, but safe mode of transport.
21. The Lex Report states that the i nci dence of conflicts between dri vers is rising rapidly.
22. The survey on Road Rage carri ed out by the RAC is very thorough.
23. According to the wri ter, Road Rage is a rel ati vel y modern phenomenon.
QUESTI ONS 24 - 27
Using NO MORE THAN THREE WORDS from the passage, complete the sentences below.
24 . Professionals face an___________________ in their fight against Road Rage.
25. ____________________are being considered by the law courts.
26. Violent behaviour by motorists is, in all probability, considered by many to be exclusively a
27. The Association of Chief Police Officers attributes the problem of Road Rage to media
QUESTI ONS 28 & 29
Choose the appropriate letters A- D and write them in Boxes 27 & 28 on your answer sheet.
28. Melanie Flowers of Oxford Brookes University states that ...
A cars make women stronger.
B cars frequently make women more combative than usual.
C cars sometimes make women less meek than they would be on the street.
D small women feel as meek in cars as they do outside.
29. The writers view of the eradication of Road Rage can be summarised as follows:
A optimistic.
B pessimistic.
C depressed.
D too pessimistic.
Do the statements agree with
Yes
No
Not Given
62
A book for IELTS
Test 1 Reading Tests
You should spend about 20 minutes on Questions 30- 4 0, which are based on P assage 3 below.
900 YEARS: THE RESTORATIONS OF WESTMI NSTER ABBEY
A. The exhibition in the summer of 1995 illustrated howWestminster Abbey has been transformed over the
past nine centuries. Both its structure and its contents have been changed and changed about but the
identity of the building has never been lost. This process of change deserves chronicling as a subject in its
own right, not as an apologetic footnote explaining why certain original features have been modified. For
those of the Gothic Revival, such as WilliamMorris, even by the 1890s the exterior of the Abbey had been
damaged so vitally... that we have nothing left us but a mere outline, a ghost. The ghost has proved
remarkably robust, the latest century of its history encompassing both aerial attack and painstaking
restoration. This is a story worth telling.
B. Restoration, according to the meaning wegiveit today as a self-conscious process of repair and reinstatement
of earlier features, only came to the Abbey at the end of the seventeenth century, with the campaign of
comprehensive repair devised and carried out by Christopher Wren and his successors. This programme of
work, covering the entire building both inside and out and setting out deliberately to respect the style of
the original structure, was exceptional for its date, not only in England but anywhere in Europe.
C. Restoration can also be used in a wider senseto cover a process of renovation whereby the original fabric
is replaced to a different design and in a different style, but respecting the meaning and ethos of the
building. Afamous example was the replacement by Bramante of the Early Christian basilica of St Peters
in Rome with his Renaissance design, not regarded then as an act of vandalism, but as a restatement of
the significance of the building for a newage. The continuing vitality of an institution can be said to be
expressed better by refashioning its buildings in a fresh style, rather than by patching up the old. It is in
this way that the replacement of Edward the ConfessorsRomanesqueabbey church (Nth century) by Henry
III (13th century) in the up-to-date Gothic style can be considered as a work of restoration, not as a new
building.
D. The meaning of restoration at Westminster can bevividly illustrated by an unexpected example: the history
of the effigy of Queen Elizabeth I. This figure was dismissed for years as a second-rate eighteenth-century
copy of the original. Indeed, the exterior of the Abbey has been regarded in a similar way. However, in
the effigy as in the building, not only is the eighteenth-century interpretation of the earlier period important
in its own right, but the early fabric turns out to remain at the heart The effigy acquired a newhead
and newclothes in 1760, not through insensitivevandalism, but to showoff Elizabeths central role in the
Abbeyshistory more effectively, just as Wren and Nicholas Hawksmoor had refaced the fabric of the building
a fewdecades before. To try to strip away the contribution of later generations in order to reveal some
mythical prime original Is a profound misunderstanding of Westminsters rich complexity.
E. The relationship between the historical overview depicted in the exhibition and the restoration work in
progress seen in the adjacent MasonsYard was vital to the exhibition. Thetwo parts gave meaning to each
other, the historical context gavevalidity to the current works, showing howthis process of organic renewal
has been present at the Abbey fromthe start while the display of work in progress brought vividly to life
the physical reality of the works exhibited.
A book for IELTS
63
Reading Tests Test 1
QUESTI ONS 30- 33
Choose one phrase (i - x) from the List of phrases to complete each key point below. Write the
appropriate letters (i - x ) in Boxes 30-33 on your answer sheet.
The information in the completed sentences should be an accurate summary of the points made by the
writer.
NB. There are more phrases (i - x) than sentences, so you will not need to use them all. You may use
each phrase once only.
30. The effigy of Queen Elizabeth I was ...
31. The Renaissance design for St Peters was ...
32. A comprehensive assessment of the past was ...
33. A narrow, modern meaning of restoration states that it is ...
List of P hrases
i regarded as an act of vandalism.
ii completely restored in 1760.
iii retaining the original design.
iv at the time considered appropriate.
V a method of repairing and reintroducing characteristics
from earlier times.
vi a poor replica of the original.
vii as important as the work exhibits in the Masons yard.
viii the validity of the current works.
ix respecting the original structure and ethos of a building.
X for a long time considered a poor replica of the original.
QUESTI ONS 34 - 36
Choose the appropriate letter A- D and write them in Boxes 34-36 on your answer sheet.
34. At the end of the seventeenth century the Abbey was ...
A thoroughly repaired.
B conscientiously repaired.
C designed by Sir Christopher Wren.
D unusual for buildings of the time.
35. Which of the following has the Abbey retained through centuries of change?
A structure and contents.
B original features.
C identity.
D outline.
Test 1 Reading Tests
36. The writer believes that it is better ...
A to remove the work of later generations to expose the original features of a building.
B not to remove the work of later generations to expose the original features of a building.
C to reveal the mythical original architecture of a building.
D to enhance the rich complexity of a building.
QUESTI ONS 37- 4 0
Reading Passage 3 has 5 paragraphs (A- E). Choose the most suitable heading for each paragraph from
the List of Headi ngs below. Write the appropriate numbers (i - xi ) in Boxes 37- 4 0 on your answer sheet.
One of the headings has been done for you as an example.
NB. There are more headings than paragraphs, so you will not use all of them.
37. P aragraph A
38. P aragraph B
39. P aragraph C
4 0. P aragraph D
Example: P aragraph E
Answer: vii
i
List of Headings
Bramantes artistic and architectural skills
ii A royal example
iii Restoration in Europe
iv The importance of recording change
V An extensive and unusual scheme,
vi Keeping the meaning
vii History alongside progress
viii Hawksmoors effect on the Abbey
ix Wren and Hawksmoor at the Abbey
X A summer exhibition
xi An organic renewal
A book for IELTS
65
Reading
Test 2
66
A book for IELTS
Test 2 Reading Tests
You should spend about 20 minutes on Questions 1- 14 , which are based on P assage 1 below.
Translation: from the sublime to the ridiculous?
According to the Oxford Dictionary, 'to translate' is 'to express the sense in or into another
language'. But what is 'the sense' really? Translating a piece of writing is not just a question
of picking up the foreign language dictionary and substituting one set of words for aaother.
Although it represents the substitution of a set of words from one lexicon for those from
another, it is ultimately a form of communication, concerned, as Peter Newmark says, with
transmitting culture and truth. For this reason, a translation should only be attempted after
the translator has carefully studied the whole text, and asked herself a number of questions.
Firstly, it is important that she considers the purpose of the said text. Insofar as all writing
is a form of communication, does this particular text aim - user instructions for a household
appliance, for example - simply to transmit information to a would-be user? Or does it
strive - an advertisement or hotel brochure or any other piece of publicity material - to
arouse interest so that the reader will want to buy the product, or stay in the hotel? Or is its
purpose - like that of a piece of literature, or a film - to stimulate the imagination, to
inspire and to entertain - as well as, perhaps, to instruct?
Once she has ascertained the purpose of the text, the translator needs to consider who the
readers of the translated text will be. The readers of the translation will, of necessity,
comprise a different group from the readers of the original - but they are likely to share
certain characteristics. I f the original text was aimed at a wide audience - the 'man in the
street' anxious to get to grips with his new coffee-maker, for example - then the reader of
the translated text is likely to fall into the same category and have the same expectations.
But perhaps the original was aimed at a more discrete and well-defined group, perhaps by
its style and content it has defined its readership.
Will the reader of the translation be someone with a good knowledge of the culture from
which the original has sprung, or will he be someone with a very sparse knowledge of it? I t
has been said that everything is translatable 'on condition that the two languages belong to
cultures that have reached a comparable degree of development'; how up-to-date will he be
with the requisite technical knowledge? Balancing the expectations of the potential readers
with those of the writer is, in this way, part of the tightrope which the translator treads; it
will dictate, for example, the extent to which annotations and footnotes will be needed in
the translation, and the way in which culturally-specific references and items of specialist
vocabulary are (or are not) translated.
The style and register of the translated text should, for reasons of integrity and coherence,
mirror that of the original. I t would be misleading if the translator of a text written in a
discursive and amusing style were to render it ponderous in translation; just as it would be
wrong for a translator to over-simplify what was originally an erudite piece of prose.
However, this is not to ignore the fact that there might well be instances in which a text -
awkwardly written in the original - could be made more accessible by the translator. I t is a
question of judgement.
The style in which something is written often represents a large part of what the writer is
trying to convey, and this is particularly likely to be the case with a work of literature, such
as a poem or novel: it is not only what the writer is saying, but how she says it which is
important. Allusions, deliberate ambiguity, humour, parody, and language which contains
alliteration and assonance, are likely to be features of such a text, and to represent
problems which the translator needs to solve appropriately. To that extent, translating is
rather like doing a jigsaw puzzle. Other kinds of writing - a piece of advertising, for
example - may well contain subliminal messages to which the translator will need to be
alert - as to any kind of'sub-text'.
A book for IELTS
67
Reading Tests
Test 2
Much translation is, by default, given to those with an inadequate grasp of either the source
or target language; - and often of both. I t is frequently overlooked that the successful
translator needs an excellent knowledge of the source language and a perfect mastery of
the target language in its technical and colloquial aspects. The target language, for the best
results, should be her mother-tongue but, as Peter Newmark says, many translators who
translate out of their own language 'contribute greatly to many people's hilarity in the
process.' So, for example, it once happened that 'la sagesse normande' became, in English,
'Norman wisdom'.
QUESTI ONS 1- 3
Complete the sentences below with information from the reading passage. You may use NO MORE
THAN THREE WORDS for each answer.
1. Translating a text is more than merely__________________
2. Each text whether informative, stimulating or instructive has
needs to take into account.
3. The reader of Hhe translation may have only a ___________
which the origi nal comes.
QUESTI ONS 4 - 6
Choose the appropr^te letters A- D and write them in Boxes 4 - 6 on your answer sheet.
4 . Anything can b>e translated, provided that...
A the t>wo languages are equally developed.
B the t\wo languages have similar levels of cultural development.
C the translator is up-to-date.
D the translator has the same expectations as the reader.
5. According to thje writer, it is sometimes possible to make a translation ...
A clear-er than the original.
B overl]y simple.
C humcorous.
D pondierous.
6. When translating a literary text, which one of the following is important for the translator?
A The \way in which a writer says something as much as the content.
B Sublhminal messages.
C Allusiions.
D J igsaiw puzzles in texts.
for others.
____________ that the translator
____knowledge of the culture from
Test 2 Reading Tests
QUESTI ONS 7- 10
The writer mentions a number of Judgements that need to be made by the translator. Which Four of the
Judgements below are mentioned? Write your answers (A- H) in Boxes 7- 10 on your answer sheet.
7. _________
8. __________
9. _________
10. ______
List of Judgements
A Weighing up why a writer says what she says.
B Determining the importance of poetry.
C Making a decision as to how far to stick to the original.
D J udging who the target audience of a translation will be.
E Whether translating is best done from the mother tongue.
F Deciding how many explanations, footnotes and comments
on vocabulary to include.
G Deciding on which information to use from dictionaries.
H Whether to oversimplify a text.
QUESTI ONS 11- 14
Answer the questions below using information from the passage. You may use NO MORE THAN THREE
WORDS from the passage for each answer. Write your answers in Boxes 11- 14 on your answer sheet.
11. Translation is a form of communication; what does it, in essence, transmit?
12. What do readers of a translation and readers of the original text often share?
13. Which aspects of the translated text should reflect the original?
14. What, according to the text, should a translator look at carefully before trying to do a translation?
A book for IELTS
69
Reading Tests
Test 2
You should spend about 20 minutes on QUESTI ONS 15- 29, which are based on P assage 2 below.
A buzz in the world of chemistry
A. For the past few years, one of the buzz terms in the pharmaceutical, agrochemical and biotechnology industries
has been combinatorial chemistry. Surf the net and find thousands of references to it. Read any of the general
science weeklies, such as Nature or New Scientist, and every few issues, another worthy author is going to save
the 21st century from everything nasty with this miraculous technology. Some of the more specialist journals
have even devoted whole issues to reviewing combinatorial chemistry.
B. These reviews all have the same format. First, there is a section from the Research and Development Director
of a major chemical company, a person who has not worked at the bench for years, if not decades. This is filled
with business-speak; the jargon keeps the shareholders happy and makes them proud to own a bit of something
at the forefront of science. Section two is from a director of a venture capital funded synthetic chemistry company
located on a green field site, probably in a portacabin, or, perhaps, in a new business park, rent free for the first
five years from the local authority of a small town no one has heard of. He discusses the molecular modelling
packages that they are using to build virtual libraries containing millions of compounds. The third section is
by someone who, in fact, practises combinatorial chemistry and who has developed automated systems to do
the syntheses and to assay the products. They can probably synthesise a few thousand compounds per week.
C. We know that organic chemistry is the chemistry of carbon, biochemistry the chemistry of life and physical
chemistry the application of physics to chemical behaviour. What then is combinatorial chemistry?
D. Combinatorial chemistry is a branch of synthetic organic chemistry. We all remember mathematics classes at
school just before the end of term when we were given silly sums to do: How many ways can five differently
coloured beads be arranged on a string? (120). Maths teachers call these permutation and combination problems;
hence, combinatorial chemistry.
E. After the development of solid phase peptide synthesis in the 1960s by Merrifield, soon synthetic peptide
chemists were also doing permutation and combination sums. There are 20 naturally occurring amino acids, the
building blocks of peptides and proteins, the workhorse molecules of life. How many ways can these be arranged,
or chemically bonded, to synthesise novel peptides which might be put to any number of uses in the pharmacy?
If we take just one molecule of each of the 20 amino acids and join them together to form a peptide, we find that
we can arrange these in 20! or 2.432902008177 x 1018 ways. Nature knows no such restraint; it can use multiple
copies of each amino acid, and so can synthesise 2020 or 1.048576 x 1026 twenty amino acid peptides. Proteins
contain hundreds of amino acids. The numbers of possible sequences are truly innumerable!
F. They become even more so when one considers the other polymeric molecules of life: the lipids, carbohydrates
and nucleic acids.
G . Classically trained synthetic chemists strive for purity. One remembers twelve years ago a chemist synthesising
a 20 residue peptide. He went off to the lab, was ever so busy, producing a different high performance liquid
cinematography (HPLC) trace every few days to show his biologist customers how the reactions were
progressing. A few months after the request was placed, the biologists were given a few milligrams of their
desired peptide and half a rain forest worth of HPLC printout!
H. That was fine when only one product was sought. Now the demand is for thousands of products to satisfy the
automated high-through-put screening systems employed by the major pharmaceutical companies. How can this
be achieved?
I. Let us consider solid phase synthesis strategies. In these, the compound of interest is synthesised on a solid
support, a resin bead. These beads are typically 100 microns in diameter and made from cross-linked polyvinyl
benzene or polyethylene glycol polymers.
J. Using the Tea-bag method, developed by Houghten in the 1980s, typically about 100 mg of the 100 micron
beads are put into polypropylene mesh sacs which have a 75 micron mesh size. These are thermally sealed closed
and the synthesis takes place on the resin beads within the sac. During the synthesis reaction cycles, the sacs are
transferred from reagent pot to pot in sequence, and at the end of the synthesis, the product is cleaved off the
bead, characterised and purified as need be. Using this strategy, one needs to use a separate sac for each compound
to be synthesised and automated systems have now been developed for multiple sac manipulation.
K. The sensitivity of compound analytical techniques has developed apace with the technology, and whereas, in
the 1980s, one required several millimoles of product to characterise, now this can be done with femtomoles or
in some cases attomoles (10 moles)! Therefore, one need only recover product from 1 bead, about 2-3
picomoles. Automated systems are now being developed to synthesise on single magnetic beads using only 2-3
nanolitres of reagent per cycle. When the classical Tea-bag strategy was developed, 100 millilitres per cycle
were considered to be a phenomenal solvent cost-cutting exercise.
70
A book for IELTS
Test 2 Reading Tests
L. The development of high-through-put automated screening has demanded from synthetic chemistry large arrays
or libraries of compounds to satisfy the investment made in installing these systems. Will combinatorial
chemistry be able to meet this demand? Are the syntheses well enough developed to meet this? Peptide and
oligonucleotide solid phase strategies have been well developed over the past 30 years. Will solution methods
and other novel chemistries be able to keep apace? Can virtual chemicals be used to remedy real problems?
After all, we are living in a real world.
QUESTI ONS 15- 20
Complete the text below, which is a summary of paragraphs A- E. Choose your answers from the Word
List and write them in Boxes 15- 20 on your answer sheet.
Exampl e: There is a wealth of_______ (Exampl e)_______ to
combi natori al chemi stry on the I nternet.
Answer: references
There are more words than spaces, so you will not be able to use them all. You may use each word only
once.
How Combinatori al Chemistry began
Combinatorial chemistry as an_____ 15____ of synthetic organic chemistry has
been very much_____ 16_____ in recent years, ______ 17_____ in a plethora of
articles written by experts in the field. Moreover, all the reviews in specialist
publications _____ 18_____ the same formula. But what about the origin of
combinatorial chemistry? It comes from permutation and combination problems in
mathematics.______19_____ solid phase peptide synthesis was developed, synthetic
peptide chemists started doing similar calculations as well. The 20 naturally occurring
amino acids provided them with _____ 20_____ possibilities.
QUESTI ONS 21- 25
known
limitless
offspring
usually follow
as
Word List
in vogue
in the air
until
offshoot
follow religiously
appeanng
once
doubled
limited
references
Look at paragraphs I and J which describe the Tea- bag method. Using the information in the passage,
complete the flow chart below. Write your answers in Boxes 21- 25 on your answer sheet. Use NO
MORE THAN THREE WORDS for each answer.
A book for IELTS
71
Reading Tests
Test 2
I n the Te*-bag method,
special solid supports are placed
in 21 ,
And, finally, the product
is separated, and
---------25-----------
as required.
whi ch are then closed by
_____22_____ .
During the process, the
sacs are moved from
_____ 24______
Chemical bonding occurs on the
solid supports, i.e. on the
_____ 23______
QUESTI ONS 26- 28
Below is a list of the regular types of contributor to combinatorial chemistry reviews. Which three
contributors are described by the writer? Write your answers A- F in the order they occur in the text in
Boxes 26- 28 on the answer sheet.
A A director of a technology business park.
B Someone who is from a major company and involved directly in research.
C Someone who is involved in the new technology of combinatorial chemistry.
D An amateur chemist who synthesises thousands of compounds per week.
E The director of a small, obscurely located and investment funded operation.
F An out-of-practice director of some major chemical enterprise.
QUESTI ON 29
Choose the appropriate letter (A- D) and write it in Box 29 on your answer sheet.
29. Physical chemistry ...
A deals with the way physics is applied to chemical behaviour.
B is closely connected with organic chemistry.
C deals with the way chemistry is applied to physical behaviour.
D led to the development of combinatorial chemistry.
72
A book for IELTS
Test 2 Reading Tests
You should spend about 20 minutes on Questions 30- 4 1, which are based on P assage 3 below.
Ice and Fire
The poet W.H. Auden once wrote: ' To me I cel and is sacred soil. I t s memory is a constant
background to what I am doing. I t is a permanent part of my exi stence. I could say t hat
I cel and is t he sun col ouring t he mountai ns wi thout being anywhere in si ght, even sunk beyond
the horizon ...' . The extraordi nary and lasting effect t hat this small island of 270,000 inhabi tants
invari ably has on its vi sitors is as eni gmatic as t he land itself. Those once intoxicated by it are
likely to become addicts for life; those who recoil in horror at t he bl eak lava fields, which
surround its ai rport, may never return.
I cel and is as di stant in topographical character, modes of life and at ti t udes from its Nordic
nei ghbours on t he Scandinavian mainland as it is geographically. I sol ated f ar north- west in the
North Atl antic, its real neighbours are Greenl and and t he Arctic ice- cap. Far from t he forested
mountai ns of Norway or t he f l at lakes of Fi nland, its geol ogi cal ly young l andscape is constantl y
being carved by t he acti vity of ice and fire. Volcanoes, glaci ers and 700 years of Danish colonial
rule have i mpoverished the land, but enriched t he human spirit.
I n its cultural history, I cel and has enj oyed no heri tage of court patronage, no i nterfertili sati on
with t he European Renaissance, Baroque or Enli ghtenment. Yet, from t he first murmurings' of
nati onal affi rmati on in t he l atter hal f of t he ni neteenth century to full i ndependence in 194 4 ,
cultural acti vity has sprung up like t he geysers which shoot high from t he country's geothermal
energy sources j ust under t he earth' s crust.
Reykj avi k can now boast as many as 60 musical events per month; it has t wo lively theatres,
an opera company and a flourishi ng and internati onall y respected fil m industry. Much I cel andi c
art articulates t he sense of danger f el t in living in a country with at l east 30 live vol canoes:
when one erupted under a gl aci er in the autumn of 1996, t he subsequent floodi ng swept away
roads and bri dges to t he tune of six million pounds. And, despite a sophisticated system of
damage l imi tati on, maveri ck avalanches can destroy enti re settlements.
Stubbornness, a superiori ty compl ex which can, in moments of crisis or loss of confi dence,
qui etly veer towards its opposite, and a laconically obl ique vi ew of life characterises t he typical
I cel ander, if such a creature exists. A determi nati on to protect and develop a l anguage basically
unchanged since t he t i me of t he Sagas has led I cel and to coin its own new words for
tel ephone, television, radio and computer. When gas pipes are laid, t he homes of el ves and
trolls are respectfully by- passed.
One such detour is there for those who have eyes to see on t he mai n route from t he ai rport to
Reykjavik city centre. Nobody, though, should feel i nti midated. Regul ar buses connect all towns
and settl ements around t he country' s mai n ring- road: t he central wil derness, stunning in its
landscape of bl ack volcanic desert and brown glacial morai nes, can be traversed only for a few
weeks in t he summer, when t he snow has mel ted but floods have abated. Few rivers there
have bridges.
Four- wheel - dri ve vehicles, careful research, a good radio, and a sense of humour are essential
travel li ng companions - unless, like the first travel lers to I cel and, including Wil li am Morris and
W.H. Auden, a convoy of sturdy I cel andi c horses is preferred. And, as t he old saying goes: ' I f
you get lost in an I cel andi c forest, j ust stand up.'
A book for IELTS
73
Reading Tests Test 2
QUESTI ON 30
Choose the appropriate letter A- D and write it in Box 30 on your answer sheet.
30. Which of the following is true concerning transport on Iceland?
A All the settlements and towns in Iceland are linked by four-wheel-drive vehicles.
B Sturdy Icelandic horses are needed to get round all parts of Iceland.
C All the settlements and towns on the main ring-road are linked by a bus service.
D A fleet of coaches serves the entire island.
QUESTI ONS 31- 36
Do the statements below agree with the information given by the writer in Readi ng P assage 3?
In boxes 31- 36, write:
Yes if the statement agrees with the information in the passage
No if the statement contradicts the information in the passage
Not Given if no information is given about the statement in the passage
31. The natural features of Iceland are in a state of continual transformation.
32. Iceland is a Danish colony.
33. Iceland is not dissimilar, from the topographical point of view, to Scandinavian countries
on the continent.
34 . Some people are horrified by the starkness of the landscape around the airport.
35. The majority of people who visit Iceland are intoxicated by it for life.
36. The author is intoxicated by Iceland.
QUESTI ONS 37- 39
Answer the questions below using NO MORE THAN FOUR WORDS from the passage.
37. What is the state of the Icelandic movie business?
38. To what is the growth of cultural activity in recent decades compared?
39. What does much Icelandic art reflect about life in Iceland?
QUESTI ONS 4 0 & 4 1
Complete the sentences below. You may use NO MORE THAN THREE WORDS taken directly from the
passage, or based on the information in the passage.
4 0. Avalanches can destroy entire settlements, although a system has been set up
to_______________ .
4 1. Icelanders are intent on________________ their language.
Reading
Test 3
A book for IELTS
75
Reading Tests Test 3
You should spend about 20 minutes on Questions 1- 15, which are based on P assage 1 below.
THE ALEXANDER TECHNI QUE AND DI SABI LI TY
A. The Alexander Technique is a method of psychophysical re-education developed by F. Matthias
Alexander more than a century ago, initially as a result of trying to solve a vocal problem. It is a -
technique for the elimination of ingrained habits of 'misuse' that interfere with the healthy and
harmonious functioning of ourselves as a whole, often the underlying cause of many conditions,
such as back pain, neck and shoulder tension, fatigue, breathing disorders and other stress-related
illnesses.
B. Our natural reflex mechanisms for balance and posture are largely dependent on the co-ordination
of the head, neck and back. The Technique addresses the causes of 'misuse' and lack of poise that
may be interfering with this relationship. When these mechanisms are allowed to work in harmony,
'good use' spontaneously returns, resulting in easier breathing, freer, lighter movement and a
greater ability to control our reactions and our movements. In other words, the Technique enables
us to 'use' ourselves better, and, in that sense, is concerned with helping anybody - the so called
'able bodied' as well as disabled people to overcome their disabilities. Hence, the Alexander
teacher's approach when working with the disabled is, in essence, the same as with any pupil of
the Technique.
C. For example, if we take a violinist with a 'misuse' problem of the upper limbs causing technical
limitations to his or her playing, the Alexander teacher will work on improving the pupil's overall
'use' by encouraging the inhibition of the habitual muscular tension pattern that interferes with
the co-ordination of the head/neck/back relationship in order to enable him/her to play with more
ease. Similarly, when working with a pupil who has lost mobility in the left arm from a stroke, the
teacher will first of all address the head/neck/back relationship, and the inhibition of extraneous
tension that prevents maximum use of the affected limb. In this way, it is possible to enable the
stroke patient to retrain mobility of the paralysed part of the body.
D. The approach and what results can be expected vary greatly depending on the disability. For the
stroke patient, especially if lessons are commenced early after the stroke, the Alexander Technique
can play an important role in rehabilitation and mobility retraining. With a blind person, the work
is likely to focus instead more directly on eliminating tension habits that have developed to
compensate for the loss of sight, e.g. insecurity leading to stiff and overcautious walking, balancing
difficulties and poor head poise.
E. Working with the disabled pupil, the Alexander teacher can offer help with everyday activities,
things that the average person takes for granted, such as the ability to brush one's teeth, shave,
tie one's shoelaces or cut a slice of bread. By looking at compensatory tension patterns, the teacher
can, in many instances, help the disabled person find a new means whereby they can perform
these everyday tasks.
F. In this respect, the lessons may extend to include the disabled person's carer, for example the
person who regularly has to help someone in and out of a wheelchair. Using the Alexander
Technique, the carer learns not only to lift and give support in the most efficient way to avoid
damaging his/her own back, but, as the two learn together, they also become better skilled at
working out strategies enabling the disabled person to become more independent.
G. There are, of course, several factors which have to be taken into consideration when working with
disabled pupils. They may suffer intense pain and discomfort, loss of Kinaesthetic awareness
(sometimes with total loss of sensitivity in parts of the body), severe lack of co-ordination, loss of
mobility, memory loss, blindness, deafness, and speech impairment. The effect this has on the
person's emotional and psychological state also has to be taken into account. Some disabled pupils
may need longer lessons, because of the time required to move them from the wheelchair, take
off casts, slings and other movement aids, etc. Others may only be able to concentrate for short
periods of time and, therefore, require shorter lessons more frequently. It often requires a certain
amount of inventiveness on the part of the Alexander teacher, both as far as practical arrangements
and the approach to teaching are concerned, a challenge that, in most cases, is greatly rewarded
by the positive results.
76
A book for IELTS
Test 3 Reading Tests
QUESTI ONS 1- 5
Reading P assage 1 has seven paragraphs (A- G).
Choose the most suitable heading from the List of Headings below. Write the appropriate numbers
(i - xi i ) in Boxes 1- 5 on your answer sheet. Paragraphs C and G have been done for you.
List of Headings
i Co-ordination - important for ali
ii Tension and daily routine
iii Brushing ones teeth and slicing bread
iv Fitting the technique to the disability
v Challenges for the Alexander teacher
vi Musical solutions
vii Potential drawbacks
viii Helping the disabled through their helpers
ix Pain problems
x Better body use for all
xi Retraining limbs
xii Breaking bad habits
Complete the summary below using information from the passage. You may use no more than two
words from the passage for each blank. Write your answers in Boxes 6- 14 on your answer sheet.
Example: Alexander Matthias_______ (Example)_______ the technique named after him
more than a hundred years ago.
Answer: developed.
With the Alexander Technique, people are_______6_______ in a psychophysical way. The
Technique works on the bodys _______7_______ so that they all operate_______ 8_______ .
As a result, bad habits are_______9_______ and the individual is able to live a healthy life.
Alexanders technique can help any of us to _____ 10_______ ourselves better. As
regards ________11______ person, the expected results and exact method used vary,
according to the_______ 12_______ of the individual, e.g. shorter and more regular sessions
in the case of clients who find it difficult to concentrate. With disabled clients, in fact, a number
of_______ 13_______ have to be considered, and for the teacher, who often needs to be very
inventive, this is_______ 14_______ .
QUESTI ON 15
Does the statement below agree with the information given in Reading P assage 1?
Yes if the statement agrees with the information in the text
No if the statement contradicts the information in the text
Not Given if there is no information about the statement in the text
15. The success rate of the Alexander Technique in working with stroke victims is high.
1. Paragraph A
2. Paragraph B
P aragraph C Answer: (xi)
3. Paragraph D
4. Paragraph E
5. Paragraph F
P aragraph G Answer: (v)
QUESTI ONS 6- 14
A book for IELTS
77
Reading Tests Test 3
You should spend about 20 minutes on Questions 16- 28, which are based on P assage 2 below.
Science, Technology and the third Millennium:
Change, Progress, Fear & Complacency
The 20th Century is drawing to a close, merging rapidly and imperceptibly with its successor - the first 100 years ,
of the Third Millennium. It will deliver an awesome inheritance: a world propelled by science and technology; a
world where incredible and accelerating discovery will create changes beyond the scope of our wildest
speculations; a world where science and technology have placed What Is Possible beyond What We Can Imagine.
History may well dub the 1900s The Century of Change - the era when science and technology forged a
permanent partnership and unleashed the first products of their unique alliance on a largely illiterate, earthbound
civilisation. The Industrial Revolution provided the impetus for action and cast the die for the future; two world
wars, fought only a generation apart and before 1950, accelerated the process. Life changed quickly and irreversibly
- like a moth shedding its cocoon.
Within one life span, top-hatted physicians, gas lamps and horse-drawn transport gave way to transplant
surgery, laser beams and space travel. The speed of change and the volume of knowledge defied measurement.
Early attempts to do so reflected growing concerns about possible adverse effects on established social values and
systems. One widely circulated document estimated that mankinds total knowledge doubled first between the
years 1 AD and 1900; again by 1950; and again by 1960. After that, even the best would-be assessors gave up,
many of them becoming management consultants. The new profession flourished as modem business faced
rampant stress caused by inexorable change, and cut-throat competition in the global marketplace. Change and
Progress became popular themes for training workshops.
Change is often presented as progress. To act on this misconception (as too frequently happens!) is to court
disaster. Progress implies change with benefit. It reflects action taken only after management has considered
relevant past experiences, current priorities and future objectives. Change for changes sake may reflect the
response of a novice manager, or of one more senior who wishes to impress an advisory committee. Technology
can convincingly disguise poor drafting styles or a proposals lack of substance, but its healing influence does not
extend to the application of a plan itself. Delays, increased costs, confusion and low staff morale often follow
change without benefit. Sadly, solutions offered to such problems are inevitably, further change!
The age of push-button miracles has not eradicated boredom. In the 1960s, the world held its breath as live
television and radio transmitted the first lunar landing. Many in the worldwide audience viewed and listened from
the comfort of their homes. Technology had deftly demonstrated passive participation and predicted couch
potatoes. Local cinemas and sports grounds would close. As the astronauts bounced across the ghostly moonscape
and joked with each other and Earth, they demolished a primeval barrier: science fiction became fact. And anything
imaginable became possible - perhaps worse, inevitable. For many participants, the mystery and magic of fantasy
vanished forever - like a childs perception of Christmas. Technology had become commonplace, its wonders
explicable and predictable.
The second moon expedition raised little public excitement. It was, after all, a repeat performance, sure of
success. In the 1970s and 80s, repeated success itself bred complacency. But...! Nearly 30 years later, a space
shuttle exploded during the launch and the crew perished. Their deaths provoked intense, but short-term, shock.
Commentators soon reflected a popular view: that such accidents, although unfortunate, were also inevitable. The
astronauts had known and had accepted the risks; NASA could be proud of its record and rest on its laurels - until
the next catastrophe.
Today, as we face a new Millennium, technology and science are simultaneously feared, admired and taken
for granted. Enthusiasts and critics alike, increasingly depend on them. In education, for example, computer-based
programmes are replacing textbooks, blackboards and tutors; the Internet bridges time and distance and provides
access to specialist resources. Factors such as the need for skilled and costly support services are rarely discussed.
The principles of learning are established: the way they may be best used in different settings and the results
evaluated will vary with client needs. But, no matter how good, no one method can satisfy all the needs of any
one client. Books, theatre and technology go well together.
The Third Millennium will open the door to a future filled with a kaleidoscope of scientific and technical
wizardry. We have, without resistance, grown very dependent on such attractions. Few of us differentiate between
simple and complex uses of technology. The former used routinely (e.g. simple mental arithmetic) may deskill us
and increase our dependency - without our being aware of any danger. Artificial intelligence, human cloning and
the unimaginable are no longer science fiction.
78
A book for IELTS
Test 3 Reading Tests
The time has come to reassess our relationship with science and technology to review the first 100 years and
plan ahead. We must reaffirm our roles as creators and directors of that future and help realise its human potential.
Without such effort, we may find ourselves victims of our inherent intelligence, curiosity and imagination - and
a rather curious complacency.
QUESTI ONS 16- 19
Using NO MORE THAN THREE WORDS from the text, answer the following questions:
16. According to the author, who or what became partners in the 1900s?
17. Something about the speed of change and the volume of knowledge was elusive. What was it?
18. What was the main contributory factor to the growth of the management consultancy profession, as
world markets changed?
19. What does progress have that change does not?
QUESTI ONS 20- 23
Choose the most appropriate letters A- D and write them in Boxes 20- 23 on your answer sheet.
20. Progress can be seen as action taken after
consideration of...
A company priorities for the future.
B the past, the present and the future.
C mistakes made in the past.
D experiences and objectives.
21. Some types of manager...
A are always changing things.
B make changes for no apparent reason.
C try to increase staff morale.
D try to impress their colleagues.
22. When the first lunar landing happened,...
A many people were watching it at home.
B fact became fiction.
C a lot of people thought it was a joke.
D science fiction became like Christmas.
23. The space shuttle explosion showed that
A nothing is exciting anymore.
B TV can show shocking things as well
as exciting ones.
C accidents are bound to happen.
D the astronauts were to blame.
QUESTI ONS 24 - 28
The text mentions a number of current and future developments. State whether the developments in
Questions 24 - 28 below are:
C current, as mentioned in the text.
F future, as mentioned in the text.
NG not mentioned as current or future in the text.
24 . machines taking the place of teachers.
25. a life filled with a variety of magical gadgetry.
26. recognition of the need for expensive, yet necessary support services.
27. an adaptation of learning principles to fit different situations.
28. a re-evaluation of our relationship with the world of science.
A book for IELTS
79
Reading Tests Test 3
You should spend about 20 minutes on Questions 29- 4 2, which are based on P assage 3 below.
A note on the national minimum wage debate
A. Much of the literature on the minimum wage has as its main theme the question of whether or not
the introduction of a national minimum wage reduces employment. The empirical evidence on this
point comes mainly from America and is contradictory and inconclusive. This does not, however,'
prevent the political debate from using the economic evidence. Advocates from both sides do so,
with some rhetorical force, despite its contentious nature.
B. The proposition that jobs might be destroyed by higher wages follows directly from neo-classical
economic theory. However, the empirical studies display findings that are rather milder than theory
would expect. A review of such studies by Card and Krueger (1995) concluded that minimum wages
had no effect on employment; this despite the evidence of Neumark and Wascher (1992) that the
negative effect comes through strongly when teenagers are isolated in the sample. This notion was
supported by a later study which showed that teenagers were more likely to be enticed away from
education by the higher wages ensuing from statutory minimum wage legislation (Neumark and
Wascher 1995).
C. Critics of neutral and slightly positive evidence claim that studies cannot, by definition, take account
of companies driven out of business by minimum wages. Whilst this is true, a more substantial
criticism of the literature would be the dearth of studies based on local labour markets and on those
of specific industries. Such studies as exist show a clearer picture - which could be summarised as
demonstrating a small negative effect on jobs, but, more importantly, showing the strategic
processes which managers use to cope with an imposed rise in the price of labour. Certain types of
service industry, for example, can show positive employment effects (Alpert 1986).
D. The irony here is that the best evidence is furthest away from the political debate, which, by its
very nature, uses a national perspective. Unfortunately, the contentious nature of the evidential
base, which is so unhelpful to the jobs argument, permeates into other areas. For example, if the
jobs argument is unresolved, then those arguments surrounding the saving to be made on the
payment of social benefits to low paid workers hardly get off the ground, because, if jobs are
destroyed, unemployment benefit costs rise and offset the savings on income support. Critics of the
minimum wage would, of course, argue that it only benefits people who have a job and, therefore,
does nothing for unemployment. Advocates, on the other hand, would contend that income support
benefits are a wasteful subsidy to bademployers who are, in effect, gaining a competitive advantage
over more responsible employers. In this argument, the minimum wage would encourage better
market functioning and more competitive conditions than the subsidies that prop-up bad employers.
They would go even further and point to continental Europe, where minimum wage statutes
abound, to suggest that minimum wages are an incentive to develop training. Exactly why this
should be so escapes British management, who appear to need a better translation of the text of
this argument. However, one point that is well understood is that a national minimum wage could
cause a run of differential-maintaining pay claims. The fact that the beneficiaries of a minimum
wage usually lack bargaining power (Lucas 1995) and that they are unlikely to be a reference group
for any sector of organised labour, takes the edge off this argument.
E. The EEC has recently tossed a new coin into the ring; the notion of maximum working hours per
week. So far this has not touched the minimum wage debate, but the connection is inevitable. A
new set of arguments about overtime and shorter hours is about to break through. Whether the
poor can best be helped by a minimum wage, or a maximum working week, is a matter for empirical
evidence. Whatever the evidence is, it will not stop the political debate from maintaining a national
perspective. This is a pity, because an increment for the poor does not go on luxury items and foreign
holidays. It is spent on the home and on small scale leisure activities in the local market.
Furthermore, if adjustments in taxation to help small business through a sudden rise in labour
costs are contemplated, they are best executed through local rather than national government. To
paraphrase an American political slogan: its the localeconomy stupid.
80
A book for IELTS
Test 3 Reading Tests
QUESTI ONS 29- 32
Use the information in the text to match the authors (A- D) with the Findings (29- 32) below. Write the
appropriate letters (A- D) in Boxes 29- 32 on your answer sheet.
A Neumark & Wascher
B Alpert
C Lucas
D Card & Krueger
Findings
29. The economic influence of those who would benefit most from a minimum wage is not great
enough to affect wage differentials.
30. A minimum wage does not influence the number of people who find employment.
31. The beneficial effects of a minimum wage have been observed in some service industries.
32. A minimum wage appears not to have a positive impact as regards teenagers.
QUESTI ONS 33- 39
The diagram below summarises some of the main points on the minimum wage provided in paragraphs
B- D. Complete the diagram with information from the passage. You may use NO MORE THAN THREE
WORDS to fill each blank space. Write your answers in Boxes 33- 39 on your answer sheet.
A book for IELTS
81
Reading Tests Test 3
QUESTI ONS 4 0- 4 2
Choose the appropriate letters A- D and write them in Boxes 4 0- 4 2 on your answer sheet.
4 0. Critics of the minimum wage argue that...
A it makes services more expensive.
B it only helps those already in work.
C it causes inflation.
D it affects exports.
4 1. According to the writer, the fiscal counterbalance to increased costs should be ...
A at national level.
B through Income Tax.
C through VAT.
D at local level.
4 2. There is a lack of studies based ...
A on international industries.
B on the national economy.
C on local labour markets.
D on specific locations.
82
A book for IELTS
Reading
Test 4
A book for IELTS
83
Reading Tests Test 4
You should spend about 20 minutes on Questions 1- 14 , which are based on P assage 1 below.
HOW THE PAULI EXCLUSION PRINCIPLE
All stars (like plants and animals) evolve, with each one
following the same general pattern of evolution. Their
journey along the evolutionary path, and ultimate fate at
stellar death, is determined by their initial mass, which is
measured in multiples of the solar mass of our own Sun.
Perturbations of nebulous interstellar clouds in space
result in gravitational interaction, with the consequent
contraction of gaseous matter to create protostars, which
are much larger than the stars they will finally become.
As the temperature increases, the gas becomes
completely ionised to form plasma and gravitational
contraction of the core then takes place. The onset of
hydrogen-burning happens at a core temperature of
several million degrees, and converts hydrogen to helium
through nuclear fusion. The greater part of a stars
evolutionary lifetime is spent hydrogen-burning and,
during this period, it is said to be on the Main Sequence.
The end of hydrogen-burning is marked by the evolution
of a star into a red giant, when it is said to leave the Main
Sequence. Burning ceases completely in the core, which
undergoes gravitational contraction to maintain
mechanical equilibrium.
Now, the Pauli Exclusion Principle states that no two
identical particles can occupy the same quantum state
(Kaufmann, 1994): that is, loosely, they cannot have the
same spatial location and momentum. This principle is
important in determining the ultimate fate of stars.
Consider low Main Sequence mass stars (that is, stars
of less than three solar masses) which have passed
through the hydrogen-burning phase to helium-burning.
Such bodies require extreme compression of the core to
raise their temperature sufficiently for the onset of
helium-burning. Increasing density of electrons occurs,
so that they are squashed into close proximity with each
other, until a limit is reached when they resist any further
compression. This phenomenon is called degeneracy,
and is a manifestation of the Pauli Exclusion Principle.
Resistance to further compression results in
degenerate-electron pressure which supports the core,
preventing its contraction. However, this pressure is
independent of temperature, and remains constant while
the temperature continues to increase. Helium ignition
takes place and the thermonuclear reaction proceeds at
an increasing rate until a helium-flash occurs. The
temperature is so great that degeneracy cannot be
maintained: the core suddenly expands with a
corresponding decrease in temperature that abruptly
REGULATES THE EVOLUTION OF STARS
ends the helium-flash. This cycle may be repeated until
all the core helium is converted to carbon.
More massive stars do not undergo a helium-flash.
Moreover, their cores are sufficiently massive for further
element-burning to occur, until they, too, reach a limit
imposed by degeneracy. That is, as the product of each
phase of element-burning is always nuclei of greater
mass, it requires even greater compression of the core
remnant in order to raise the temperature sufficiently high
enough to initiate the next phase. Such compression can
only occur until the degenerate condition is achieved.
Stellar death comes about when the core cannot carry
out further element-burning, because of its degenerate
nature. Stars of Main Sequence mass less than seven
solar masses become white dwarfs. The stability of a
white dwarf is only maintained if its final (post-Main
Sequence) mass does not exceed the Chandrasekhar
Limit of 1.4 solar masses. Degenerate-electron pressure
supports the core against collapse, thereby conforming
to the Principle.
Neutron stars are the stellar corpses of stars whose Main
Sequence mass is between seven and twenty solar
masses. Before death, these stars have undergone
some further element-burning and the final core mass
exceeds the Chandrasekhar Limit. This is too great for
degenerate-electron pressure to prevent collapse of the
core: electrons and protons are crushed together to form
neutrons and neutrinos. Gravitational collapse continues
until degeneracy equilibrium is achieved once more. It is
degenerate-neutron pressure that halts the collapse,
and, thereby, upholds the Principle.
The most massive stars have completed burning to
obtain an iron core, and have a Main Sequence mass
exceeding twenty solar masses. This is so great that
degenerate-neutron pressure cannot support it, and
rapid collapse ensues. Since density is inversely
proportional to volume and the mass is vast, then, as the
volume dwindles, the density tends to infinity and a Black
Hole is formed.
Black Holes are a violation of Paulis Exclusion Principle.
If the Principle did not regulate the evolution of stars,
nothing would prevent the inexorable collapse of an
interstellar cloud from its initial disturbance into a
massive Black Hole.
84
A book for IELTS
Test 4 Reading Tests
QUESTI ONS 1- 7
The flow chart below summarises P aragraph 2. Complete the chart with information from the passage
and write your answers in Boxes 1- 7 on your answer sheet.
You may use NO MORE THAN THREE WORDS to complete each space.
Choose the appropriate letters A- D and write them in Boxes 8- 11 on your answer sheet.
8. What can be said about degeneracy? 10. Which of the following is true of the largest
A It violates the Pauli Exclusion Principle.
stars, but not of smaller ones?
B It is not dependent upon temperature. A Compression of their core is halted by degeneracy.
C It is the point where the core of a star withstands
B Their core becomes iron.
further compression.
C Their fate is stellar death.
D It happens to most, but not all stars. D They undergo a helium flash.
9. According to the Pauli Exclusion Principle,...
11. What affects the development of all stars?
A no two stars are the same. A Their stellar death.
B low mass stars do not degenerate.
B Their evolutionary path.
C it is not possible for two identical particles to be
C Their mass when they are first formed.
D
in the same space at the same time.
when a star is compressed, the temperature and
the pressure rise.
D Their size when compared to our own Sun.
QUESTI ONS 12- 14
Use information from the passage to complete the table below. Use No More Than Two Words for each
space. _ _ _ _ _ _________________ _______ __________________________
Stars with main sequence mass of turn into
Less than 7
12
Between 7-20 13
20+
14
A book for IELTS
85
Reading Tests
Test 4
You should spend about 20 minutes on Questions 15- 28, which are based on P assage 2
ENVY WITHOUT REASON?
A Do you come from a culture which places emphasis on the emotion of envy? Without a doubt,
envy is something that we all feel at some time in our lives. The Concise Oxford Dictionary lists envy
as resentful or admiring contemplation o f more fortunate person. Instead of sharing in the joy
of a new job, car or party dress, a friend either pretends she or he has not noticed the fantastic
new BMW or says Mercedes are better. But does it matter? In many parts of the world, the
personal satisfaction felt by those who prosper is tinged with concerns about the ill-will which
success provokes in friends, and even family members. Envy becomes something to be feared,
for it may have the power to cause harm.
B The Swahili people of Coastal East Africa take envy very seriously. They frequently feel the need
to hide or minimise personal success. Hence, boasting can be a dangerous pastime. Envy
emanates from neighbours, friends and family. After all, a stranger does not care if you have
managed to replace your thatched roof with corrugated iron. But those Swahili who have struggled
to build houses which are a little better than their neighbours often paint on the front of their
houses the slogan, hasidi hana sababu: this means envy without reason. The slogan seems to be
a forlorn attempt to remind neighbours and any envious passers-by that the apparent good
fortune indicated by a superior house has been earned. The message is that there is no reason
for envy, and that those harbouring ill-will should control their feelings. The successful are
pleading to be allowed to succeed.
C In Swahili culture, and many others, envy emanates from the eye of the beholder. The Evil Eye,
as a source of harm to those who fall under its gaze, is reported throughout much of the world.
Indeed, according to Brian Spooner, an expert on the various ways used to keep envy at bay, the
idea of the Evil Eye is so widespread that it can be regarded as a universal phenomenon. In the
parts of Europe that border the Mediterranean, in the Middle East and North Africa, the wearing
of pendants depicting one large eye is a popular way of repelling envy.
D Ideas about the Evil Eye moved from the Mediterranean to the New World of America. Atwood
Gaines has traced the origin of beliefs about the Evil Eye as a cause of sickness from Spain to
Mexico, Haiti and Puerto Rica. The illnesses caused by the Evil Eye are given specific names such
as susto. In such cases, the Evil Eye is suspected after an illness or misfortune has already occurred.
E Marcia Inhorn has written about the Evil Eye in Egypt. There, women may attribute infertility
and other health problems to the envy of neighbours or friends. But in the Middle East, as
elsewhere, envy can occur in many settings. Hence, at the end of an important meeting to discuss
a research study, the head of the project noticed that her best silk suit had white marks on both
the jacket and skirt. It was ruined. She worked out that after the sumptuous lunch, which had
preceded the meeting, the table had been cleaned with bleach. She had then brushed against the
table. Nobody elses clothes were damaged. Her Palestinian colleague suggested that envy,
harboured by an unknown acquaintance, had ruined her suit. The grounds for envy were either
her beautiful clothes or her powerful position within the research team.
F Some social scientists argue that envy is widespread in societies where resources are scarce and
one persons gain is considered anothers loss. The reasoning behind this theory o f envy is that,
when people are poor and in competition with each other, they believe that there is not enough
good food, good fortune or good jobs to go around. G M Foster studied peasant society in Latin
America and propounded the image o f limited good. According to his theory, when somebody
from a family or village prospers, they use up part of a stock of limited good and reduce the
chances of the success of others. Foster sees the image o f limited good as operating in peasant
societies where people know and compete with each other in adverse economic conditions.
However, the theory may hold good for many other social and economic contexts. Take
86
A book for IELTS
Test 4 Reading Tests
scholarships, for example. There are only so many to go round. If your best friend gets the
scholarship, your chances of getting one too may be greatly reduced.
G Western psychoanalysts have also studied envy. Melanie Klein sees envy as an emotion felt by
the breastfeeding infant towards its mothers breast. Although the infant feels love and gratitude
towards its mother, it also wants the goodness of the milk for itself. Some of these scholars,
unlike everyday speakers of English, are careful to distinguish between envy and jealousy. Swahili
people make the same distinction. Jealousy is a triangular relationship. For example, two friends
spend all their free time together until one takes a lover. The neglected friend grows jealous of
the affection lavished on the new lover. When there is jealousy, three people are involved. Envy,
on the other hand, is more straightforward: one person envies anothers achievement, quality or
possession. While most English people do not take envy seriously, it remains a matter of concern
to people worldwide. It makes ambition and the pursuit of success more difficult, and some
would say, dangerous. Many seek ways to avoid falling victim to envy. How do you deal with it?
QUESTI ONS 15- 20
Reading P assage 2 below has seven paragraphs (A- G).
Choose the most suitable heading for each paragraph from the List of Headi ngs below. Write the
appropriate numbers (i - xv) in Boxes 15- 20 on your answer sheet.
P aragraph D has been done for you as an example.
Please note that you may use each heading only once.
Example
15. P aragraph A
16. P aragraph B
17. P aragraph C
P aragraph D
18. P aragraph E
19. P aragraph F
20. P aragraph G
Answer: viii
List of Headings
i Breastfeeding and envy
ii A victim of envy
iii A global remedy for envy
iv What is envy?
v The Evil Eye in Europe
vi Sharing success
vii No grounds for envy
viii Envy and illness
ix Envy where resources are limited
x The Swahili in Africa
xi The work of social scientists
xii Envy in relation to other emotions
xiii A dictionary definition of envy
xi v A universal phenomenon
xv Envy in poor societies
A book for IELTS
87
Reading Tests Test 4
QUESTI ONS 21- 24
Use the information in the text to match the people listed (21- 24 ) with the Concepts (i - vi i ).
Write the appropriate letter in Boxes 21- 24 on your answer sheet. Note that there are more concepts
than names, so you will not use all of them.
21. Brian Spooner
22. GM Foster
23. Melanie Klein
24. Atwood Gaines
CONCEP TS
i the idea that there is only so much good to go round in any one community
ii that there is a relationship between the Evil Eye and illness
iii the theory that the Evil Eye influences infertility
iv keeping envy at bay
V the concept of the Evil Eye being a universal phenomenon
vi the distinction between jealousy and envy
vii that babies envy their mothers milk
QUESTI ONS 25- 28
Complete the following sentences with information from the passage. Use NO MORE THAN THREE
WORDS to fill each blank space.
25. ___________________ people in society are often the victims of envy.
26. The Evil Eye is a ___________________ to those who come within its range.
27. Among the Swahili, boasting is a _____________________.
28. The Swahili on the East African coast often feel they have to conceal or__________________
88
A book for IELTS
Test 4 Reading Tests
You should spend about 20 minutes on Questions 29- 4 2, which are based on P assage 3 below.
Have you a tea-room?
We have all walked through modem office blocks where the workers are busily tapping away at keyboards.
They have their mugs of tea, or coffee, as they work. Some have a packet of something to nibble in the drawer;
but how do they manage to make one packet of chocolate digestives last one whole week? There is an area
by the wall somewhere with a water geyser perpetually on the boil, and a stack of mugs. There is a palpable
air of activity. Productivity must be booming, one thinks. But is it?
How many of these people work late of their own volition, want to obtain a result before going home, and
will beaver away happily until well after dark to achieve it? Damned few! Yes! It may seem wonderful to
have a constant flow of liquid refreshment at the desk, not to need a tea, or coffee, break - because the whole
working day is a tea break. Yet, who wants the tea when the ambience, all too often, is that of a concentration
camp?
Why not escape from the desk with a cup of tea from time to time? Perhaps, take your break in a comfortable
chair, talk about last nights football results or discuss work, seek or offer advice, arrange a game of squash,
play bridge. Or, network and enjoy some refreshment at the same time!
What will the Boss say, however? If he has any sense, he will also come and join you. Perhaps, he supports
another team? You can discuss the merits of the players and show him how competently you can present a
case. He will realise that the tea-room is an ideal place for informal meetings with his staff, where any number
of day-to-day problems can be sorted out over a cup of tea, and where anyone who needs a tender warning
about something can be quietly given it without the march to The Office. If, as a consequence, the
communication process improves, the boss may even dispense with a layer of middle management twixt
you and himself. He will then no longer need to have expensive Off-site Meetings, where his middle managers
experience Free Expression. He can spend some of the savings on light refreshments for his staff to enjoy!
If you, or a colleague, have a problem with some aspect of work, share it with everyone in the tea-room. One
of your colleagues will, doubtless, have had similar difficulties in the past and will have discovered a
ridiculously simple solution. To your surprise, you will find he is more than happy to share his experience
and answers with you over a cup of tea. Both of you will then go back to your desks with added commitment
and make a positive contribution to the work of the group.
Every team has its specialists. They are normal people in their everyday lives, but there are those special
situations where they seem to excel all the time. It may be that they format new documentation with
consummate ease. Maybe, they can bake excellent butter sponge cakes decorated as fax machines .... The
true specialist can train anyone to fulfil his role.
Who will be trained? Keen, eager, people: the raw recruits. Released from the inhibitions of the office
environment in the relaxed atmosphere of a tea-room, they have the confidence to ask dumb questions. This
is, in fact, the best place to find solutions to problems; and conduct training. In the tea-room, old-hands, freed
temporarily from the modem technologies they often do not fully understand, will invariably offer advice.
These people, who know all about the way things happen and what the final product should look like, will
give free information communicated with an honest confidence. Why have lots of knowledge, if you cannot
share it effectively with others? The Boss should observe the information flow between these people.
Situations like these occur in tea-rooms worldwide every day. These are all natural human interactions. There
is much that can be said for the idea of fixed tea times during the working day away from ones precise place
of work. Suggesting this will make Asset Managers cringe. This room is only being used 4 hours a day!
But let us say we allow staff to enjoy staggered breaks. The morning coffee is between 10.00 and 11.00.
Lunch is sometime between 12.00 and 2.00. Afternoon tea is between 3.00 and 4.00. The tea-room can then
be used by time-conscious executives to have their meetings. And, since the room is required for refreshment,
these meetings must never over-run, unless they are scheduled after afternoon tea . ... Who wants to work
late anyway?
A book for IELTS
89
Reading Tests Test 4
QUESTI ONS 29- 33
Reading P assage 3 describes a number of I mpli cations for the working environment provided certain
Condi ti ons are met. Match each Condition (29- 33) in List A with its I mpli cation (A- l ) in List B.
There are more I mpli cations in List B than you will need, so you will not use all of them.
List A: Conditions List B: I mplications
29. Provided people share and
solve problems together,
30. If the atmosphere in the
tea-room is totally relaxed,
31. Should bosses relax with their
employees,
32. When tea-rooms are used as a
multi-purpose venue,
33. If communication between boss
and staff is improved,
A the tendency for meetings to over-run is avoided.
B the employer will recognise the positive contribution
to team-work.
C they will work harder as part of a team.
D a layer of management will perhaps be removed.
E some executives will be able to work later.
F more experienced staff will have an opportunity to
train the more inexperienced staff.
G they will see tea-rooms as an informal opportunity to
meet staff and solve problems.
H there will be more off-site meetings for middle
managers.
I the boss will see how information is exchanged
between staff members.
QUESTI ONS 34 - 38
Do the following statements agree with the views of the writer in Reading P assage 3?
In Boxes 34 - 38 write:
Yes if the statement agrees with the views of the writer
No if the statement contradicts the views of the writer
Not Given if it is impossible to say what the writer thinks about this
34 . A variety of snacks should be provided in tea-rooms.
35. It is surprising that office workers make a packet of chocolate digestives last for a week.
36. The writer suggests workers could, at times, change the setting for their tea breaks.
37. Specialists excel in their everyday lives.
38. Tea-rooms are the best places to ask facile questions.
QUESTI ONS 39- 4 2
Using NO MORE THAN TWO WORDS from the passage, answer the questions below. Write your
answers in Boxes 39- 4 2 on your answer sheet.
39. How many people voluntarily work late?
4 0. On what can the money saved by avoiding off-site meetings be spent?
4 1. What would Asset Managers do if the tea-room were used only 4 hours per day?
4 2. What do older and experienced people not always understand?
90
A book for IELTS
Section on
Writing
i
A book for IELTS
91
Section on Writing
I ntroduction to the Section on Writing
The writing section in the IELTS contains two tasks. Writing Task 1usually contains a diagram of some sort,
such as: a graph, a pie chart, a bar chart, a table or a combination of two or more of these items; a diagram
of a process; a map; or some other kind of diagram. You have to write at least 150 words and you are advised
to spend 20 minutes on this task. There is only one question, so you do not have a choice.
In Writing Task 2, you are asked to write an essay on an academic topic, about which no specialised
knowledge is required. The length of the essay should be at least 250 words. Again, there is no choice.
This section of the book contains 20 practice exercises for Writing Task 1, 4 exercises for Task 2 with 3
Writing Tests. The exercises all have a Key and for the tasks in the Tests there are model answers. Exercises
1--10 and Exercise 20 in the Section on Reading will also help you prepare for Writing Task 2. You may also
want to look at a book on writing1by Sam McCarter, published by IntelliGene, 1997.
Hints for Writing Task 1
You should train yourself to spend only 20 minutes on this task and to write the minimum number of words
you are asked to produce.
The language is academic and formal, so you need to avoid using informal language.
Many candidates are not very familiar with doing this kind of task. Quite often the difficulty they face lies in
interpreting the diagram or data given. There are many publications with statistical data in diagrammatic form
in libraries. Even if you do not write a description, you should study some of them and look for patterns of
organisation.
It is important that you learn to recognise what 150 words look like in your own hand-writing and that you
write at least the minimum number of words that are set. We would also advise you not to write too many
words, whether practising at home or in the exam.
Hints for Writing Task 2
Questions to ask yourself
In the examination itself, you will not have time to rewrite your essay. You should, therefore, learn to write in
such a way that you can avoid re-writing.
This does not mean, however, that you should not re-read carefully and correct what you have written. As
you prepare for the exam, you should re-read and correct each of your essays immediately after you have
written them so that by the time you take the IELTS this will be a natural thing to do.
Again, it is important that you learn to recognise what 250 words look like in your own hand-writing and that
you write at least the minimum number of words that are set. We would also advise you not to write too many
words, whether practising at home or in the exam.
Candidates often want to learn examples of essays that have occurred in the exam. This causes several
problems. First, the exam questions are quite long and, while it is possible to have an idea of the general
subject, it is often quite difficult to find out the exact focus of the essay question. Students frequently memorise
essays they have practised and reproduce them in the examination, not realising that the essay they are
writing does not have the same focus as the one on the exam paper. So beware!
More seriously, when you write down something from memory the number of mistakes can increase. Try
writing out one of the model essays in the Key for the Tests and see how many mistakes you make!
Below are some questions, you should ask yourself, both while you are writing the essay, and also while you
are re-reading and checking.
92
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
Essay titl e
1. Have I accurately identified the general subject and the focus in the title?
2. Am I clear about the organising word(s) in the essay title, i.e. do I understand exactly what I am being
asked to write about?
Organi sation
3. Is the structure of my essay clear: are there clear paragraph divisions?
4. As regards the introduction, have I connected it with the title of the essay?
5. Have each of my paragraphs got a clear topic sentence, and does each one deal with one main point?
6. Is my conclusion short and concise, and does it more or less repeat what I have written in my
introduction?
Content
7. Have I kept to the main theme of the essay? Or, have I made a mistake and strayed from the focus by
including points and examples that are not relevant?
8. Have I made my points clearly?
9. Have I helped the reader to understand the points I am making by giving clear examples, wherever
possible?
10. Am I completing the task I have been set?
11 .Is my essay going to be the right length i.e. more than 250 words?
Grammar
12.1s the structure of my sentences clear throughout, or are some of my sentences too long and
over-complicated, making my essay difficult to read?
13. Have I used appropriate and precise vocabulary?
14. Have I checked carefully to make sure that I have avoided making my mistakes , i.e. language errors
which I usually make in grammar, syntax and spelling.
Ask yourself the questions above each time you write an essay, while you are preparing for IELTS. Then, by
the time you take the exam, you should be better prepared.
A book for IELTS
93
Section on Writing
Graphs and Diagrams for Task 1
Exerci se 1: Looking for patterns
Many students have difficulty describing information or data in the form of charts, graphs, diagrams etc. There
are many reasons for this, but, perhaps, the main reason is that students have not been taught how to interpret
diagrams. They then cannot see the organisation and the underlying patterns, which means that, when they
describe a chart etc, they do not have a framework within which they can write. Their description turns out
to be nothing more than a list, or is just chaotic. This exercise helps you to recognise the organisation of
charts etc, and so give you a framework within which to write.
Before you do the exercise, look at the following example:
The bar chart below shows the results of a survey which asked people what they thought the main causes
of crime were. Study the chart and look for patterns to help you organise the information.
lack of school discipline
peer group pressure
famil y upbringing
lack of education
working parents
lack of facilities
unemployment
drug addiction
poor housing
boredom
poverty
0 10 20 30 4 0 50 60 70 80 90 100
You can organise the above data into three main categories, as follows:
- family upbringing - poverty
working parents unemployment
boredom
drug addiction
peer group pressure lack of education
poor housing
lack of school discipline
lack of facilities
94
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
Within this framework, it is then easier to describe and analyse. Your description can move from general
points to specific examples. For instance, according to the bar chart, people attribute crime to six causes
within the control of the Government. You can, therefore, compare this with the Family or the Individual. You
can then move deeper into the bar chart by giving specific examples from within the categories. You can also
compare examples within categories, or even across categories, thus moving from general to particular and
from particular to particular.
Another possible way to organise the data is:
You can then describe and analyse the data within the top band and then within the bottom band. You can
see that this approach is more simplistic than the framework above.
Now look at the diagrams and charts in this exercise. Remember that you are looking only for patterns and
ways to organise the data. You may find more than one way to do this. If you find the exercise difficult, look
at the Key and use it to help you understand how to organise data. Repeat the exercise several times so that
you can learn to recognise the mechanism.
The chart (Figure 1) below shows the results of a survey on the leisure activities in which a group of adults
in their early 20s participate.
WatchingTV
Reading books
Listening to CDs
Gardening
Home computer
Eveni ng classes
Visiting a sports centre
P laying wi th children
Voluntary Work
Reading newspapers
Walki ng
DI Y

f
/ / / \ \ \ \
0 10 20 30 4 0 50 60 70 80 90 100
Figure 1 Results of a survey on the leisure activities in which a group of adults in their early 20s participate.
A book for IELTS
95
Section on Writing
The chart (Figure 2) below shows the same leisure activities as for Figure 1above for a group of people in
their mid to late 60s.
WatchingTV
Reading books
Listening to CDs
Gardening
Home computer
Evening classes
Visiting a sports centre
P laying with children
Voluntary Work
Reading newspapers
Walking
DI Y
10 20 30 4 0 50 60 70 80 90 100
Figure 2 The same leisure activities as for Figure 1above for a group of people in their mid to late 60s.
Now look for patterns between Figures 1and 2.
The chart (Figure 3) below shows the sporting activities, in which a sample of inner-city teenagers participated.
Figure 3 The sporting activities, in which a sample of inner-city teenagers participated.
96
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
The graph (Figure 4) below shows the share price of three high-tech companies over a three-year period
from their launch.
The Berk
Figure 4 The share price of three high-tech companies over a three-year period from their launch.
The graph (Figure 5) below shows the estimated consumption of four sources of protein in grammes per
person per week in a control group over a 35-year period.
Poultry
Fish
Pork
^ Beef
Figure 5 The estimated consumption of four sources of protein in grammes
per person per week in a control group over a 35-year period.
A book for IELTS
97
Section on Writing
Exerci se 2: Language for graphs
This exercise focuses on the language for describing graphs. Match the texts below with the graphs on the
next page. Each graph may have more than one suitable description.
1. The price did not change over the period.
2. There was a steep fall in 1994 followed by a gradual improvement in the subsequent years.
3. The price rose and fell over the period, but the trend was definitely upwards.
4. The price collapsed in 1994.
5. The price plunged dramatically in 1994, but then it regained its previous level, before
soaring to a new peak.
6. The price plummeted in 1994.
7. In spite of the sharp fluctuations in the price, the trend was obviously upwards.
8. In 1994, the price fell steeply.
9. The price remained static, before experiencing a period of erratic behaviour.
10. The price fluctuated slightly over the period.
11. The price remained stable.
12. The price plunged in 1994.
13. Having remained stable for several years apart from a plunge in 1994, the price leaped
to a new peak at the end of 1997.
14. The price dipped slightly several times before sinking to a new low at the end of 1997.
15. The price remained the same for a brief period and then fluctuated wildly.
16. The price was steady over the period.
17. The price was erratic.
18. The price was fairly steady over the period.
98
A book for IELTS
$
p
e
r

t
o
n
n
e

U
$
p
e
r

t
o
n
n
e

o
$
p
e
r

t
o
n
n
e

U
J

$
p
e
r

t
o
n
n
e
Section on Writing
A E
Years
50
0
Years
150
50
G
Years
H
S
i n <p
0 3 O ) 0 3
Years
Exercise 2 Match the graphs above with the texts on the previous page.
Each graph may have more than one suitable description.
A book for IELTS
99
Section on Writing
Exercise 3: Which chart?
Read the text below and look at the charts and graphs (A-D) which follow. Decide which chart interprets the
text exactly. Then decide how you have to change the other charts to make them reflect the text exactly.
The average number of people attending the museum
yearly stood at just under 700,000 at the beginning of
1985. Over the subsequent years, attendances saw a
modest rise, followed by a period of volatility. During 1989,
the museum suffered a steep decline in the number of
visitors as a result of the introduction of voluntary charges.
The recovery, fitful at first lasted through to the beginning
of 1993, by which time the number of people attending
had climbed to a new peak of 750,000. In the first half of
1993, the attendance at the museum went into free fall,
nose-diving to approximately 300,000 visitors after
charging was introduced. Over the next iwo years and a
half, the number of people coming to the museum
fluctuated wildly; the trend, however, was obviously
upwards.
A
100
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
B
o
o
o
o
Q.
O
0
Cl
<D
JD
E
800
700
600
500
400
300
200
100
0
co
oo
h-
00
00
00
05
00
o
05
05
CM
05
CO
05 05
m
05
CO
05
Years
o
O
O
0
C L
O
0
CL
0
E
u
D
Years
Years
A book for IELTS
101
Section on Writing
Exerci se 4: A maze in graph form
In this exercise, you are going to look at the organisation of a graph in another way. Read the text below
and then look at the graph which follows. On the graph, there are various lines, which form a jumbled maze.
Find your way through the maze using the text as a guide. Where do you end up at the end of the period:
Point A, B, C or D?
The share price of FF International Ltd soared spectacularly to
more than nine times its value in the first year of the period,
before plunging again in the following year losing more than half
its previous gain. The share price then recovered, rising once
again fairly steeply in the next twelve months, adding roughly a
third to its value, only to fall back by more than the same amount
in the next year. Over the next year, the price jumped to just
under a hundred points short of its 1960 peak. Then, for the
space of a year, the share value remained stable, but, in the
subsequent three years, the share price experienced a sharp
decline, increasing in speed at the end of the fall, to below its
value at the beginning of the period. The next movement in the
share price was markedly upwards, but then it fell back again to
end at just over four times its value at the beginning of the 60s.
102
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
Exercise 5: Draw your own graph
The bar chart below shows the average number of monthly flights in 000s out of a regional airport called
Cranby. Read the text which follows the chart and plot the line graph for the number of flights out of the
second airport called Tinbury.
It is better to make a photocopy of the page and to write on the photocopy so that you can
repeat the exercise
M J J A
Months of the year
In January, the number of flights from Cranby airport was exactly half that of those from Tinbury.
In the following month, both airports saw a rise of about 50,000 flights, but in March, while flights
from Cranby continued to increase, to 150,000, those from Tinbury dropped back to the January
level. Flights from Cranby stayed at the March level for the following two months, but, in April, the
number leaving Tinbury climbed to 175,000, remaining at this level for the subsequent month. The
number of flights from both airports decreased in June, although the reduction was more dramatic
in Tinbury than Cranby, by 50,000 and 20,000 respectively. Both cities experienced a rise in the
number of flights leaving their airports in July, reaching a common level of 175,000. This increase
continued in August, both airports having just over 200,000 outbound flights.
However, in September, while the number of flights out of Tinbury continued to climb, to 25,000
more than the February peak, those from Cranby remained at the same number as for the previous
month. October saw an increase in the number of flights from Cranby, to 250,000, but a steep drop
in those from Tinbury, to the June level. During the last two months of the year, the number of
take-offs from both airports went up and then fell. From Cranby, a dramatic rise in November to
350,000 was followed by a slight decline in the subsequent month; while from Tinbury the increase
in the number of flights was more marked in November, climbing to a new peak of 375,000, but
December then saw the number of flights tumble to 75,000.
A book for IELTS
103
Section on Writing
Exerci se 6: Graph comprehension
Learning to look at a graph so that you can extract information which is relevant to a particular question means
that you have to develop the skill to do so.
Before you look at the graph in this exercise read the questions below carefully.
1. Look at the graph very quickly. Which feature stands out the most?
2. What other main characteristics of the graph can you see?
3. Is it possible to group the different types of fuel? If so, how?
4. Which line represents coal and which represents natural gas? How do you know?
5. If you are asked to describe the graph, is it important to put in reasons for the changes in the
amount of energy consumed?
6. Which tenses are you most likely to use in describing the graph?
7. As regards petroleum, you can mention that over the period consumption fluctuated,
but ended the period at approximately the same level. What else can you say?
8. In writing you should always try to avoid repetition. Are there any synonyms you can use
for: consumption, rise, fall?
Now cover the questions above and study the graph below which shows Inland Energy Consumption in the
UK in million tonnes of oil/coal equivalents from 1992 to 1995. After you have done this, look at the graph
again and answer the questions.
I nland Energy Comsumpt i on
104
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
Exercise 7: Improving a text
Once students have written a text, it is often difficult for them to recognise the mistakes. The text below is an
answer written for the graph in the previous exercise.
Read the text as quickly as you can and see how many mistakes you can find.
1. The graph shows the energy consumption from fossil and non-fossil fuels
in UK in million tonnes of oil/coal equivalent from 1992 to 1995.
2. A striking feature of the graph is the rise in the use of natural gas. Gas
consumption was steadily upwards, overtook coal towards the end of
1992 and finally outstriping petroleum in 1995 to become, fora period,
the second most popular energy source.
3. This rise was coincided with a drop in the use of coal during the period
1992 to 1995. At the beginning of 1992, coal consumtion stood at 65
million tonnes or so. In the first quater of 1992, there was a breif, steady
climb and, from then until the beginning of the third quarter in 1995, the
trend was markedly down. The fall down, first, was quite steep. From the
end of 1993, consumption was steady with two miner peeks at the end of
1993 and 1994, which were corresponded with two troughs in the use of
nuclear and hydro-electricity. Then from the beginning of 1995 coal
consumption resumed its fall.
4. As it can be seen, petroleum was the main source of energy throughout
the period with little or no changes in the consumed amount. The use of
non-fossil sources of energy, i.e. nuclear and hydroelectricity, over the
period was increased gradually with no dramatic rises or falls.
5. Despite the variations, the overall amount of energy consumed during the
period shown on the graph was a little changed at the end of 1995.
A book for IELTS
105
Section on Writing
Exerci se 8: The language of comparison and contrast
Look at the sentences and texts below. You can see that they are all related to comparing and contrasting.
Now look at the graphs on the next page. Decide which graphs are being compared or contrasted in each of
the texts and sentences.
For example, the answer to the first one is F and C.
1. The number of seats filled at the Bartlett theatre was steady over the period, but at the Ritz
attendance was very irregular.
2. The trend in attendance at the Ritz was erratic, but nevertheless upwards, while that for the
Bartlett enjoyed a steady rise before stabilising at around the 120 mark.
3. While attendances at the Ritz rose steadily throughout the year, at the Bartlett they shot up
initially before plunging steeply and then remaining stable for the rest of the year.
4. Whereas the attendances at the Ritz dipped slightly at the end of March/beginning of April and
again in August/September, those at the Bartlett rose during the corresponding periods.
5. The numbers attending the Bartlett declined through the year, while, on the contrary, attendance
at the Ritz climbed at an even pace.
6. Attendances at the Ritz saw a steady rise, whereas the Bartletts fluctuated wildly
7. Audiences at the Ritz, not very stable for the first part of the year, shot up dramatically. The
Bartlett, on the other hand, went through a rather volatile period in the first half of the year, before
settling down to a more stable period.
8. The number of theatre-goers at the Ritz was fairly steady in the first half of the year, but
numbers, plunging in the middle of the year, gradually petered out. The Bartlett, however,
experienced a steep rise in attendance in the first half of the year, before falling again.
9. The total number of theatre-goers attending the Bartlett fell off during the first part of the year
before making a steady recovery. By contrast, the Ritz attendance figures showed a rise followed
by a steep drop.
10. The attendance rate at the Bartlett went up and down considerably throughout the year with the
Ritz, by contrast, enjoying a period of stable, though modest, attendance.
106
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
A book for IELTS
107
Section on Writing
Exerci se 9: Graphs and charts combined
The diagram below shows the number of shoppers who visited a new shopping complex in its first year of
operation and the estimated number of shoppers over the same period. Below the diagram, there are two
charts, which show the sales at the centre in the first and last quarters of the year.
On the opposite page, there is a list of words and phrases and a model answer. All of the items in the list fit
into the model, but some of them are more sophisticated than the alternative. Find the appropriate words and
phrases to fill each blank and then decide which is the best answer.
For example, the answer for number 1 is e or m, of which m is the better answer.
e

a .
a .
o

10
Months of the year
Sales in percentage terms for first quarter
108
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
Sales in percentage terms for the last quarter
Food
20%
Electrical
Others 5% Computers
Clothes
10%
List of words and phrases
a in November the number of shoppers increased n which were predicted for the period
again
0 which is twice as much as the estimated figures
b fell by a large amount
P
they were
c those
q
reveal a marked shift
d experienced a hefty fall
r double the estimate for the period
e in the chart
s before picking up
f outstripping projections by a wide margin
t proved
9
outperforming the figures predicted
u hitting a peak
h declined further
V were
i being
w show that there was a change
j
November saw a noticeable turnaround
X went down
k before they went up
y
during which time they did better than the figures
I forecast for the period predicted
m as can be seen from the chart z doing better than expected.
MODEL ANSWER
_____1_, in the first two months after the opening of the new shopping complex,
the number of shoppers reached nearly 50,000, _____2_____. During March,
however, the number of shoppers dropped slightly,_____3_____during April and
May, once again_____4_____. The summer months_____ 5___not only rather
erratic with the shopper numbers at the end of August 6 no higher than
_____7_____ at the end of February, and also falling well below the numbers
_____8_____ .
During September and October, the number of actual shoppers 9_____, but
_____10_____ with the volume of shoppers rising dramatically, 11_____ .
December saw this spectacular rise continue with the number of people shopping at
the centre for the year_____12_____ of nearly 160,000 visitors per month.
The sales figures_____13_____ in spending patterns at the complex over the year
with greater expenditure on Toys, Computers and Other items at the expense of Food
and Clothes. For example, Toy sales soared from 5% to over 30%, while at the same
time Clothes sales_____14_____ .
A book for IELTS
109
Section on Writing
Exerci se 10: It is predicted that...
This exercise looks at talking about the future. Study the charts below, which show changing trends in leisure
in Europe for certain industries.
8000
7000
6000
5000
4000
3000
2000
1000
0
European Entertainment I ndustry
Internet Sales
Years
Forecasts for European cinema attendances
1200
1000
800
in
c
| 600
S 4 00
200
0
2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008
Years
110
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
Now look at the model below.
It is predicted that European Internet music sales will increase
dramatically over the period covered by the graph. Rising fitfully
at first, the sales will then leap in two stages to reach a high of
$3900 million in 2012, before rocketing to a new peak of $8000
million at the end of 2014. Album sales, on the other hand, initially
climbing until the end of 2006, are then set to drop steadily
throughout the next five years, before bottoming out to end the
period considerably below the $1000 million mark.
As regards attendances at European cinemas, there are two
diverging forecasts. The first estimate is for numbers to rise
steadily between the year 2003 and 2008, increasing from just
below 900 million people to 1200 million with the largest rise in
numbers going to cinemas expected to be in the year 2008. By
contrast, the second forecast paints a different picture. The
projection for the first three years of the period shows a rise, but
after that cinema attendances are forecast to fall to below 400
million people.
Using the words and phrases below replace parts of the text above. Which version do you prefer? Note that
the items below are in the order that you should replace them. Number six has been done for you as an
example.
1. The prediction is that
2. will go up a lot
3. which the graph covers
4. They will rise erratically
5. and will then rise
6. going up
7. which will climb at first
8. before they bottom out and end
9. a lot below $1000 million
10. With European cinema
attendances
11. and increase
12. and the biggest jump in cinema
visitors is projected
13. But, the second forecast is different.
14. will fall
A book for IELTS
m
Section on Writing
Exerci se 11: More comparison and contrast
This exercise gives you more practice with comparing and contrasting. This time, however, you are going to
look at two bar charts and a pie chart.
Study the two bar charts below, which show the average number of books borrowed from a local library per
month in each category for the years 1996 and 1997. The pie chart then shows the percentage of books
devoted to each category in the library
Look at the first two charts and find patterns in the data. Then compare the data with the information in the
pie chart. Make a list of the patterns you find on a separate piece of paper.
Borrowings per area 1996
y.
Borrowings per area i 997
Other
Sci-fi
Children's
Crime
Romance
Non-fiction
Fiction
0
J
10 15 20 25
%
30
Library Contents
Children's
15%
Non- fiction
20%
112
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
Now look at the text below and insert the following words and phrases in the most appropriate place:
1. in no way 10. , however,
2. For example, 11. whereas
3. In the third category come 12. On the one hand,
4. whereas 13. the former
5. as another example 14. by varying degrees
6. By contrast,
7. A comparison
8. the latter
9. fall into three categories
One of the phrases (No. 13) has already been inserted for you.
of the borrowings for 1996 and 1997 shows that they, those for fiction
and the other category fell, the former by 50% from 30% of
borrowings to 15%, and again by 50% from ten percent to five percent.
, childrens books, romance and sci-fi all rose. Childrens increased by
several percentage points, books taken out from the romance section
rose by 50% between the two years. The number of books borrowed
by those reading science-fiction, went up threefold.
non-fiction and crime, neither of which saw any rise.
The contents of the library are reflected by the books that are taken out
in either of the years., sci-fi books make up five per cent of the books
in the library, while in both years borrowings exceed this amount, by
three times as we have seen in 1997. Take non-fiction. Lendings in both
years stand at five per cent, 20 per cent of the books fall into this
category.
A book for IELTS
113
Section on Writing
Exer ci se 12: More complex terms
This exercise gives you more practice with comparing data. Study the charts below. The bar chart shows the
results of a survey of the reading habits of first year female and male university students at a university in
the UK. The pie charts show the amount of time male and female students spend on various activities.
Readi ng habi t s of f i r st year uni ver si t y st udent s
J ournals
Non-fiction
Fiction
Comics
Magazines
Tabloids
Qualities
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100
i r
i i
i i
F 3
Male students
i i
&
i i
Female students
Working
Sport
10%
Socialising
10%
Male Students
Working
15%
Studying
4 5%
15%
114
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
Now read the following text:
______1______ the bar chart shows how many first year male and female university
students read______ 2______ .
______3______ the female students appear to read more quality newspapers than
______4______ by a margin of roughly 20%, male first year students______ 5______
read more tabloids_____6_______ . When it comes to non-fiction, the same pattern is
repeated; only this time the difference is______7______ approximately 65% of female
students reading non-fiction______8_____25% of the males.
The______ 9______ for comics. While over 60% of males read comics, only 25% of
female students claim to do so._____10_______ , however, male students are ahead
of females_____11_______ , roughly 78% for the former and 75% for the latter. As
regards magazines,_______12_______ both sexes are almost equal.
_____13_______ from the pie charts, a number of differences between the two groups
______14_____ . Although female students work more (20% of their time rather than
15% for males, they______15______ 15% more of their time to studying. Females also
spend less time socialising and much less than men on sport, allowing them more time
for studying.
To complete the above text, add the most appropriate phrases to the blank spaces. Note that there are more
blanks than words and phrases, so you also have to decide which blank spaces to leave empty!
a pattern is reversed
b devote
c by a narrow margin
d a range of publications
e where fiction is concerned
f their male counterparts
9
more pronounced with
h as opposed to
i can be seen
j
whereas
A book for IELTS
115
Section on Writing
Exerci se 13: Some common language mistakes
This exercise contains a range of mistakes, e.g. spelling and grammar, that students often make in the
language that they use to write about graphs. Some of the sentences have more than one mistake. Can you
find them?
1. There was a sharp decrease of the number of people attending the theatre over the period.
2. The increase of the incidence in petty crime has continued in spite of the measures
introduced.
3. The charts indicate that the price of the various types of cars fell down considerably.
4. It was predicted that industrial production in Western countries level out, while that in the
so-called Tiger economies will rise in the early 90s.
5 . The price of computers has drammatically reduced over the period.
6. As regarding noise pollution, a pretty big rise in number of complaints was recorded for 1997.
7. As it can be seen, the rate of increase slowed over the last five years of the period.
8. At 1974, its output began to stage a gradual recovery.
9. Between February and May, the income was fairly eratic.
10. It is estimated that the number of cars on the road plunge when road prizing is introduced.
11. Sales hit a peek in late summer and then felled back in the consequent months.
12. There was, acording to the graph, no significant changes to sales from 1973 to 1976.
13. The rate of inflation drooped slowly, but surely, in the early 80s.
14. The main charactristic of the bar chart is the large drop in male students applying.
15. The birth rate raised quite slowly over the period.
116
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
Exercise 14 : How many correct sentences are there?
And now more mistakes! On the left, you have uncompleted texts, some of which are correct and some
wrong. In the right-hand column, you again have some texts which are correct and some which are wrong.
Match the correct texts in each column to form complete sentences. If you think that the text in the first column
is wrong, it cannot then be completed. One of the sentences has been completed for you. In some cases,
there may be more than one combination.
e.g. (9 + e) = Expenditure has climbed considerably over the period.
1 The graph shows that there was ...
2 The small decline of the use of...
3 As the chart shows that...
4 From the informations shown in the charts,...
5 The graph shows the number of passengers ...
6 The incidence of telephone rage ...
7 Between 1780 and 1850, a large number...
8 The fluctuations in the consumption of alcohol...
9 Expenditure ...
10 There was a mild rise ...
11 In case of Liberia,...
12 The pound ...
13 The incidence of TB ...
14 The rise in cheese production ...
15 A similar rise can be ...
16 The Bartletts shares of the UK bicycle market...
17 From the data given,
18 In the case of the UK,...
a using trains, buses and the metro rose 7%, 8%
and 4%, respectively.
b a sudden rise in applications to take the course.
c corresponding peaks in people using public
transport.
d was slight.
e has climbed considerably over the period.
f numeracy rates slipped back in the late 1970s.
g plant equipment will ease off.
h crept up at an even pace.
i depend on many factors.
j on education fell quite severely.
k trains, buses and the metro rose 7%, 8% and 4%,
respectfully.
I soared slightly against the dollar.
m we can see the main reason was a desire to
meet new friends.
n rose steeply between 1990 and 1997.
o is dependent on a number of factors.
p recovered slightly against the dollar.
q in education was decreased.
A book for IELTS
117
Section on Writing
Exer ci se 15: Questionnaire 1
This exercise focuses on a number of specific language points relating to graphs. Answer the questions as
far as you can, and use the Key where necessary.
1. Look at the list of words and phrases below. Which is the odd one out? And why?
decline, fall, drop, go down, decrease, fall down, plunge
2. Read the following sentence:
Over recent years, the price of white goods has fallen considerably.
Which of the words or phrases below can replace has fal len? There is more than one answer.
has reduced, has slowed down, has declined, has dropped, has been reduced,
has deteriorated, has been dropped, has subsided, has lessened, has gone down,
has decreased
Give reasons for your answer.
3. Which of the sentences below is correct and why?
The number of people in full-time work dipped rather dramatically.
The number of people in full-time work dipped slightly.
The number of people in full-time work dipped rather slightly.
4. One major problem that students face in writing is using words that go together.
In other words, they often use words which do not collocate. For example, you cannot say:
The space between the rich and the poor widened considerably.
Space is obviously the wrong word. The correct word is gap.
Look at the following sentences and decide which word or phrase is not suitable and correct it:
(a) The dropping death rate ended the decade at an all time low.
(b) The rising cost of life continued until the end of the decade.
(c) The chart shows a large plummet in the amount of money invested in
education over recent years.
(d) There has been a deterioration in the percentage of the population in work.
(e) There was a diminution in the price of telephoning internationally.
(f) The downward tendency in traditional skills halted abruptly at the end of the year.
5. Look at the following sentence:
While the number of tourists visiting the site saw a significant increase, the amount of
money which they spent on souvenirs fell.
What other ways can you use to express comparison here instead of using while?
6. What other phrases and words do you know with the same meaning as fluctuate?
118
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
7. The birth rate did not change over the period.
Can you rewrite the sentence and begin: There was ...
What other expressions do you know to express stability?
8. Which two words and phrases below are the odd ones out?
plunge, plummet, deteriorate, take a nose dive, nosedive, decline, collapse,
dive, fall headlong
9. One of the main problems that students have in describing graphs etc. is that they have
difficulty using synonyms. What other words or phrases can you think of to replace the
underlined words in the texts below?
The incidence of teenage crime has levelled off in many parts of the country over recent years.
Nevertheless, we should not become complacent about the situation, as the incidence of
teenage cri me is historically high.
10. When you want to refer to a particular item on a graph you can use an expression like:
As regards the trend for Sierra Leone, the increase is more marked.
What other words or expressions like this do you know?
11. Look at the sentence below. What other words and expressions do you know which can
replace the word shows?
The graph shows the percentage of the population of the UK who support the
idea of a single currency.
A book for IELTS
119
Section on Writing
Exercise 16: Questionnaire 2
This exercise contains a number of questions about the language you need to describe graphs.
1. What other ways can you express sequence in the sentence below instead of just using
the word next? You may rewrite part of the sentence if you wish.
Next, the information is collated and sent out electronically to other agents.
2. In the sentence below, what do you think is the best word to fill the blank?
The main__________ of this graph is the inverse relationship between the decrease in the
consumption of beer and the rise in that of wine.
3. In the sentence below there are two pieces of information: the approval rating of the new
currency rose and it rose 35%. Can you combine the two pieces of information in another way?
Which way is better?
The number of companies who registered approval of the new currency rose and the
ratings rose by more than 35%.
4 . Rewrite the following sentence using the words foll owed by:
Mobile telephone sales rocketed in the first three months and then there was a
steady decline for the rest of the year.
5. Are both these sentences wrong?
The amount of money invested in the infrastructure was increased slowly.
Cinema attendances were increased in the period.
6. Is there anything wrong with the sentence below?
A glance at the graph shows that the trend was stable with no significant fall and rise.
7. Look at the following words:
predict, forecast, estimate, prophesy, project, anticipate
Which is the odd one out?
8. Look at the following sentence:
The number of people on waiting lists is forecast to rise steadily in the coming years.
Rewrite the sentence and begin: I t ...
9. Is it correct to say the following:
The projected number of people on waiting lists is set to rise steadily in the coming years.
10. Is the word interesting in the sentence below objective or subjective?
The most interesting characteristic in the chart is the variation in temperature
during the period.
If you replace the word interesting with significant, is there any change in the
subjectivity/objectivity?
120
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
11. The amount of money invested in science and in training are being compared in the
sentence below.
The falls in investment in science and training are almost the same.
What other ways can you compare the two items? You cannot use while' etc
(see Exercise 15, number 5).
12. All of the sentences below are correct. Which do you prefer and why?
(a) The rates of the decline in investment in science and training are not the same.
(b) The rate of the decline in investment in science is not the same as that for training.
(c) The rate of the decline in investment in science does not quite mirror that for training.
(d) The rate of the decline in investment in science differs slightly from that for training.
(e) The rate of the decline in investment in science is practically the same as that for training.
13 Rewrite the sentence below using the word not.
The fall in investment in training is slightly smaller than that for science.
A book for IELTS
121
Section on Writing
Exer ci se 17: Tables
It is usually harder to describe tables than graphs and pie charts, mainly because they lack the visual
organisation in the latter. However, the same principles apply to tables as to graphs: look for patterns. In
addition, it might help you to draw a simple line graph next to each line of data, if it is too long to see a visual
image immediately.
Study the table below and look for patterns in the data relating to land transport onl y i.e. excluding Foot,
Water and Air.
P assenger death rates: by mode of transport
Great Britain Rates per billion passenger kilometres
Average
1981 1986 1991 1992 1993 1983-1993
Motorcycle 115.8 100.3 94.4 97.0 94.6 104.0
Foot 76.9 75.3 62.5 58.5 56.2 70.5
Pedal cycle 56.9 49.6 46.8 43.4 41.3 48.8
Water1 0.4 0.5 0.0 0.5 0.0 9.2
Car 6.1 5.1 3.7 3.5 3.0 4.6
Van 3.8 3.8 2.2 2.2 1.7 2.7
Rail 1.0 0.9 0.8 0.4 0.4 0.9
Bus or coach 0.3 0.5 0.6 0.4 0.8 0.5
Air1 0.2 0.5 0.0 0.1 0.0 0.2
1Data are for United Kingdom
Source: Department of Transport, Social Trends 1996, Table 12.15
Now look at the jumbled model below. The sections of text on the left are in the correct order and those on
the right are jumbled. Using the table above to help you, recreate the model answer by matching the two
sides.
Example: 1. matches (d); and 2. matches (e)
1. The data in the table relating to passenger
a. under review. Nevertheless, buses and
2. in Great Britain between 1981 and 1993
b. motorcycles and rail, the rate dropped
3. The first group, consisting of cars, vans
c. the second most dangerous type of
4. reduction in the rate of road death over
land transport.
5. death among the car and van users
d. death rates by mode of land transport
6. from 6.1 per billion passenger
e. can be divided into three categories.
7. respectively. Cycling, however,
f. than twice as many fatalities as cycling,
8. 56.9 per billion to 41.3, remained
and more
9. In the second category, comprising
g-
safest type of vehicular transport.
10. slightly between 1981 and 1993.
h. despite a significant decrease from
11. type of transport averaging more
i. and bicycles experienced a significant
12. than twenty times as high as cars.
j-
kilometres to 3.0 and 3.8 to 1.7,
13. Regarding the third group, buses
k. the period under study. For example,
14. almost trebled over the period
I. and coaches, the road death rate
15. coaches were still the second
m. declined by more than half, falling
n. Motorcycling was the most dangerous
Compare your answer with the Key.
122
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
Exer ci se 18: Map language - and verbs and tenses
In this exercise, you are going to look at the language that is used in describing maps. Study the two maps
below, which show the area of Barton Bingham in 1937 and 1995. Then look at the text on the page opposite
which has no verbs. Read the text with the maps and put the verbs from the Verb box into the most suitable
places in the text. You may use each item in the Verb box once only. One of the verb phrases (No. 17) has
been done for you as an example.
Key
* Woodl and
A M u i
Agri cul tural land
-
M / Marshland
i \
-
Scrubland
Railway stati on ( 1990)
Houses
+H-
course
Rail way ( 19 9 1)
Di sused rai l way line
Road
| Wi l df owl sanctuary
A book for IELTS
123
Section on Writing
Changes in Barton Bingham
As can be seen from the maps, the area of Barton Bingham significantly
between 1937 and 1995. The road bisecting the area and on both sides
various developments. On the north side, the manor house into a health
farm and part of the surrounding scrubland and adjacent woodland a golf
course. The area immediately adjacent to the road to housing along its
entire length.
On the south side of the road, a railway station in 1990, which by a minor
road to the main thoroughfare. In 1991, the disused railway line, with a
bridge across the road. In the scrubland to the east of the lake, a leisure
complex in 1995. In addition, the area of agricultural land which in 1937
to make way for the construction of a new hospital and a car park both
also with road access to the main highway. A farmhouse the remaining
agricultural land. Next to the agricultural land, the marshes that there in
1937, to a wildfowl sanctuary.
Verb box
1. became 10. was reopened
2. existed 11. was completed and opened
3. gave way 12. were
4. being built 13. was halved
5. was constructed 14. was built on
6. changed 15. was connected
7. took place 16. was straightened
8. was converted 17. can be seen
9. were turned over
124
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
Exer ci se 19: Process language?
And now for the language necessary to describe processes. Look at the timeline below which shows the
steps taken to produce a TV documentary on Lenin.
Then read the list (a-o) below diagram and choose the sentences you need to describe the sequence of
events that led to the production of the documentary.
P roducer
chooses
team
Document ary 08/02/98
producer
seeks
funding
07/01/98
Team
interviews
experts
04/04/98
Cont act wit h
experts ,
21103198
The st art of
filming on
location
I2/0S/98
Filming ends
16/06/98
Broadcast
of the
documentary
on TV
27/09/98
1
07/02/98
P roducer
finds
necessary
finance
07/03/98
Team begins
research
18/04/98
Recordi ng
of interviews
of experts
takes place
12/07/98
Editing of
filming and
interviews
Please note that five of the sentences are not suitable.
a The next stage was the fact finding which was begun on 7 March,
b Not long afterwards the programme was edited,
c and the interviews were finally recorded two weeks later,
d The required funding was secured just over four weeks afterwards,
e The film crew were briefed,
f All the necessary research was done on 7 March,
g The documentary was then televised at the end of September,
h At the beginning of 1978, funding for the documentary on Lenin was applied for.
/' The next phase, filming on location, began on 12 May and came to an end just over four weeks later,
j Contact was then made with experts on Lenin,
k The experts were interviewed
I The producer applied for funding of the documentary at the beginning of 1998.
m and the interviews were finally recorded three weeks later,
n The producer was chosen by the team.
o The production crew were selected by the producer the following day.
A book for IELTS
125
Section on Writing
Exerci se 20: The process of making a newspaper
Look at the diagram below. Then read the brief explanation on the next page, which a printer gave to a group
of teenagers about making a daily newspaper.
Below the printers explanation is an outline for a written version of what the printer said. Using the explanation,
complete the report. Then compare your version with the Key.
Making a daily newspaper
Mechanical
P ulping P rocess
Refiner
126
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
Printer's explanation
Well, if you look at this diagram here, you can see that we take material from two places, timber
from trees and recycled paper, and then we pass it through some machines to create the
newspaper.
We put the wood into this machine here to remove the bark and then we chop the timber up into
little tiny pieces in this one here. These tiny pieces we then put into this mechanical refiner, and
after that it goes into the hydrapulper over there.
And then we mix the chippings with water and make them into a pulp, which we put into this blend
chest where we mix it with pulp from recycled paper, which Ill talk about in a minute. We then
refine, clean and screen this mixture before it goes into this large piece of machinery here where
we press the pulp, dry it and then make it into rolls of paper.
Once we print the newspaper, it is sent to your newsagent. After you have finished with the paper,
it hopefully goes into a recycling bin.
The recycled paper goes into this hydrapulper here and we remove the ink in that de-inking cell
over there. This is added to the blend chest: and the whole process is repeated. Any questions?
Written report
To create a daily newspaper, the necessary material is taken from two sources,
Trees are cut down to provide timber. In the first machine,________________
These chippings__________________________________, and subsequently a
hydrapulper______________________________________________ . At the next
stage, the pulp_____________________________________________________
This mixture
.into rolls of paper.
Once the newspaper has been printed, it______________ . After the reader _
________________________________________ . The recycling process first
involves
.into a pulp. A de-inking cell then extracts the ink. After that, the solution is
put into the blend chest: and the whole process is repeated.
A book for IELTS
127
Section on Writing
Essay Writing for Task 2
Exer ci se 21: Understanding essay titles
Candidates often score badly in the Task 2 of the writing module in IELTS, simply because they do not
understand what the essay question is asking them to do. Look at the following:
Charges for entrance to museums is seen by many as a tax on education.
What do you think the consequences of such charging would be?
The focus of this question is the word consequences and your opinion is involved in the selection of the
consequences. So you should organise your essay around the focus word, perhaps using variations like
effect and result.
Now look at the ten essay titles below and the explanations which follow. Match the explanations to the titles.
Note that there are more explanations than titles and some of the explanations are wrong or not complete.
The answer to number one is: B
Essay titles
1. Charges for entrance to museums is seen by many as a tax on education.
How far do you agree with this statement?
2. Many people believe that the next world war will happen as a result of conflicts over water.
Is this fear justified? Give reasons for your answer.
3. Success in life is more often than not elusive. What factors help to make an individual
successful?
4. Some people believe that it would be better if there were only one language in the world.
Others are of the opinion that if this ever occurred it would cause more problems than it solved.
Discuss the problems that might arise if, in fact, there were only one language in the world
and give your own opinion.
5. Some people believe that the influence that television exerts over society is largely detrimental
and are calling for it to be more strictly controlled. Should television be more tightly controlled
to protect society and, if so, how? Or should it have even fewer restrictions placed on it?
6. Noise pollution is most certainly increasing at an alarming rate in many industrialised countries.
In what ways can this problem be overcome?
7. People point to the number of presidents and other rulers who come to power at an advanced
age, or artists and famous people who achieve success late in life as one of the arguments
against age discrimination in the work place. What are the dangers of such discrimination?
Do you feel age discrimination should be banned or do you feel that there are certain jobs that
should only be open to younger people?
8. As people live longer and longer, the idea of cloning human beings in order to provide human
spare parts is becoming a reality. The idea horrifies most people, yet it is becoming a reality
rather than mere science fiction. To what extent do you agree with such a procedure?
Have you any reservations?
9. Money has always been a prime driving force for people, but as we move into the technological
age we seem to be driven more and more by the pursuit of money. Discuss the arguments for
and against this idea and give your own views.
10. People generally believe that knowledge is power, but rather it is the ability to manipulate
knowledge not knowledge itself, which bestows power. How far do you agree?
128
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
Explanations
A. The title makes a distinction between the use of knowledge and knowledge. It says that the
latter gives an individual power. You have to give your opinion about this distinction, i.e. which
is more important?
B. This title asks you how far you agree with the idea that museum charges are a tax on education.
You can state your opinion and give your reasons. Or you can state your own opinion generally,
then give other peoples views and then demolish them by supporting your own opinion. Or you
can give other peoples views and then demolish them by giving your own.
C. You are being asked to describe what contributes to making an individual successful.
D. This title asks what you think about the next world war being fought over water. You can state
your opinion and show the consequences.
E. Describe the arguments against about money being the main driving force for human beings.
F. This title asks your opinion about whether we should be afraid of a war resulting from fights
over water supplies and also asks you to give your reasons.
G. The question is asking you to state your opinion about the positive effects of TV on society.
H. Describe the risks of age discrimination in the work place and state whether it should be
banned. Also do you feel that certain jobs should be done by younger people?
I. You are being asked to describe why people more often fail than achieve success.
J . You are being asked to state how far you agree or disagree with cloning human beings to
provide spare parts and also to say whether you have any doubts about the subject.
K. You are being asked to describe the problems involved if there were only one language in the
world and what your opinion is in this matter.
L. You are being asked to state how far you agree or disagree with cloning human beings to
provide spare parts.
M. You are being asked to describe the advantages and problems involved if there were only one
language in the world.
N. Describe the arguments for and against and also give your opinion about money being the
main driving force for human beings.
O. The question is asking you to state your opinion about whether television should be restricted
or not. It also asks you to describe how to control TV, if you agree.
P. Describe some measures to reduce noise pollution.
Q. Discuss the problems faced by industrialised nations.
R. The title makes a distinction between knowledge and the use of knowledge. It says that the
latter gives an individual power not knowledge itself. You have to give your opinion about this
distinction, i.e. which is more important?
S. Describe the arguments for and against age discrimination in the work place and state whether
it should be banned.
A book for IELTS
129
Section on Writing
Exerci se 22: Plans for essays
For many students deciding how to plan an essay under the stress of the exam causes many problems.
However, you should note that, while the range of general subjects is wide, there is a limit to the type of
question you can be asked to write about.
This exercise shows a range of essay types. Look at the titles below and then at the plans which follow.
Decide which basic plan, or plans, is suitable for each essay.
Note that two of the titles do not have plans.
1. A growing number of people feel animals should have the same rights as humans. Discuss the
difficulties that the adoption of such a policy would have for humans. What is your own opinion on
this matter?
2. A growing number of people feel animals should have the same rights as humans. Others feel
that humans must always come first and accuse animal rights activists of being overly sentimental.
How far do you agree or disagree?
3. The wealth of a nation depends primarily on the level of education of its workforce. How far do
you agree with this statement and what other factors do you think might be involved?
4. The primary concern of architects should be to create buildings that are pleasing to the eye rather
than just being functional. What would be the benefits to society if architects adopted such a
principle?
5. Education is not a luxury, but a basic human right and as such should be free for everyone
irrespective of personal wealth. Discuss the difficulties of applying such a principle.
6. The extinction of animals is part of a natural process that we as human beings should not
interfere with. What are the arguments against this statement and how far do you agree with it
yourself?
7. For a long time, there has been concern about the quality of the food we eat what with food
additives and contamination from pesticides and pollution. Now the advances in
genetically-engineered food are causing concern among the general public. Is this concern, in your
opinion, justified or are we all just looking for something to worry about?
8. Prisons are basically universities of crime, fostering the kind of behaviour they aim to eradicate.
In what ways can prisons help criminals to function normally when they return to society? Do you
think such attempts at rehabilitating criminals are effective?
9. The cloning of human beings is an inevitable consequence of human development. Should such
cloning be banned? Or should scientists be allowed to continue developing this field of research?
10. Cloning is an inevitable consequence of human development. What are the dangers if it is
allowed to develop unchecked? Should it be banned totally?
130
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
P lan A
_________________ has been an issue about
which there has been considerable hostile
debate. There are, of course, a number of
problems involved in adopting such a policy.
The main difficulty i s __________________
________________________________ is yet
another obstacle.
As far as I am concerned,_______________
P lan B
Whether.______
__________________________ . I personally
My main reason is _____________________
Another justification is __________________
Last but not least,____________________
P l anC
Whether____________________________
__________________________ . (I personally
_____________ __________ .)
Some people feel ____________________
Others ______________________________
In my opinion,_________________
P lan D
___________________ is a matter of debate.
There are, however, several strong arguments
against this.
______________ _____ is obviously the main
argument.
Another justification is ________________
From my point of view,
P lan E
Whether_________________ . From my point
of view,______________________________
________________ is, in my opinion, the main
contributing factor.
Another___________________ .
Finally,__________________________ to be
considered.
As we have seen,______________________
P lan F
Many people are expressing concern about
_______________ . Other people, by contrast,
There are, of course, several risks inherent in
such a development.
The most obvious danger is______________
is another hazard.
Having said that, however, I believe
P lan G
Whether__________________ . From my point
of view,_____________________________ .
_________________ is, in my opinion, the
main measure.
Another course of action would be to_______
I am personally of the opinion_____________
P lan H
___________________ is a matter of debate.
There are, of course, several strong arguments
for/against doing this.
___________________ is obviously the main
argument for/against. However, in my opinion,
Another justification for/against is __________
_____________ . Having said that, however, I
feel_____________________ .
From my point of view,___________________
A book for IELTS
131
Section on Writing
Exer ci se 23: Same general subject - different focus
This exercise gives you further practice in interpreting essay titles. Below there are ten essay titles all with
the same general subject, but the focus of each essay question is different. Following the titles, there are
some explanations. Match the explanations to the titles. Note that there are more explanations than titles;
some of the explanations are wrong or not complete. In one or two cases there may be more than one correct
answer.
Essay titles
1. Some people feel that media like the press, television, and the Internet should be more strictly
controlled. Others believe that, if anything, the controls should be loosened to give people freer
access to information. Where do you stand on this issue?
2. Some people are of the opinion that media like the press, television, and the Internet should be
more strictly controlled. Others feel that the controls should be loosened to give people freer
access to information. How far do you agree with loosening the controls?
3. Some people are of the opinion that media like the press, television, and the Internet should be
more strictly controlled. Others firmly feel that, if anything, the controls should be loosened to
give people freer access to information. Discuss the dangers and advantages if media controls
were further relaxed.
4. Some people believe that media like the press, television, and the Internet should be more
strictly controlled. Others feel that, if anything, the controls should be loosened to give people
freer access to information. What are the disadvantages of not relaxing media controls further?
And where do you stand on the issue?
5. Some people think that media like the press, television, and the Internet should be more strictly
controlled. Others feel that if anything the controls should be loosened to give people freer
access to information. Discuss the problems that might arise if the controls were relaxed and
give your own opinion on the issue.
6. Some people fear that media like the press, television, and the Internet will cause irreparable
damage unless they are more strictly controlled. Others feel that, if anything, the controls should
be loosened to give people freer access to information. Is this fear really justified? Give reasons
for your answer.
7. Some people believe that media like the press, television, and the Internet should be more
strictly controlled. Others feel that if anything the controls should be loosened to give people
freer access to information. What are the dangers of such freedom? Do you feel there should
be more controls over the media or do you think that the restrictions in place are too tight?
8. Some people believe that media like the press, television, and the Internet should be more
strictly controlled. Others feel that if anything the controls should be loosened to give people
freer access to information. To what extent do you agree with the idea of reducing media
controls? Have you any reservations either way?
9. Some people believe that media like the press, television, and the Internet should be more
strictly controlled. Others feel that if anything the controls should be loosened to give people
freer access to information. Discuss the arguments for and against the latter idea and give
your own views.
10. Some people believe that media like the press, television, and the Internet should be more
strictly controlled. Others feel that if anything the controls should be loosened to give people
freer access to information. Should the controls be made tighter? Or should there be more
freedom for the media?
132
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
Explanations
A. The question is asking you to describe what the drawbacks could be if controls over the media
are relaxed. You also have to give your own opinion. The question has two main parts.
B. You are being asked to discuss the risks involved in relaxing control of the media. There is
another part to this question i.e. you have to give your opinion about whether controls need to
be tightened or whether they are already too restrictive.
C. This title asks you whether you agree with relaxing or tightening media controls. You can state
your opinion and give your reasons. Or you can state your own opinion generally, then give
other peoples views and then demolish them by supporting your own opinion. Or you can give
other peoples views and then demolish them by giving your own.
D. You are being asked to give your opinion i.e. which side of the issue do you agree with or are
you in the middle?
E. This title asks to write about the risks involved in having media controls. You should also give
your opinion. The question has two parts.
F. You are being asked to describe the problems involved if media controls were relaxed and to
give your opinion.
G. This title asks you to write about the risks involved and the benefits in having looser media
controls.
H. The question is asking you to describe what the drawbacks could be if controls over the media
are not relaxed. You also have to give your own opinion.
I. You are being asked to describe the problems involved if media controls were relaxed. You are
not being asked to write about anything else.
J . Note the question has three elements. You are being asked to describe the arguments for and
against relaxing media control and also to give your opinion.
K. Note the question has two elements. You are being asked to describe the arguments for
relaxing media control and also to give your opinion.
L. Should we be afraid of relaxing controls governing the media? This also means that you should
ask yourself: Or should we not be afraid? Then you are asked to give the reasons for your
opinion.
M. You are being asked to state how far you agree with relaxing media controls and also whether
you have any doubts either way regarding the issue.
N. You are being asked to state how far you agree with relaxing or tightening media controls.
Note the question has only one part.
A book for IELTS
133
Section on Writing
Exerci se 24: A model essay
Look at two different answers for the essay title below and see if you can spot the difference between the
two versions. Then when you have done this, decide which one is the better of the two.
Essay title
Should museums and art galleries be free of charge for the general public or should a
charge, even a voluntary charge, be levied for admittance?
Version A
1. In many countries, a charge is levied for entrance to museums and art galleries, but, in
some instances, entrance is free.
2. The up-keep of such institutions is not cheap and it is only fair that some contribution should
come by way of an entrance fee or, at least, a voluntary contribution. An exception is usually
made for certain categories of people.
3. If people are made to pay to visit museums and art galleries, then this is effectively a tax on
education. People should be encouraged to visit such institutions.
4. Moreover, children who have visited a museum or a gallery with their school may not be able
to go again with their parents. A fee would act as a deterrent to people wanting to visit a
museum.
5. Often people want to spend maybe only half an hour in a museum rather than spending a long
time to justify paying a fee.
6. People should not have pay to visit museums and art galleries.
Version B
1. In many countries, a charge is levied for entrance to museums and art galleries, but, in some
instances, entrance is free.
2. Where a charge is, in fact, levied, the argument is that the up-keep of such institutions is not
cheap and while the tax-payer might be expected to provide some funds, it is only fair that
some contribution should come by way of an entrance fee or, at least, a voluntary contribution.
An exception is usually made for certain categories of people, like the unemployed, the elderly,
the disabled, school children and students on the grounds of financial hardship.
3. Personally, however, I believe that, if people are made to pay to visit museums and art galleries,
then this is effectively a tax on education. People should be encouraged to visit such institutions,
as they contain a wealth of material relating not only to the history and culture of their own
countries, but also of other civilisations. They can, of course, obtain information from books
films etc, but this is nothing to seeing the real objects.
4. Moreover, children who have visited a museum or a gallery with their school may not be able to
go again with their parents, if there is an entrance fee. So a fee, in my opinion would act as a
deterrent to people wanting to visit a museum.
5. Often people want to spend maybe only half an hour in a museum rather than spending a long
time to justify paying a fee. This would deter many people, myself included, from visiting
museums. Having said this, however, I am not against voluntary charges or people being
encouraged to make donations.
6. So, all in all, my personal view is that people should not have pay to visit museums and art
galleries.
134
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
Writing Tests
TEST 1
Writing Task 1
You should spend about 20 minutes on this task.
The bar chart below shows the projected sales in the UK of private cars and company cars from
2003 to 2014 and the graph shows the projected motorcycle sales for the same period.
Write a report for a university lecturer comparing and contrasting the data from the year 2003 onwards.
You should write at least 150 words.
P rojected UK car sales
Years
P rojected UK motorcycle sales
Years
TEST 1
Writing Task 2
You should spend about 40 minutes on this task.
Present a written argument or case for an educated reader with no specialist knowledge of the
following topic:
Some people are of the opinion that prisons are basically universities of crime, fostering the kind of
behaviour they aim to eradicate, and are, therefore, not effective. Others feel that prison life is not
A book for IELTS
135
Section on Writing
hard enough. Discuss the arguments on both sides of the issue. What is your own opinion on the
matter?
You should write at least 250 words.
Use your own ideas, knowledge and experience and support your arguments with examples and with relevant
evidence.
TEST 2
Writing Task 1
You should spend about 20 minutes on this task.
The charts below show the result of a public survey on the use of mobile phones.
Write a report for a university lecturer describing the data.
You should write at least 150 words.
General ly speaki ng, do you approve of mobile phones?
Female
Male
Yes QNo Don't Know
Yes Dont Know DNo
136
A book for IELTS
Section on Writing
TEST 2
Writing Task 2
You should spend about 40 minutes on this task.
Present a written argument or case for an educated reader with no specialist knowledge of the following topic:
Euthanasia, or mercy killing, has been in the news more and more recently. Many people are
strongly against such a practice, but there is a growing demand to have it legalised. How far do you
agree with euthanasia being made legal?
You should write at least 250 words.
Use your own ideas, knowledge and experience and support your arguments with examples and with relevant
evidence.
TEST 3
Writing Task 1
You should spend about 20 minutes on this task.
The pictures below show the changes that took place at Laguna Beach from 1950 to 1990.
Sand dunes
wr
>M3F& Vi-ai-aiaL3L
^ < Landsco|?ed . Hcfel*. /.Rood
sGordens *
. ~/N s &each *. SurP ,
1990 Sch0l
A book for IELTS
137
Section on Writing
Write a report for a university lecturer describing the information shown below.
You should write at least 150 words.
TEST 3
Writing Task 2
You should spend about 40 minutes on this task.
Present a written argument or case for an educated reader with no specialist knowledge of the
following topic:
In recent years, life has become more stressful than it has ever been. As a consequence,
more and more people are suffering from stress-related problems. What factors are contributing
to this increase and what do you think can be done to overcome the current problems?
You should write at least 250 words.
Use your own ideas, knowledge and experience and support your arguments with examples
and with relevant evidence.
138
A book for IELTS
Section on
Speaking
A book for IELTS
139
Section on Speaking
I ntroduction to the Speaking Module
The speaking module for the IELTS exam was changed in J uly 2001. The new speaking test lasts
between 11 and 14 minutes. During the examination you will have a conversation with an examiner, which
is recorded.
There are now three main parts within the oral exam:
P art 1: I ntroduction and interview
In this part of the oral examination, the examiner introduces himself/herself and confirms the identity of
the candidate.
The examiner asks the candidate questions about himself/herself, their home, their interests, studies, etc.
This is very similar to the first part of the oral exam before J uly 2001. For example, you could be asked
the following set of questions:
a) What is your name?
b) Where do you live?
c) Do you have any brothers and sisters?
d) What do they do for a living?
e) What subject are you studying?
f) Why did you choose this subject?
g) How do you use English in your studies?
The first question is obviously just your name, but you can add additional information to your answers:
otherwise, the examiner will be speaking more than you! So, remember to give the examiner evidence of
your ability to use the language. Look at the following short dialogue where the additional information is
marked in bold:
Examiner: What is your name?
Candidate: Sandra Bhatti
Examiner: Where do you live?
Candidate: 1live in London now, but I m ori ginall y from a smal l town in Southern India.
Examiner: Have you got any brothers and sisters?
Candidate: Yes. One brother and two sisters. My brother is two years ol der than me, but both my
si sters, who are twins, are younger than me. They are 17 years of age.
Examiner: What do they do for a living?
Candidate: Only my brother is working. He is an engi neer and hes now working in Saudi Arabia
for a l arge oi l company.
Examiner: Let us now turn to your studies. What subject are you studying?
Candidate: Im studying architecture which 1have been doi ng now for the past 5 years,
Examiner: Why did you choose this subject?
Candidate: 1adore buildings especi al l y ol d ones li ke the Taj Mahal and 1have a thing about
bri dges. My dream is to design a world famous bridge.
Examiner: How do you use English in your studies?
Candidate: 1use it a lot when 1am reading as many of my books on archi tecture are in English.
There is one very important difference between this part of the test and that prior to J uly 2001. The
examiner uses a frame to ask questions and is limited in the help he/she can give you if you cannot, or do
not, answer a question.
140
A book for IELTS
Section on Speaking
P art 2: I ndividual long term
In this part of the oral exam, you are given a card, e.g.
Topi c Card
Describe what you like doing most in your free time.
You should say:
when you first started doing the particular activity
how frequently you do it
whether you do it on your own or with other people
And explain why you like it.
You are given one minute to prepare a short talk, which will then last between one and two minutes.
There is paper and pencil in the exam to make notes. Please note that the examiner is checking not just
your English, but your fluency in speaking. We would advise you not to learn examples of the long turn by
heart.
It is important that you make use of the minute given to organise your answer and make notes.
Example of notes
- swimming
- 5 years
- hated it at first
- 3 times a week
Then when you speak you can do so in an organised
information is attached to the above notes:
- on my own
- relaxing
- feel good
- stops laziness
manner. Look at the following example and see how
I think for me it has to be swimming, which Ive been doing now for the past 5 years. At school,
... where we were encouraged to do compulsory sport, I didnt fancy football or rugby, so I took
up swimming. At first, I must say I ... I hated it with a passion, because I didnt like putting my
head in the water. It just terrified me, but now things couldnt be more different. I now try to get
in at least three half-hour sessions per week, and on holidays, if I can, Ill try to fit it in daily.
I prefer to do it on my own, but obviously now and again some friends tag along - 1cant say I
like them being there, because they tend to want to mess around.... I suppose you could say I am
addicted to it! But its a better addiction than smoking and drinking;... a healthy mind in a healthy
body as my father used to say.... And why do I like it so much? Well, first of all, it helps me to
relax, because it helps me take my mind off things, if Im worried about something. Whats more,
I always feel so good after Ive come out of the swimming pool. It also stops me from being lazy
... like some of my friends.... And what keeps me going? Its not just the adrenaline.... I just have
to look at some of my friends and I know then why I am doing it!
A book for IELTS
141
Section on Speaking
You can see how the notes help you to organise your answer. So that you can get the feel of how much
you have to say, read the above text and time it. Try to speak at natural spoken speed.
After you have finished, the examiner may ask you a few questions related to what you have said. For
example, the examiner might ask you here:
Do you do any other sport? Do you think it is important for people to do regular physical activity? Would
you recommend swimming to other people?
Remember to give full answers, not just Yes/No.
P art 3: Two- way discussion
In this part of the test, the examiner starts a two-way discussion on a subject related to the topic in Part 2.
For example, if you were asked to describe what you like doing most in your free time in Part 2, you
might, for example, have a discussion on leisure, stress in modern life or health. This part of the oral test
lasts 4-5 minutes.
Please note that the questions in this part of the test are of a more abstract nature. For example, you
could be asked the following questions on leisure:
What do you think the advantages are of doing leisure activities?
Is a hobby like chess more important than say a physical activity like swimming?
In what way do leisure activities help us cope with modern life?
Should a leisure activity be incorporated in the working day?
Do you think life will be more stressful or less stressful, in future?
How do mental and physical activities improve health?
Remember as in Part 1that you should give full answers. Note also that you can ask the examiner to
repeat or rephrase the question.
Marking of the oral exam
It is important that you know how the examiners are marking your speaking. You are given marks for:
Fl uency and Coherence, which means how well you can speak naturally without
stopping too much and also being organised.
Lexical Resource, which covers the level and range of your vocabulary.
Grammati cal Range and Accuracy, which covers the level and accuracy of your
grammar.
P ronunciation, which covers the pronunciation of individual words and phrase and
sentence stress.
142
A book for IELTS
Section on Speaking
Exercise 1: I ndividual long term
Look at the Topic Card below, which contains a subject on which you are asked to talk for one to two
minutes.
Topi c Card A
Describe an event in your life which changed you.
You should say:
what the event was
when the event took place
what made the event special
And explain how it changed you.
Look at the notes below for the above talk, which are jumbled.
Example of notes
a) motivated me
b) made friends
c) 7 years ago
d) won money
Now look at the sample answer below. Put the notes in the correct order according to the talk.
I would like to talk about a prize I won,... which I won 7 years ago when I was 15. The prize
was a national writing competition, which, incidentally, I entered without prompting from anyone.
I saw the entry form for a writing competition, a short story of no more than 5,000 words, and I
felt compelled to enter it. What made the whole thing special was not the prize money of 10,000
French francs, but having the story published in a national newspaper. As you can imagine, I was
thrilled to bits and so were my parents, who were quite taken aback,... as I hadnt told anyone
about it. What winning the prize did for me is difficult to explain. But I can say that it changed
my life dramatically. It may sound silly to say so, but it boosted my confidence enormously. I
wasnt doing very well in school at the time, especially in English. Another thing is that it
motivated me in all areas of my life, not just my school work. I started achieving high grades in
all subjects and doing well in sport. And a strange thing was that I started making more friends.
Before that I was quite shy, but afterwards my social life improved.
e) won a writing prize
f) change-confidence
g) national
A book for IELTS
143
Section on Speaking
term: Now look at the following cards for the Individual long
Topi c Card B
Describe somewhere that is speci al to you.
You should say:
where the place is
when you first realised it was special
why you like it
whether you would recommend it as a place
for other people to visit
And explain why it is special to you.
Topi c Card E
Describe the most memorabl e holiday
you have had.
You should say:
when it was
where it was
who you were with
what made it memorable
And explain why it is special to you.
Topi c Card C
Describe a person who has had the most
i nfl uence on your life.
You should say:
who the person is
when and where you first met the person
what made this person so special
And explain why you think the person had such
an effect on you.
Topic Card F
Describe the most i mportant day of your
life.
You should say:
which day it was
why it was important
what happened on that day
And explain whether you think you will have
equally important days in the future.
Topic Card D
Describe somethi ng which annoys you.
You should say:
what it is
when it started annoying you
how it annoys you
what you do when it annoys you
And explain why it annoys you so much.
Topic Card G
Describe your favouri te food.
You should say:
what the food is
how often you eat it
how the food is made
whether you make it yourself
And explain why it is your favourite food.
Prepare notes for each of the Individual long terms and practise speaking using your notes. Time yourself
as you speak. Also think about some questions the examiner might ask you at the end of each long term.
Compare your notes with the samples in the KEY.
14 4
A book for IELTS
Section on Speaking
Exercise 2: Two- way discussion
The discussion below is an example of what you might have in the third section of the Speaking
Component of the exam.
Read the discussion and insert the examiners questions (A-l) in the appropriate space. You may use
each question once only.
Examiners questions
A. And working hours? Should people have a limit on the number of hours they can work per week?
B. What do you think working hours will be like in the future?
C. Should we have more holidays nowadays?
D. And what about any disadvantages that holidays might have?
E. To turn to types of holidays, which do you think are better, long or short holiday breaks?
F. What are the advantages for workers of having holidays?
G. Are holidays of any importance, in your opinion?
H. And what are the arguments against this, if any?
I. What are the advantages of limiting working hours?
Two- way discussion
Examiner: _____1_______________
Candidate: Yes. I think they are actually very important. Of course, there are other things that are of
equal importance in life, but... holidays give us something to look forward to,... just like a
purpose to aim for.
Examiner: _____2_______________
Candidate: A lot of people, in my opinion, work far too hard these days; the saying that all work and
no play makes J ack a dull boy is certainly true. So ... yes, I think we do need more
holidays ... to give us a chance to relax and enjoy life.
Examiner: _____3_______________
Candidate: Id say that holidays are beneficial for workers themselves physically,...
Examiner: Why?
Candidate: Well, because they give workers a good opportunity to recharge their batteries.
Examiner: Anything else?
Candidate: Another thing is that vacations also have a positive effect on employees when they return
to work: they become more productive.
Examiner: _____4_______________
Candidate: I suppose, on the other hand, holidays can sometimes make workers feel dissatisfied with
their jobs and unwilling to return to their working life, as it may seem dull and monotonous
in comparison to the time they have spent on holiday. But I still think that the benefits far
outweigh any disadvantage.
Examiner: _____5_______________
Candidate: Thats a difficult question. Longer breaks have, of course, been very popular up till now,
but more and more people are taking short breaks.
Examiner: And why is this?
Candidate: For instance, the chance to have a break in routine, even say for a couple of days, gives
the worker a feeling of having had a proper break, even though it may have been a short
one. It gives people a chance to unwind, to forget about work for a while and enjoy a
different pace of life.
A book for IELTS
145
Section on Speaking
Examiner:
Candidate:
Examiner:
Candidate:
Examiner:
Candi date:
Examiner:
Candidate:
__________ 6_________
In many countries, I believe there is already a legal limit to the number of hours people
can work per week. But Im not sure whether this is a good thing or not; I suppose it
depends on the job and how much stress and responsibility is involved.
___________ 7__________
Limiting working hours means that workers cannot be exploited, and put under too much
stress and pressure, which could be detrimental to their health. Sometimes,... it could be
dangerous to allow people to work too many hours. For example, an overworked and
exhausted surgeon could make a mistake which could result in the death of a patient.
__________ 8_________
From another point of view, it could be said that it is unfair to tell people how many hours
they can or cant work. If, for example, a fit and healthy person is prepared to work many
hours to earn enough money for himself and his family to have a better standard of living,
should he not be allowed to?
___________ 9__________
In the future, I think the working lives of people will probably become much more flexible.
Most people, in Britain anyway, tend to still work from 9-5. It would be a plus for workers
if they could adapt their working life to fit in with their personal circumstances, With the
growth in technology, it is also now possible for many people to work from home, a trend
which I imagine will continue.
146
A book for IELTS
Section on Speaking
Exercise 3: Example of extended discourse No.2
Look at the dialogue below. The Examiners questions on the left are not in the correct order, but the
candidates answers are. Match the questions and answers in the dialogue. The first question of the
examiner is marked in bold.
When you have finished try to give your own answers to the examiners questions.
1. Such as?
2. So, in what ways would you criticise the British
way of life?
3. More marked, in what way?
4. And is that always a bad thing?
5. But how can young people become independent if
they arent given the chance?
6.1expect family life is different in your home
country?
7. Can you give me an example of this bond?
8. What about differences between parents and, say,
teenagers, are there differences there too?
9. So you think children should live at home as long
as possible?
10. And what are the advantages of having people
around all the time?
A. Well, there are several differences that I have noticed.
First of all, where I come from, the bond between each
generation seems much stronger than in Britain.
B. Yes, for example the older generation, the
grandparents are looked after by their grown-up
children, and more often than not they live with them.
C. Well, for one thing, it means that there is always
someone around to help with the children, the
housework, the shopping or just to provide company for
another member of the family.
D. Oh yes and in many ways they are even more
pronounced.
E. Well, for instance in my country teenagers would never
dream of leaving home to live somewhere else, but, in
the UK, its almost the norm.
F. Yes, if it is possible, because they need their parents
both financially and, in other ways, too, for example, in
an emotional or educational capacity.
G. Independence is something that comes gradually to
young people in my country, but here it seems to be an
instant thing. At home, young people tend to leave their
parents home only when they get married and not
always then either.
H. Well, to start with, I think one of the disadvantages of
there being weaker family ties than in my country is
that children are more easily influenced by forces
outside the home rather than by their parents.
I. Like films, their peers, the media in all its forms.
J . No not necessarily, but I do feel that in the UK there is a
lack of respect generally for parents as far as
teenagers are concerned.
A book for IELTS
14 7
Section on Speaking
Exercise 4 : Your future plans
In the third part of the Speaking Module, you need to be able to talk about your future plans. You should
think beforehand about what you are going to say, but you should not learn a speech by heart. Remember
the examiner is testing your ability to use the language, not to remember it.
This exercise looks at some of the ways you talk about the future in English.
The future in English is expressed in many ways. Study Questions (i-vii) below, which ask you about
what way you look at the future.
Do you
i. make firm plans for the future?
ii. plan to finish something before a particular time?
iii. dream about doing something at a particular time in the future?
Or do you
iv. run your life according to a timetable or calendar?
v. intend to do things, but cant make firm decisions?
vi. make decisions about your future without really thinking?
Or are you
vii. very indecisive about your future?
Now look at the statements below and match them with the categories above.
A. I am going to start working once I finish university
B. When I have graduated, I intend to find a good job.
C. I am planning to go to university in the future.
D. I am intending to go to university in the near future.
E. If I am successful in the IELTS, my plan is to do a postgraduate course.
F. Im starting university next October.
G. Ill have finished university in three years time.
H. I am having a small party to celebrate the completion of my IELTS exam.
I. This time next year Ill be studying at university, I hope.
J . The next step in my career, after this one year course, is to find a good job.
K. Mmm, Ill become a doctor!
L. In ten years time, Ill be writing full-time, I hope.
M. I might be going to university next autumn, I dont really know.
14 8
A book for IELTS
Section on Speaking
Exercise 5: Questi ons about the future
Now look at Questions 1-10 below, which contain questions about the future. You can see that there are
four alternative answers for each question. Decide which answer is the most appropriate in each case.
Note that more than one answer may be suitable.
1. Do you think teachers will disappear in the future?
(a) Well, I suppose some teachers will be replaced by machines.
(b) Yes. Machines will replace teachers.
(c) Well, some teachers are likely to be replaced by machines.
(d) Well, I think some teachers will probably be replaced by machines.
2. Will people be able to travel on holiday to places like the moon?
(a) I dont see why not. People are probably going to be able to have holidays in space way beyond
the moon.
(b) There is every likelihood that people will have holidays in space way beyond the moon.
(c) I dont see why not. People are probably having holidays in space way beyond the moon.
(d) I dont see why not. People will probably have been having holidays in space way beyond the moon.
3. Do you believe it will be possible to feed all the people in the world in the future?
(a) Yes, I think so. Well be able to develop new ways of growing food.
(b) Yes, I think so. Well likely develop new ways of growing food.
(c) Yes, I think so. Within the next few decades, well have developed new ways to produce
more food.
(d) Yes, I think so. Well be producing more and more food as the world population grows.
4 . What about living in citi es? Will it be any di fferent from now in the future?
(a) Well, Im afraid its likely that theyll be much more dangerous in the future than they are now.
(b) Well, Imafraid I have to say that I think theyll certainly have become much more dangerous in
the future than they are now.
(c) Well, Im afraid I have to say that I think theyll certainly have become much more dangerous by
the end of the decade than they are now.
(d) Well, I think they may be much safer in the future than they are now.
5. What are you going to do once you finish university?
(a) Well, I intend to spend a year travelling round the world.
(b) Well, I think Id like to spend a year travelling round the world.
(c) Well, Imintending to spend a year travelling round the world.
(d) Well, Ill be taking a year off to spend a year travelling round the world.
6. When you have graduated next year, what do you intend to do?
(a) I plan to take time off before starting work.
(b) Mmm, well, Ill take time off before starting work.
(c) Implanning to take time off before starting work.
(d) Yes, I take time off before starting work.
A book for IELTS
149
Section on Speaking
7. Any pl ans for after graduati on?
(a) Yes, I start work immediately.
(b) Mmm, I know, Ill go abroad for a few months.
(c) Mmm, Ill be going abroad for a few weeks.
(d) Ill hope to go abroad for a few months.
8. Are you intending to go to university in the near future?
(a) Yes, next September.
(b) Yes, I start next September.
(c) Yes, Im starting next September.
(d) Yes, I might start next September.
9. Do you have any thoughts about where youd like to work?
(a) I was thinking of applying for a research post in China.
(b) I like to work somewhere in South-east Asia.
(c) Im really not decided yet.
(d) Ill like working in Australia or New Zealand, I think.
10. What do you hope to have achieved in two years time?
(a) I hope to qualify as an accountant.
(b) I hope Ill be finally working as an accountant.
(c) I hope I finish all my accountancy exams.
(d) I hope Ill have finished all my accountancy exams.
11. Are you doing anythi ng to cel ebrate the completion of your I ELTS exam?
(a) Ill be having a rest.
(b) Yes I have a small get-together with some friends.
(c) Yes, I think Ill have a small get together with some friends.
(d) Ill have had a small get-together with some friends and well probably do something.
12. What do you thi nk youll be doing this time next year?
(a) I hope to start my degree course.
(b) I hope Ill start my degree course.
(c) I hope I get on my degree course.
(d) I hope Ill be studying at university.
13. What is the next step as far as your career is concerned?
(a) Ill apply for a job.
(b) I start a postgraduate course immediately once I get through the entrance exam.
(c) If I pass all my exams, I can start work immediately.
(d) Im starting work immediately.
14 . Where do you see yourself in ten years time?
(a) Hopefully, Ill be working as a teacher.
(b) Hopefully, Ill have been working for quite a number of years.
(c) Ill be a politician!
(d) Happily living in a cottage in the countryside, writing books and making jam.
150
A book for IELTS
Listening Module
Key to Tests I - 4
A book for IELTS
151
Key to Listening Practice Tests
P racti ce Test 1 Section 1
Questions 1- 5
SA: ...versity Bookshop, Bridge Street, Doris speaking,
can I help you?
S: Is that the University Bookshop?
SA. Yes, it is.
S: Id like to place an order for some books, if I may.
SA Have you got an account with us?
S: No, not yet. I havent started university yet.
Ill be starting in October, but Ill be coming in early to
have a look round and to get settled in and wanted to
order some books.
SA: Right. I see. Would you like to open an account?
S: Mmm, I dont know.
SA: Well, you get a student discount on all book purchases.
S: Oh! And how much is that, then?
SA: 15% for fi rst year students.
S: 15%! That sounds all right.
SA: You just have to make sure that you settle your account
at the end of each month.
S: OK. Well, mm, I might as well open one, then.
SA: I just need to take down some details. Do you want the
account to be at your term time address or your home
address?
S: Theyre the same.
SA: Right. First of all, can I have your name?
S: Nasreen Kerrigan.
SA: Is that, K , I ...
S: No, Ill have to spell it for you. Its K, E for everyone,
double R, I , G for Go, A and N for Nobody.
SA: A N for Nobody. ...Kerrigan.
S: Yes. Thats it.
SA: And your address?
S: Its 127a Adel aide Mansions ...
SA: Hold on. 117a ... Ade ...
S: No, 127a ...
SA: Ok, Right. And Adelaide, that s A, D, E for everyone,
L, A , I , D, and E for everyone.
S: Yes, thats it. Then Mansions.
SA: Mansions. Right.
S: Compton Street.
SA: Right.
S: London.
SA: London. And the postcode?
S: SE19.
SA: SE ...19.
S: 7 FT
SA: 7?
S: Yes 7 F for Freddi e and T for Tommy.
SA: FT. Right. So let me just check that. Mm
127a Adel aide Mansions, Compton Street,
London SE19 7FT.
S: Thats correct.
SA: And are you on the telephone?
S: Yes, its 0181 797 4882.
SA: 797 ...
S: 4882.
SA: 4882.
S: Yes, thats it.
1. 15%/ fifteen percent/per cent
2. Kerrigan
3. 127a Adelaide
4. 19 7FT
5. 797 4882
Questions 6- 10
SA: Right, thats that out of the way. And which books would
you like to order?
S: Well, I just want four books to start off with.
SA: Hmm.
S: Have you got Physics in the Age of Technology by
Adrianna Stern.
SA: Physics in the Age of... its out of stock, Imafraid.
S: Oh, OK.
SA: Would you like me to order it for you?
S: No, what about mm. Mathematics in Physics by Professor I
Lovatt. Experimental...
SA: J ust, just wait, Mathemati cs in ... P hysics b y ...
P rofessor I Lovatt. Lets just check that. Right, here
we are. Yes,.... weve got it in stock. I t s 27.95.
S: 27.95! With the discount?
SA: Imafraid, yes. Ah, the next one?
S: Experimental P hysics by Simon Blair and Violet Boyd.
SA: Experimental P hysics by Simon Blair and Violet
Boyd. OK, l ets see ....Thats 29.50.
S: OK and P hysi cs for the fi rst year student by A. Laska.
SA: Physics for the first year student... Thats ... 25.
S: OK. Ill stick with these three for the moment.
SA: Right. Would you like to have the books posted to you?
S: No, No its its okay. Ill come in one day this week and pick
them up.
SA: Right. When you come in, can you bring two forms of
i denti fication.
S: OK, Like what?
SA: A credit c ar d ,... dri ving l i cence,... a cheque card and
S: Oh, OK.
SA: ... and your l etter confirming admission to the
university.
S: Yeah, OK. What time do you close?
SA: Were open until 6pm every day except Thursday, when
we close at 7.30. ,
S: And youre on which floor? \
SA: The P hysi cs Department is in the basement. The
books wi ll be kept here and as youre paying by
account well post the bill to you.
S: Thanks. Bye.
SA: Bye-Bye.
6. s / 7. P hysics 8. 25 9. D 10. B
152
A book for IELTS
Key to Listening Practice Tests
Note: Section 1 usually tests your ability to extract basic
information from a dialogue. It is easy to pick up marks
in this Section. However, it is also easy to lose them. If
you need a high grade you should be aiming to get all
of the first section correct.
Practice Test 1 Section 2
~ ________________________________
Questions 11- 14
Good morning. My name is Dave Eastman and Imone of the
five student counsell ors in the university. And Imhere today
to introduce myself to you briefly and to say just a few words
about the Student Welfare Service. But before I begin, Id like
to thank your Faculty Head, Professor Anwar, for inviting me
here to talk to you. At the end, Ill throw questions open to the
floor.
The service we offer is available on all six sites of the university
campus. The three main sites have a counsellor available
week-days, Monday to Thursday, between 9.30 amand 4.00
pm. On this site, the office is situated in the Queens Building,
on the fi rst floor. I understand that all of you are based on this
site, so I wont go into details about the others.
11. C 12. B 13. A 14 . D
Questions 15- 20
Information about the service and the other offices is contained
in this leaflet, which you can pick up practically everywhere on
campus. We also run a Helpline, which is open after the office
is closed. The number for the line is 0345 1607 2390. This
number with all the others, my own, included, is contained in the
leaflet. Obviously, we would like to make the Helpline available
24 hours a day, but the money simply isnt there, so we have to
rely on the generosity of volunteers. I can say on average the
line is open about 3 hours per evening most evenings and
roughly 8 hours at weekends. If there is no-one to take your
call, or in the event of an emergency, there will be a message
on the answering machine which will give you other contact
numbers.
You might be thinking why not just give us the leaflet and get on
with the lecture. Well, the answer to that, as you probably well
know, is that people dont always read leaflets; they look at them
and say: Thats not for me.
People contact us for a vari ety of reasons. They may come to
see us if they feel isolated, because its the first time many have
been away from home; or they may have personal relationship
problems; or money problems. Certain times of the year bring
increased pressure to bear on students, the exam time being
the main one and Imnot just talking about Finals. Preparing a
paper for a tutorial or a seminar can also be a stressful exercise.
On occasions like this, we are available to help you.
We dont pretend that we have an answer for every problem,
but we can try and help; and if we cant we can usually refer you
to someone who can.
I would also like to take this opportunity to ask for volunteers for
our advice Helpline. You dont need any previous experience
and, because you are newcomers to the university, it does not
mean that you do not have anything to offer. We provide
training and support for all volunteers. So if youd like to get
involved see me at the end of this session.
Id like to thank you for listening and now its your chance to ask
some questions.... Yes the gentleman in the third row in the red
T-shirt.
15. everywhere on campus
16. generosity of volunteers
17. roughly 8/eight hours
18. variety of reasons
19. someone who can
20. training and support
Note: You can see that the level of difficulty has increased in
this section. Always be careful with questions like
number 13. It is tempting to write down the answer for
the first number you hear, i.e. A six.
Note that the answers for 16 and 17 come close together.
Always be ready to write down the next answer. Do not
assume that the answers will be wide apart.
It is also easy to lose concentration as you are listening.
You need to practise holding your concentration. There
is quite a big gap between the information in 17 and 18,
which tests your ability to concentrate as you listen.
Note that to answer the questions you do not need to listen to
all the information in the speech. Try to learn to treat
the questions as markers and listen only for that
information. When you are talking to someone in your
own language or in English, you hear every word, but
you do not listen to all of them!
Practice Test 1 Section 3
Questions 21- 23
L: Come in!
J : Hello, Dr Townsend.
L: Ah - hello J im, come and sit down. Now - its about this
essay of yours, am I right?
J : Yes, the one on global employment.
L: Ah yes, global employment, lets see ...What was the exact
title again?
J : Information Tech ...
L: Right, here it is:" Information Technology will put millions
of people out of work throughout the world in the
coming decades. Explore the arguments on both sides
of this debate and give your opinion.
J : Yep, thats it.
L: Yes, on the whole, I was very pleased with what you wrote
... mm...Youve presented the different points of view
clearly.
J : Thank you.
L: Did you give the sources for your statistics?
J : Yes, I ...
L: Ah, yes, I see, the World Bank and the OECD. Where
did you get the figures from?
J : On the Internet.
L: Right, I see. OK - well, lets have a closer look.
J : OK.
A book for IELTS
153
Key to Listening Practice Tests
L: Now, near the beginning, you draw a parallel between
present day fears about machines replacing people,
J : Yeah.
L: and the 19th Century Luddites. Its an appropriate parallel,
but dont you think it might be better to explain who the
Luddites were?
J : Well, I mm did think about it, but ...ah ..
L: Yes?
J : I thought it might be a little bit simplistic.
L: Well, yes, maybe, but a short sentence might help just to
show the connection between then and now.
21. global employment
22. The World Bank
23. machines replacing peopl e
The test is just checking discrete points of information
as in Sections 1 and 2. You just have to use the
questions in the exercise as markers for the informatioi
on the tape.
Questions 24 - 27
L: Good. Lets move on then.
J : Right.
L: So, in the first paragraph you describe three reasons for
peoples fears: IT is more pervasive in its impact than
the effect of steam power or electricity, affecting service
industries as well as traditional manufacturing. Second,
I T is being introduced faster than earl ier new
technol ogi es and thirdly, ... that it makes it
possible for jobs to be easil y moved from one place
to another. Could you have described any other
reservations?
J : Well, I suppose I could have said that the richer industrial
economies fear the easy transfer of their jobs to poorer
and, therefore, cheaper economies, but I felt it was too
restricted a fear. You could also blame the media for
their coverage of large job losses at big firms without
publicising small business creation.
L: I see - fair enough. So then you continue with two
paragraphs saying why people need not be afraid. I
see you start with the historic evidence, that over the
past 200 years of huge technol ogi cal advance,
employment and real incomes in rich industrial
countries have risen fai rly continuousl y,
J : Yes....
L: and you illustrate it by an OECD chart. Then you state that
although jobs are destroyed by new technology, new
ones are constantly being created which offset the
losses - i liked your example here: that as blacksmiths
and coachmen disappeared, mechanics, drivers and
car salesmen took their place.
24 . b 25. b 26. a 27. b
This part of Section 3 is more difficult than any of the
previous Questions 1-23. The nature of the questions
has begun to change. Instead of just giving information
straight from the conversation, you are being asked to
summarise what is being said. Also the detail is quite
close together, so you need to be very quick.
Questions 28- 30
L: Now, where were we?
J : We were ...
L: Yes, you said that although new technology may reduce
the amount of labour necessary to produce a given
volume of output, this doesnt necessarily reduce
overall unemployment,
J : Employment,
L: Sorry, yes, employment, because technology can boost
output and create new demand and new products.
J : Yes.
L: Perhaps you could have given some examples here of
products which didnt exist 20 years ago?
J : You mean things like VCRs, mm ... personal stereos, soft
contact lenses! Yes, mm, I suppose I should have done.
L: And, of course, computers themselves, both personal
and industrial! Good! So lets have a look at your
conclusion - so you believe that on balance, given a
favourable business climate, and a well educated,
high- skil led workforce, theres no reason why I T
should destroy jobs.
J : Yes.
L: You havent ah explained what you mean by a
favourable business cl i mate.
J : Mmm well 11mean an environment where there arent
too many restri ctions, rules and regulations like
protectionism over goods and restrictions on work
practices and, perhaps, minimum wage levels that are
too high.
L: I see. Well, youve certainly thought through the issues,
but they are complex and perhaps you could have
gone into them rather more deeply. However, as I said
at the beginning, youre good and clear about your
points, so Ive marked it.............
28. C 29. D 30. A
This sub-section is testing understanding of points in the
conversation
P racti ce Test 1 Section 4
Questions 31- 37
Good afternoon, and welcome to everybody. My name is Dr
Paulette Southfield and I specialise in European product
desi gn in the Department of Product and Furniture Design. It
has fallen on me to kick off your first term with the introductory
lecture. And after much thought looking for a fancy title, I
decided to call my talk today, simply: What is design for?
What is design for? is one of the most important questions that
we seek to answer in this department. After all, an electric kettle
is no more than a vessel with a heating element, a chair - no
more than a seat and back with enough legs for support, and a
motor car no more than a box with seats, four wheels and an
engine. But, we all know that a kettle can pour badly and be
awkward to handle, a chair uncomfortable and ugly to look at
and a car unreliable and unattractive. The answer to my
question is, of course, implicit in these examples: good design
makes for eff icient products, like an efficient kettle, maybe
cordless and manageable by arthritic or elderly hands; a well
designed chair is comfortable and an inviting asset to our
living-rooms and a carefully designed car combines maximum
154
A book for IELTS
Key to Listening P ractice Tests
saf et y, comf or t and el egan ce. Th e concl usi on we can dr aw f rom
this is t hat t ne roi e of oesi gn - to par aphr as e Ter en c e Conr an
- is to ensur e t hat t hi ngs do t he j ob t hey wer e intended to do
t hat t hey ar e wel l made and ef f i ci ent and t hat t hey ar e pl easi ng
to use and to l ook at.
Th er e ar e. however , ot her r easons f or t he i mpor t ance of desi gn
Adverti si ng and t he medi a f uel t he acqui si t i ve nat ur e of
consumer i sm but, t oget her wi th gr eat er choi ce, t ney encour age
a mor e di scer ni ng appr oach f rom t n e publ i c wno can compar e
t he qual i t i es of one pr oduct wi th t hose of anot her . Th e aest het i c
appeal of a bol d new t abl e l amp can be wei ghed agai nst t ne
cnar ms of a dozen ot her s - whi l e t he choi ce of a new personal
st er eo may i nvol ve its st yi i sh ap p ear an c e as much as its
effi ci ent functi on.
31. European product design
32. introductory lecture
33. design
You can see that the first three answers (31-33:
are fairly straightforward and give a very broad
summary of the lecture.
34 . efficient products
35. intended to (do)
36. adverti sing/adverts (and) the med i a
37. efficient function
You can see that after the introduction, the amount of detailed
information in the speech has increased. Tne type of checking
in the listening has changed from seeing if you understand
specific points to understanding chunks of information
Compare this with the basic information checK in Section 1 cf
the Test. Again, it is not important that you understano even
piece of information but that you understand the overall
meaning.
Questions 38- 4 1
And yet t her e is anot her r eason f or t he en han c ed rol e of t he
desi gner in t o day s worl d of r api dl y advanci ng t echnol ogy. As
the life cycle of every product grows ever shorter, t h e
designer has to be worki ng on an updated model as soon
as the latest one is off the drawing board. Nowher e is this
mor e evi dent t han in t he desi gn of mot or cars. Th e same
t echnol ogi cal ad v an c e has al so mad e a huge i mpact in t he field
of m ed i c i n e an d h er e t h e d es i g n er is i n v o l v ed in the
development of new equi pment, from the endoscope, the
increasingly sophisticated dentists chair and the robotic
hospital porter, to the artifi cial hip repl acement and other
prostheses.
Fi nal l y, we shoul d not f or get t he rol e of desi gn in t he mar ket i ng
war s. As manufacturers battle to enhance the desirability
of thei r products over those of their competitors, the
talents, imagination and training of their designers are
paramount. A pr oper appr eci at i on of this f act or can ev en be
si gni f i cant f or nat i onal ec onomi es and t hei r expor t market s.
i woul d li ke to end t hough, wi th a f ew words on t he rel at i onshi p
bet ween good desi gn ana t hat el usi ve f act or - qual i t y of life I f
we st art by agr eei ng t hat l iving is mor e t han just exi st i ng we
must admit that l i v i n g wi th everyday t n i n g s m a t ar e
aestheti call y p l eas i n g as weli as ef f ec t i v e, en h an c es t h at
quality. Most of us r eact agai nst t hi ngs whi ch ar e coar se, f eebl e
or pr et ent i ous, but ar e dr awn t owar ds t hi ngs whi ch embody
ef f i ci ency, i magi nat i on and st yl e, in t he wor ds of Fr ench
desi gner , Roger Tai l on, desi gn is first and foremost an attitude.
Now if anyone woul d l ike to ask any quest i ons, or rai se any
f urt her poi nts
38. D 39. A 4 0 . B 4 1. C
The answers nere are more difficult as they paraphrase
and summarise parts of tne lecture. Compare this with
questions 34-37 where the summaries were in the
speech.
| |
I Practice Test 2 Section 1 {
C: I d li ke to send some f l ower s and some chocol at es.
SA Ok, I ll j ust get t he com ... out er on ... Ri ght. Can I j ust
t ak e your det ai l s?
r
w. Yes, cert ai nl y.
SA: Your name?
C: Angel a Love.
c a
Angel a Love. And your ad ar ess?
n
14 4 a Or cnar a Hei ght s. Mar sh Dri ve, Edi nbur gh.
SA Ri gnt , And t ne post code' 7
C. Ah. 1do nt Know . i'm j ust st ayi ng here for a while
SA Oh I t d o es nt mat t er. Wh at ., Wh at exact l y is it youd like
to send?
Q-
Anm. a bouauet of flowers
SA: Ana how much woul d you li ke 10 spend?
f ' .
30
SA' Any par t i cul ar f l ower s9
C: 1dont Know mmm. somet hi ng exot i c per haps.
SA OK. Ana you wan t ed a oox of choc o l at es 7
C. Yeah .
SA: To wnat vai ue?
n.
^ . Oh. say 25
SA: Ri ght . 25. And t he chocol at es, what woul d you l ike ah
dark, whi t e, mil k, l i dueurs, or a mi xt ure?
C: Well, a mixture, 1suppose, but no liqueurs. And more
white chocol ates than the others.
SA: I'll j ust wr i t e this on t he or der f orm: mi xt ure - most l y
whi t e/no l i queurs.
That ' s it.
SA: And t h es e ar e to go wi t hi n Edi nbur gh?
C: No, t h ey re to go to Car di f f , in Wal es .
SA: Th er ell be a del i very' char ge of 19 for bofh i t ems, I m
af rai d.
c
For dot h, not each?
SA: Yes Th at s right.
- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 1
1. A 2 D 3. 0 4 . C |
|
j SA: Ana how woul d you l i ke to pay. madam?
I C: By Swi t ch Car d, if I may.
A book for IELTS
155
Key to Listening Practice Tests
SA: Of course, thats fine. And the number?
C: Its 569 000
SA: 569 000
C: 212 897
SA: 212 897
C: 884 223
SA: 884 223
C: 7.
SA: 7.
SA: Can I just check that? 569 000 212 897 884 223 7.
C: Yes, thats it.
SA: So, the total amount to be debited is 74.
C: OK.
SA: And to whom would you like them sent?
C: To Mrs Easter
SA: Thats E AS TE R?
C: Yes.
SA: And the address?
C: 27
SA: 27
C: Rowntree Road
SA: Is that R O W N T R Double E.
C: Yes. Thats it. Cardiff.
SA: Cardiff.
C: CA13 8YU.
SA: CA13 8YU. And did you want any message to go with
the flowers and chocolates?
C: Yes, mmm, Congratulations on passing your test! Just
let me know when youre out on the road! Love Angie.
SA: Someones just passed their driving test, then.
C: Yes, my mother.
SA: Your mother?
C: Yeah, its her sixth attempt.
SA: Oh, right; that is a cause for celebration!
C: Yes.
SA: And, when would you like them delivered?
C: The day after tomorrow, between 9 and 11 am.
SA: Thats the 17th in the morning between 9 and 11.1 just
need to take a daytime contact number.
C: Ill give you my mobile number; its 0963 371 555
SA: 0963 317
C: No 371 555
SA: 371 555. Ill arrange this for you now.
C: OK, thank you.
SA: Thank you. Good-bye. Have a nice day.
C: You too. Good-bye.
5. 212 897
6. Easter
7. Rowntree Road
8. passing your test
9. 17th/seventeenth
10. 9 [and] 11/ nine [and] eleven
Just like the first section in Test 1. The exercises are testing
your ability to extract basic information from a simple
dialogue.
P ractice Test 2 Section 2
Questions 11- 13
Good afternoon, my name is Mick Clarke and Imthe sports rep
from the Students Union. As well as these talks on the university
sports facilities, information will be put up on noti ce- boards all
over the campus, so you will definitely ali know where to find
us.
Well, as you have probably realised the university is spread all
over the place and the sports facilities are, Im afraid, no
different. I f you look at the map here on the screen, youll see
we we are here on Thames Street opposite the city Library, If
you look down at the bottom of this map on the right youll see
Burse Road. On the left of the police station, between the
shopping complex and the theatre, and the Phoenix theatre, is
the university sports complex.
11. B 12. A 13. A
This is just a test of basic information.
Questions 14 - 17
The complex is arranged over four floors; two above ground and
two below. The buildings were just completed iast year funded
by an anonymous donor. The swimming pool is on the lower
ground floor and we are very lucky in that a full - sized Ol ympic
pool is to be bui lt by the end of this academic year along
wi th a new sauna. In addition, there are a number of other
facilities, including various courts, and I would strongly advise
you to book well in advance if you want to use any of these
courts, as they are very much in demand. Mm, We have, full
changing facilities, three large halls for aerobics and other
classes, three squash courts, and two badminton courts. And
two other exciting developments in the pipeline are a
state- of- the- art gym and an ice- skati ng rink. There are also
courts for playing softball and basketball. And there is, of course,
a cafeteria, which is run by the Students Union, so the prices
are reasonable. A wel come addi ti on is the bar, which is due
to open shortly.
14 . D 15. F 16. G 17. K
You need to be careful here. We do not always talk about
the future by using the Simple Future. This is a good test
of comprehension. Notice the different ways the speaker
talks about the developments: is to be built/is in the
pipeline; is due to open shortly.
Questions 18- 20
For outdoor sports, Imafraid, we have to go further afield. The
university grounds for rugby, football, hockey and cricket are on
the edge of the city centre in the southwest, on the north
bank of the ri ver as you can see from this map. The rowing
and canoeing clubs, which are very popular, also run from there.
The only bus that goes to the university sports fields directly
from here is the 553; no sorry, i t s the 53. It is fortunately very
frequent and runs late into the night; the last buses either way
are around 12.30. But there is also a mini-bus service, which is
pretty frequent and reliable, and the times are posted at the
Students Union office.
156
A book for IELTS
Key to Listening Practice Tests
If you want to join up for any of the clubs, you just have to see
the reps on the stalls at the different Societies stalls outside.
Anyway, thanks for taking the time to come in and listen and I
wish you every success whether you decide to take up some
form of sport or not.
18. B 19. D 20. A
Practice Test 2 Section 3
Questions 21-26
L = Dr Warner; S = Sandra; D = Derek
Knock
L: Come in! .... ah Sandra and Derek. Come in, come in.
S: Good morning, Dr Warner.
L: Good morning, Sandra.
D: Good morning, Dr Warner.
L: Good morning Derek.
D: We know youre busy, but have you got a moment?
L: Yes, for the moment, Imfree. What can I do for you?
S: We just wanted to ask your advice about applying for
awards
L: Oh, right. Ah. Which awards are you interested in?
D: Well, Iminterested in the FBT Award for a grant to
travel abroad.
S: And Id like to apply for the Bisiker Travel Award for a
research grant in Entomology in J ordan.
L: Okay. Ah. You do know that you have to satisfy a number
of criteria to be eligible for each award.
S: Yesss...
L: The book is here somewhere.... Right, here it is. Ah. For
you Derek,... Ah. Lets see, The FBT Award. Mmm.
The conditions for that are ... You have to be in your
fourth y ear ,... as you are.
D: Okay.
L: You have to be a British or Commonwealth citizen. So
youre okay on that one, as well.
D: Yes.
L: And you have to come in the top fi ve students in
your year in your Finals.
D: Ahh. Right. Well, obviously, that I wont know until Ive
taken my exams.
L: No, but you should put in the application now, as the
deadli ne is the end of June, no sorry its May ... and
thats before the exams even start. So they expect you
to tell them afterwards.
D: And are there any other criteria?
L: Lets see. Mmm ... Well, it says here you have to be
under 25 years of age at the end of your final year.
Are you?
D: I wont be 25 until September 27th. So thats okay.
And do I need any referees?
L: Yes, Ah, two. And I amhappy to do one for you and ...
D: I was also thinking of asking Dr J ameson.
L: Yes, Imsure hell gladly do one for you.
21. travel abroad
22. 4 th/fourth
23. top fi ve/5 students
24 . end of May
25. twenty- fi ve/25
26. two/2
The information relating to the conditions for the award
comes in quick succession. You need to learn to practise
processing information quickly as you listen.
Questions 27-30
L: And Sandra ...
S: Yes.
L: The Bisi ker Award is a lot stricter, as i ts for a much
larger sum of money. And you must reali se that the
competition is very sti ff indeed.
S: Yes, Ive heard its not easy to get one as there are only
three per year,
L: Yes, youre right. Unlike the FBT award, for which there
are10 bursaries. The first thing you have to know is that
application is by way of a 5,000 word summary
outli ning how you intend to use the money; of
course, accompani ed by a covering one page form
with all your personal details.
S: Yes, I know about that, but what I wanted to know is
whether there are examples of other applications I can
look at.
L: Well, not really. Ah. The summary has to be very
much an original piece and that I cannot emphasise
enough. If there are any signs of it having been copied,
then ...
S: I see, but will you be able to read it through for me?
L: Oh I dont see why not.
S: Oh thats alright, then. What do you think my chances are
of my getting one of the grants?
L: Its difficult to say. Ah. Theres usually about 20 to 30
people applying every year.
S: And this year?
L: Well, Id imagine its about the same.
S: Who decides?
L: Well, there is a panel of five trustees and once you have
submitted everything ...
S: Mhmm
L: to the Departmental secretary, they each receive a copy
of your full application.
S: But do you think I stand a chance?
L: Well, as I said its not easy to say; its up to the Trustees.
S: Okay.
L: Another thing that I would stress is that the
appl icati ons must be typed, very ti dy and properly
bound.
S: With a ring binder?
L: Yes ... There have been complaints in previous years
about the lack of care taken in completing the forms
and essays. Ah. This applies to you too, Derek.
D: Yes. Well, its only fair; after all we are asking for help.
L: Yes. Is there anything else I can help you with while
youre here Sandra?
A book for IELTS
157
Key to Listening Practice Tests
S: No. Thank you very much for all your help.
L: Derek?
D: No. And thank you for your help.
27. D 28. B 29. A 30. D
Questi ons 27 and 28 check basic detail regarding the
award Sandra is applying for. The next questions check
your interpretation of the function/meaning of what the
lecturer says. We would advise you for all parts of the
IELTS test, not just the listening, to study modal verbs, e.g.
to have to, should, may etc, and complex tenses. You need
to understand more than just the simple tenses like the
Simple Present Simple Future, Simple Past etc. Compare
Questi ons 14 -17 in Section 2 of this Test.
P ractice Test 2 Section 4
Questions 31- 36
Thank you for inviting me here to speak to you today at your
department of Social Sciences. As Imsure you already know,
the title of my talk, Europe goes grey, relates to the marked
demographic change which has taken place in Europe since
the 1960s. J ust a few statistics showing the projected trends will
illustrate this.
By the year 2029, almost one in four of the populati on of
the UK will be over the present retirement age of 60 years for
women and 65 for men. By the year 2020, I taly, for example,
will have both the ol dest population wi th 23.2% aged 65 and
over, and at the same time, the lowest fertility rate. Furthermore,
a 1997 report from the UK Office for National Statistics notes
that since 1950, the number of centenarians has increased at
the rate of just under 7% a year - faster than for most other
age groups - and will continue to do so into the next century.
The main reasons for the generally increased life-span are
self-evident. These are, simply, a better diet, better housing and
above all, the ever- improving standard of health care.
The social reasons for the changed demographic profile of
Europe - that is, the increasing proportion of the elderly, relative
to the middle and steadily diminishing young generations - are,
of course, the falling birth rate, as a result of widespread birth
control and the education and increasing participation of
women in the workforce.
31. [marked] demographi c change
32. twenty- fi ve/25
33. I taly
34 . just under 7
35. ever- improving standard
36. (widespread) birth control
Questions 37- 4 0
This change raises two profound questions - one social and one
economic - and it is these that I propose to examine here today.
At the end I intend to share with you a few thoughts on how we
can help to make the lives of those in the third age, more fulfilling
and rewarding.
Firstly, we need to recognise that the el derl y are not a
homogeneous group. They can range from a fit, active and
independent 85-year-old, to a 65-year-old with rapidly
advancing Alzheimers disease, to a retired 55-year-old with
both a dependent parent and still dependent student children.
The social aspect I referred to earlier is, of course, the big
question: who will care for the elderly? The question is a
complex one and I would like to illustrate this by making a few
comparisons with the past. I n earl ier ti mes, large extended
famil i es living in the same area, were the norm. Thi s meant
the sharing of care for the grandparents generation was
usual . Now, however, the mobi l i t y of the population
combined wi th smal ler famil i es often means there are, quite
simpl y, no famil y members to take care of an older person.
The breakdown of traditional family structures and the increase
in divorce has exacerbated this.
The other big question, the economic one, involves the
increasing cost of adjustment to this situation, and how the
burden of this cost can most equitably be shared between, on
the one hand, the elderly and their families and, on the other,
the relatively smaller number of people of working age whose
tax contributions have to be used to fund pensions and services
for an increasingly elderly population as well as all the other
demands on the public purse.
The questions raised by this demographic change are
exercising Governments all over Europe, and t her e is
natural l y, wi despread debate about how best to help
f i nanci al l y those who can remai n independent, while
supporting those who cannot, and ensuring that they continue
a sometimes failing life, with dignity.
I promised to finish with a few thoughts about how we might
come closer to achieving this. More imaginative use is being
made of existing property by adapting it for elderly, often less
able people, and their needs are now being kept in mind by
planners, Local Authorities and transport providers. But not
forgetting the cry - where does the money come from - we need
radically to rethink the arrangements for funding pensions and
younger peoples planning for retirement. I nnovative
insurance schemes should be developed to assist people
in provi ding for the future, and financial institutions ought to
be thinking about these.
So I will close by repeating that I believe we should do everything
to enable the elderly to live meaningful and rewarding lives. After
all, we will be in the same situation, all too soon.
Thank you, and I would welcome any questions or comments
from the floor.
37. C 38. C 39. B 4 0. A
The information comes thick and fast in this lecture. The
questions relating to the Projections are fairly
straightforward. However, you need to be able to process
the information rapidly. The layout of the question prepares
you for the information need to fill 35, but for 36 you have
to be on the alert as it is the first one in the sequence. If
you find it difficult to catch the answer to 36 at the first
attempt, listen several times and try to catch the
information. Again, remember that you do not need to
understand everything that is being said.
These questions are much more difficult than the earlier
part of this section, because they are analysing much larger
chunks of text. The two tests so far, it is hoped, show you
how the listening test in the IELTS exam becomes
progressively more difficult.
158
A book for IELTS
Key to Listening Practice Tests
P ractice Test 3 Section 1
Questions 1- 7
P GS =postgraduate student; UGS =undergraduate student
PGS: Ima research student in the Social Sciences
department
UGS: Yes?
PGS: Would you mind if I ask you a few questions to help me
complete this questionnaire?
UGS: Mmm, well...
PGS: Are you an undergraduate?
UGS: Yes. Imin my second year. Is this going to take long?
PGS: Well, no it shouldnt. Do you mind?
UGS: No . Not if... if its quick. What time is it now?
PGS: Its ten to 11.
UGS Ive a lecture at 11.15.
PGS: Well, it shouldnt take more than five minutes.
UGS: Oh, thats OK, then.
PGS: Right, off we go. Ah, youre in your second year, right.
Well, the questionnaire is anonymous, so I dont need
your name, but I do need some other details.
UGS: OK.
PGS: Which faculty are you in?
UGS: Humanities.
PGS: Oh right; youre in the Hunter Building.
UGS: Thats right.
PGS: And what are you studying?
UGS: Chinese and Oriental Studies.
PGS: Chinese and Oriental Studies. Oh, right. And what age
are you?
UGS: I ve j ust turned 19.
PGS: Do you live on the campus?
UGS: Yeah. Imin one of the students flats, so I dont have
much travelling.
PGS: Ok. And which block are you in?
UGS: Benbradagh.
PGS: How do you spell that?
UGS: B E N for Nobody B again R A D A again; then G for
... grow; and H.
PGS: Ben ... bradagh. Whats that named after?
UGS: Its a mountain in Ireland.
PGS: Oh, right. You re quite a bit out. Its on the edge of the
campus next to the sports complex.
UGS: No. Thats Mount Bures House. Were on the opposite
side of the campus next to the Student Union building,
Cornwall House.
PGS: Oh, yes. I just need to ask you a few social questions, if
I may.
UGS: Mhmm.
PGS: Do you play any sport?
UGS: Yeah. Squash, basketball and football.
P GS: How often do you play squash?
UGS: Usually once a week.
PGS: So, say 3 to 5 times a month.
UGS: Yeah.
PGS: And basketball?
UGS: Usually twice a month.
PGS: Basketball , twice a month. Right. And how often do
you play football?
UGS: Id say at least twice a week.
PGS: So about 8 times a month. Do you go to the gym?
UGS: No.
PGS: Right. And do you belong to any clubs?
UGS: Ah, the Film Club and Amateur Dramatics.
PGS: The Film Club, how often do you go?
UGS: Not as often as Id like. I went loads last year, but this
year I dont seem to have much time.
PGS: But how often? Say once a fortnight?
UGS: More like once a month.
PGS: Right one to two ti mes per month. And amateur
dramatics?
UGS: Actually, at least once per week. And if were rehearsing
it could be a couple of nights and all day Saturday and
Sunday as well.
PGS: Shall we say 6 to 8 times a month then?
UGS: Mmmm, its more like 9 or 10 times.
1. Oriental Studies
2. nineteen/19
3. Benbradagh
4 . Squash
5. A
6. (The) Film Club
7. D
Questions 8- 10
PGS: And how much do you spend on sociali sing per week?
UGS: I dont know.
PGS: Say 5%, 20%, 30% of your income?
UGS: Oh, I suppose I must spend 25%.
PGS: Is that typical of your friends as well?
UGS: I think so. We stick to the university, so its cheaper...
and the sports facilities are cheap as well and the bar,
of course, is subsidised.
PGS: And books, how much do reckon you spend?
UGS: Mmm. Not more than 10%. I borrow most of the books
from the library, when I can get hold of them.
PGS: Right.
PGS: And what about accommodation and food?
UGS: Id say 50%.
PGS: And what about the rest of your money?
UGS: Well, it goes on small luxuri es ... very small. Whats
this for anyway?
PGS: Its part of a study on the change in students spending
patterns, as they progress from first year to
postgraduate level.
UGS: Oh right.
PGS: I wish you luck.
UGS: Thanks.
PGS: And thanks for your help.
PGS: No problem. Oh, look at the time I must get a move on.
See you!
A book for IELTS
159
Key to Listening Practice Tests
8. B
9. B
10. D
The listening is testing your ability to extract simple
information from a dialogue.
Hello! And welcome to this weeks edition of Science Tomorrow
Today, my name is Bertie J ackson and today we are going to
look at three totally unrelated topics.
First, is it a Hovercraft or is it a plane?
The Hoverplane, a cross between a boat and a plane with
elements of the Hovercraft and Catamaran, is under trial at the
moment. The plane-like wings allow the craft to take off in a short
distance, and a flexible skirt allows it to operate over water like
a Hovercraft, moving on a cushion of air.
The greatest potential for this craft is as a ferry, travelling
between one and two metres above the water at up to 250
kil ometres per hour. Its advantages are those of safety and
efficiency - safety as it avoids hitting floating or submerged
debris and efficiency as it can travel at five times the speed, but
at one fifth of the fuel cost of a normal ferry. And plans are
being drawn up for a large version, big enough to carry 150
passengers and freight for 2,000 kilometres at over 300
kilometres per hour. Since the Hover plane can carry a 50%
greater payload than a similar sized aircraft, but with a 30%
lower fuel consumption, and it needs neither special ports nor
runways, the craft should be an attractive economic proposition
for operators and promises to be a popular ferry in the 21st
century.
Our second item is bad news for the criminal, but should provide
a reassuringly secure communication system for the
overworked policeman. At present, a criminal with a radio
scanner can detect poli ce presence in the area that he, or
indeed she, is operating in. This is now about to change. A new
computer-based system will soon replace most radio traffic with
digital text messages. These messages will be imperceptible,
and will allow officers to cover more jobs as they pick up and
answer text messages rather than waiting for an operator to
spell out commands. Whats more, if the initial trial is successful,
the system may be upgraded so that even maps can be sent to
police cars allowing pursuits to be visually co-ordinated. Will this
spell the end of the high-speed car chase?
11. 250 kil ometres/kms
12. fi fth/5th
13. 150 passengers
14 . poli ce presence
15. digital text messages
16. maps
The answers for the first three questions in this sub-section
are easier than Questions 14-16. The vocabulary in the
part about the Police Communication System is more
difficult.
Questions 17- 20
And now for something quite different: how can chickens provide
not only that delicious breakfast egg, but also the power to cook
it? The answer lies in that plenti ful by- product of the chicken
farm, namely, chicken dung. An enterprising British company
has proved that green solutions to the electric power needs of
communities can be profitable. In fact, there are already three,
yes three dung-fired power stations in use in Britain, which have
attracted attention from other European countries and several
projects in different places are already at the advanced planning
stage. We first believed that the only use for our dung was to
make electricity, says the British companys owner, but after
burning it for power, we are left with a residue rich in potash and
phosphate, but nitrogen-free. This provides a far more
marketable fertiliser which we can sell as well as the electricity
we produce. In many countries, agri cul tural waste is even
more of a problem than industrial waste, polluting even the sea
where rivers have carried nitrogen and other agricultural waste
to estuaries and inshore waters. By burning dung and producing
cheap electric power in the process, however, this company is
solving two problems in one go.
Thats all for today.
Next week: Its Chips with everything - a new use for microchips;
robots for fixing bridges overnight; hand-held lasers for instant
blood tests and the first commercial fully-operational satellite for
tracking shifts in climate.
Ill be back next week.
Goodbye.
17. [plenti ful] by- product
18. three/3
19. agri cul tural waste
20. electric power/ electrici ty
Students find this type of question rather difficult, because
they have to read the summary and listen at the same time.
The summary paraphrases the talk and so the words that
are written down are not exactly the same as those you
hear. You need to practise this type of question as much
as you can.
P ractice Test 3 Section 3
Questions 21- 23
D = Dave; S = Sarah; T = Terry
D: Hi Sarah. That was actually quite exciting, wasnt it?
S: You really think so, Dave? Imcompletely worn out. If I
have to take in another piece of information, my heads
going to explode.
D: I t was good, though.
S: I have to admit it was, mmm,
D: And it was challenging.
S: Challenging? The last tutorial? It makes me think I
learned absolutely nothing at school. I understood
nearly all of it, but a few bits I m not sure I got at all.
Reading is reading and thats that.
D: Well, it is and it isnt, you know.
P ractice Test 3
Questions 11- 16
Section 2
160
A book for IELTS
Key to Listening Practice Tests
S: We all read in the same way.
D: No, we dont!
T: What are you two arguing about?
S: Oh, its Terry. Hi.
D: Reading!
T: Reading?
D: Yes, reading.
T: Its not exactly a sexy subject to be arguing about. Is it
Dave?
D: I dont know; I find it quite exciting, really.
S: You would!
D: Weve just been to this tutori al on study skills as part
of the English Literature course and Sarahs found it
difficult to follow.
S: No, Dave. That's not true. Its just there were some things
that Imnot so sure about or more importantly sure
whether theyre important or not.
T: Well, what was the problem?
S: Well, when I read I just read and Dr Pratt was going on
about all these different techniques that we need to
develop and hone.
21. D 22. C 23. A
Questions 24 - 30
T: Mmm. How do you read then, Sarah?
S: I just read as I said; like everyone else. I read each word as
it comes.
T: How many pages do you read in an hour?
S: About twenty-five/thirty?
T: And what about you, Dave?
D: Sixty/maybe seventy.
S. Sixty to seventy!
T: Thats not a lot.
S: How many do you read, then, Terry?
T: It depends. About 120...
S/D: What?
S: Oh, come on, Terry.
T: Yeah and I'mnot unusual. One of my friends, doing
Medieval European history, Arnold, he reads about
160 an hour.
D: But does he remember it all?
T: Yeah, I think so, Dave.
S: I get through onl y one book a week!
D: Me too. What about you, Terry?
T: At the moment 3.
S: And your friend Arnold?
T: Twenty.
S: Twenty!
T: Yes, but it doesnt matter at the moment. What matters,
is that you develop your reading speed to suit the
circumstances. You could still stick to your reading
speed of 25 pages an hour for leisure purposes, but
double your reading speed for say reading journals or
academic texts. If Imscanning a text for specific
information, I can just whizz through. Then when I find
what I want, Ill read through that particular part very
slowly.
S: Mm.
T: With forty to fifty or more books to get through in a term
you cant afford to read every word.
D: Have you always read like that?
T: No, its only since Ive been here.
S: I find this all very depressing. How did you do it then?
T: In the first week of term, in the first year, we had a tutorial
on reading.
D: FromDr Pratt.
T: Yes, and I felt so inadequate after the class.
S: Well, what did he tell you?
T: He just gave us a few basic strategies on reading and
then over the last two years hes been nurturing us, so
that we all now work very efficiently.
S: So hes your tutor too. You can tell us then what he
means when he talks about learning to read the
content words only.
T: Well, this is obviously just the first step. If you read
every a, the, to, from, was etc. it really slows you down.
S: Yeah?
T: But if you train your eye to look at the nouns, verbs,
adverbs and adjectives
S: Assuming you know what they are!
T: Well, then the big words. Then you automatically
increase your speed.
D: Yeah, that makes sense.
S: Mmmm.
S: Right. I think Imgoing off to the library to start. Thanks
for the tutorial!
T: Anytime. Imoff to the sports centre.
D: By the way, what was your reading speed per hour
when you first came here?
T: Twenty- five.
24 . 60/70 or si xty to seventy
25. 160
26. one/1
27. three/3
28. suit the circumstances
29. so inadequate
30. twenty- fi ve/25
The listening in Section 3 contains no surprises. However,
completing the table may cause some problems. You need
to practise doing this kind of question as much as you can
in other IELTS books and listening practice for foreign
language students.
P ractice Test 3 Section 4
Questions 31- 34
Good afternoon to you all again, and thanks for coming for the
second lecture in the series Drama after Graduating. For those
of you who werent here last week, my name is J ennifer
McKenzie-Davies and I amone of those lucky ones - an actress
with a job!
A book for IELTS
161
Key to Listening Practice Tests
Imgoing to talk to you today about the difficulties actors and
actresses face finding work; not that any of you need reminding!
Its a jungle out there and youve got to be very hungry to survive.
Are you hungry? Well, Imafraid youre going to have to be,
because if you arent you might as well pack your bags and
forget all about acting as a career. And not just hungry; but
also resolute in getting what you want. And, of course,
persistent. Not to menti on gifted!
Between 80 and 90 percent of you will be out of work at any
one ti me. You are joining a group of people whose average
ti me in employment is 12 weeks a year for men, and 7 weeks
for women. Why do we do it? We must be mad! And yet, there
are thousands more waiting to take our places, if we fail.
31. C
32. B
33. D
34 . C
The answers to the questions in this sub-section follow very
closely after one another. It is not the detail itself, which
makes the speech difficult to understand, but, again, the
speed of processing the information. If you are aiming for
a high grade, you should be able to cope with this.
Questions 35- 4 0
Still hungry? Good, cos this is where the interesting bit starts,
now weve got the stats out of the way.
First of all, where do you look for work? Well, theres The
Stagedoor, the weekly newspaper which occasionally has a
couple of decent jobs in it. And then theres the weekly list of
jobs called TCR, but you need to subscribe to that with friends
- its very expensive, especially if youre out of work - about
20, no sorry 25, for five weeks. Then, theres your agent.
Youll discover sooner or later that you need an agent if you want
to have access to the best work available. But how do you get
an agent?
Well, unless youre really very lucky and get taken on by an
agent who just likes the look of you, you have to get an agent
to see you in a live performance. This could be a good part in
a play which shows off your talents, or a film role, or just a
show-reel of you performing your best speeches. I must say, I
dont really know which is harder: getting the part without an
agent in the first place or getting an agent interested enough to
come and see you; in other words, a real Catch 22 situation. A
word of warning: they dont usually travel more than a few
hundred yards from their office! Theyre supposed to be working
for you, but they actually behave like its the other way round.
As for show-reels, if you want them to look at yours, you really
need to tie them to a chair and force them to watch.
You may find it difficult to get work without an agent, but itll be
well nigh impossi bl e without an Equity card. Fortunately,
things have changed. In the past, drama school students leaving
here in J uly had what was known as a Registered Graduate
Equity Card. This gave you 2 years to get an Equity contract for
work - not that easy without experience, an agent or a full Equity
Card. But, even when you got your first job paid at Equity rates,
you received only a provisional Equity Card. The Union was
quite strict about membership, but the alternative was much
harder and less likely to result in success. This provisional card
could become a full one only after 30 weeks of work. Without
it you could forget the West End theatres, top tours and work in
television.
Now, however, things are a bit easier. After you finish from here,
you automatically get your Equity card. The downside of this is
obviously that there are more people chasing the same number
of jobs.
But even before you start worrying about Equity Cards and your
agent, youve got to establish yourself with photographs:
eye- catchi ng and professional black and white photos -
small postcard size for your publicity and CVs. There will be
several sessions devoted to choosing the right photos that will
show you off the way you are most likely to be cast, and also
what to put in your CV and, more importantly with some of you,
what not to include. So you see its not an easy road to fame
and fortune.
This has just been an introduction to the trials and tribulations
of actors looking for work. Next week, well make a start on CVs.
But now its time for a ten-minute tea break, followed by a
question and answer session.
35. live performance
36. best speeches
37. well nigh impossi bl e
38. same number of j obs
39. eye- catchi ng and professional
4 0. small postcard
The testing in this part of the speech is very different from
the first section. You have to listen very carefully for the
information. The task is made easier for you, however, by
the headings in the notes in the exercise.
P racti ce Test 4 Section 1
Questions 1- 5
A = Travel agent; S = Student
A: Good morning. Can I help you?
S: Hello - yes, well, I just want some information actually.
Imtrying to work out a trip at the end of the summer
holidays
A: Yes.
S: And I wonder if you could help me? Ima student
studying Arabic and Imheading for Alexandria in
Egypt to do my language year abroad out at the
university there.
A: Right. I just need to get a few preliminary details. Ill put
everything on the computer as we go along.
S: Okay.
A: First, when do you want to leave?
S: I have to be there by 27th September, and Id like to
leave about a month beforehand so I can do some
sightseeing on the way.
A: So ... lets say you want to leave on 27thAugust.
S: !was planning to leave around the 20th.
A: the 20thof August. Okay. Thats a Sunday.
S: I ' d rather leave on the Monday. Right, the 21st then.
A: So the 21st. And did you want to fly?
S: Mmmm, I dont really want to have to fly ah straight
there; actually...
162
A book for IELTS
Key to Listening Practice Tests
A: Yes?
S: Id like to go by train and ferry to Paris.
A: What about going through the channel tunnel?
S: Well, mm, I dont like the idea of going through
tunnels. I t scares me.
A: Oh, its just like catching the London Underground!
S: I never catch the underground.
A: The ferry trains are pretty frequent, so you wont have to
worry about that part of the journey. And where to,
after Paris?
S: Vienna.
1. C
2. C
3. A
4 . B
5. A
Questions 6- 10
A: From P aris to Vienna, by plane or train?
S: Train. I d like to travel overnight, so I d like a sleeper,
if possible.
A: Right, a sleeper to Vienna from Paris. Right: theres an
early morning train to Vienna, the 7.50, but that wont
work because you want an over-night train. But then,
theres one at 17.49.
S: Right.
A: and youre lucky, because they leave from the Gare de
IEst, which is right next to the Gare du Nord station,
where the ferry train comes in.
S: Brilliant.
A: So, that gets in to Vienna at 8.35 the next morning. You
see that bit of the journey alone costs, er, let me see ...
141.80.
S: Is that with the student discount?
A: Yes. And then?
S: Id like to spend some time in Vienna; about a week
perhaps, before going on to Athens.
A: Train again?
S: Well, no. I was thinking of going by plane via
Budapest and stoppi ng off there for a coupl e of
days.
A: You do realise that its going to cost you a lot more going
part of the way by plane and part by train. It would work
out a lot cheaper if you did it all by train or flew direct.
S: How much are we talking about?
A: Probably about at least 250 more.
S: As much as that.
A: Well, yes. Youll probably have to get a scheduled
fl ight from Budapest to Athens and thats going to
cost a lot more than by train.
S: Well, lets see when we add all up at the end.
A: And the last leg of the trip from Athens?
S: I want to go from P iraeus by ferry.
A: I see. Okay. Now Imalmost certain theres a ferry
service to Alexandria from Piraeus, but Ill have to
check ... Mmmm. The computers not giving me
anything.
S: Can I think this over? Immaybe making it more
complicated than it really is.
A: Oh, oh, by the way, have checked the visa requirements
for each country?
S: Oh, I hadnt thought of that.
A: Right. Can I take a few personal details?
S: Okay.
A: Your name?
S: Its J ames Weston thats W - e - s - 1- o - n.
A: Right. Fine! OK, then. And a daytime telephone number?
S: Its 0181 889 4269.
A: I have logged all these details on the computer. Ill just
give you the reference. Its I AMI FUR2.
S: IAMIFUR2.
A: You just quote this reference when you come in again or
telephone. Then it will speed things up a bit.
S: Okay thanks.
6. H
7. B
8. F
9. C
10. I AMI FUR2
Be careful with questions 6 - 9 .
If you find it difficult listen several times.
P ractice Test 4 Section 2
Questions 11- 16
Welcome and indeed welcome every Friday afternoon at 2.15
to Post-bag, your chance as listeners to let us know what you
think about our programmes and current issues.
This week our Post-bag has been virtually overflowing - not that
we are complaining, mind you! Many of you, in fact, a staggering
4,373 of you to be precise, have completed Radio Souths
listener phone-in survey. Some general points: 83% of you think
that the radio station has improved over the past year; and only
7% that it has got worse. Most of you think that the radio station
provides an excellent service! Thats a big thumbs up for Radio
South. Some more statistics: a rather disappointing 64% of you
did not like the start of the new international radio soap that
began on Wednesday evenings last month. Many of you said
that it was too vulgar and puerile, with no plot, no excitement!
And only 17% said they liked it.
We passed on your messages to the producer and he said that
he had received a number of letters and countless phone calls,
saying how innovative and modern the plot was. In fact, those
figures for those listening had more than doubled for the second
programme! Well have to wait and see how this one develops!
And for 87% of you, the new starting time of 5 am for the
Wake-up show went down really well! Only a small disapproval
rating for this one; in fact, only 3%. Many of you said the earlier
time is a real hit!
Unfortunately, The Wine Show has not gone down well at all.
It had a 15% approval rating and 25% who did not like it and
60% dont knows! Sadly, the main comment was that the
programme is downright boring. Maybe, wines going out of
fashion.
The full survey will be published next month and it is free on
request!
And now to our weekly letters slot.
A book for IELTS
163
Key to Listening Practice Tests
11. 83/ eighty- three
12. 7/ seven
13. 3 / three
14 . a real hit
15. Wine Show
16. downri ght boring
Questions 17- 20
Sharon from Tasmania has written in to say that she has tried
to get through on the telephone to our new Message Line to
leave a message on the Voicebox, but she finds it too
complicated. She says, and I quote: Every time I press a number
after the main menu the line wont accept my message. It is so
frustrating. Maybe your Voicebox should come with a health
warning! Well, I can tell you that youre not the first person to
have complained about this; in fact, we had 67 letters this past
week alone and complai nts have been goi ng up at the rate
of 10% a week recentl y. And were now looking into the
problem.
On a more cheerful note, Mary from Sydney, Australia, wrote in
to say how refreshing and cheerful she found our station. She
says the music and the morning Wake-up show she finds really
invigorating. Weve had lots of similar letters from all around
South- east Asia saying the same thing: from Terry in Auckland,
New Zealand, Yuko in J apan and Ahmed in Indonesia. Robyn
in Australia says its really an excellent new contribution to the
radio scene in the area and encourages us to keep going. Thank
you Robyn for your support.
Pangaporn from Thailand wants to know if there are any plans
to repeat the English language programme, English Worldwide,
on Sunday mornings at 9 am or whether we are going to expand
the programme. Weve had so many letters over the past week
about English Worldwide-, it appears to be hugely popular. Since
it started 5 weeks ago, the number of people tuning in has
grown tenfold. There are no plans at the moment to increase
the 2-hour slot on Friday morning, but if numbers keep
increasing at the rate they are we may have to.
Many of you have asked when we are becoming a 24-hour
service. The answer is as soon as we can. We now broadcast
19 hours a day and hope to be on air 24 hours a day within the
next six months.
And now its over to Marco, whos going to look at the latest
cinema and video releases
17. D 18. C 19. A 20. B
P ractice Test 4 Section 3
Questions 21- 25
Dr: = Dr Goldfi nch; F = Faril la: L: = Lorraine: S = Stevie.
Dr: This is our third and last group tutorial of the term. Have
you been finding them of any use?
F: Oh yes. I get a lot out of them.
S: Me too.
Dr: And What about you Lorraine?
L: Yes, I thi nk so
Dr: Okay. Right. Anything for this week? Lorraine? No?
Okay. Farilla?
F: Wel l ,... you know I have two teenage daughters and
I m a single parent.
Dr: Yes?
F: Well, mm, Imfinding it less and less easy to study as a
mature student and have a teenage family. The girl s
have been playing me up.
Dr: And what exactly do you mean by that?
F: Kimberly, the eldest, has a boyfriend and shes taken to
staying out later and later. And shes becoming difficult
to control. And the younger one, whos fourteen,
misses Kimberly, because they were always together.
Dr: Mhmm and
F: and I feel as if I m letting them down by doing this
course. They dont have a father and all theyve got is
me. I just dont know what to do.
Dr: It is a difficult situation this one.
S: My mum did the same thing, went back to studying when
I was 16 and I think at the time I got really jealous ...
L: Of what?
S: the course!
L: the course?
S: Well, it wasnt just the course. It was the other people and
the fact that my mums time was taken up by other
things and people. At the time I did not like it at all!
F: Thats the problem here, I think.
Dr: And what happened, Stevie?
S: Well, I started playing up to attract attention and ... doing
some pretty stupid things, in fact really stupid things.
L: Like what? Oh, go on, tell us!
S: No! Anyway, my mum sat my brother and me down and
told us how important the course was for her and us
and why she hadnt been able to do it before.
F: And?
S: Well, she said that, even though it had cost her a lot of
money and she was having to work part-time to keep
everything going, she was prepared to give it up.
L: And did she?
S: Of course not, Lorraine! We felt pretty stupid. After that we
helped out more and both of us got a job, a small
job, so that she di dnt have to give us any pocket
money.
Dr: Ah, well , Faril la, maybe you should try the same
approach.
F: I think I might just give it a try. Thanks Stevie.
Youre a star.
Dr: And what about you, then Stevie?
21. B 22. A 23. D 24 . C 25. D
Questions 26- 30
S: Ive got a rather more mundane problem, well, maybe, not
that mundane.
Dr: Mhm.
S: I had to type a paper for a semi nar for this Friday and I
had everything almost ready and ..
L: and
S: My laptop crashed ...
164
A book for IELTS
Key to Listening Practice Tests
Dr: Havent you got a copy on disk?
S: No, I ...
L: Youre crazy. This isnt the first time its happened to you;
havent you learnt by now?
S: I know, I know, but that doesnt help me at the moment,
does it?
L: You just dont listen, do you?
F: Leave himalone, Lorraine. Youre not exactly helping, are
you?
L: I ...
Dr: I think Farilla is right. Theres no point in crying over spilt
milk.
F: Have you a rough copy?
S: Yes, but
F: You can type it in again,
S: Imvery slow and Imnot going to get it done in time.
I also have to get OHPs together as well. They were on
the computer and it was just as I was printing them out
that the machine went. I also have to hand a typed up
summary in 2000 words, bound as well, to Dr
J ohnson the day before. And on top of that I have to
hand in the full paper at the end of the seminar. As it
goes towards my final grade and a credit is taken off
for handing papers in late, I have to do it. And its
Tuesday now, so I havent really got much time. I
nearly didnt come today.
F: Dont worry, Stevie, Ill help you do it, if you want; we
can start straight after the tutorial.
S: Will you, Farilla?!?
F: Yes,
L: You should let himdo it himself!
Dr: Now Lorraine,
F: He helped me, so I dont see why I shouldnt help him. You
could lend a hand too, you know. You dont know when
you might need help.
L: I ... I ...
S: Its okay, Farilla. We can do it together.
Dr: Well, two people sorted. Now what about you Lorraine?
26. (seminar) paper
27. crashed
28. rough copy
29. (2000 word) summary
30. a credit
P ractice Test 4 Section 4
Questions 31- 37
And how did it all start? Many times I have been asked how
someone becomes a journalist; and how I myself became a
music critic. There is no set path. After doing an MA in music, I
worked in a London bookshop for a couple of months, then as
a sub- editor for an educati onal publ icati on. After I left that,
like many of my colleagues, I wrote freel ance features for
various newspapers and magazines in the music world. My
counterparts on other newspapers made their entry to music
criticism by totally different routes. Some took courses in
journalism; some wrote features which they then sent round
newspapers and journals until they were published; while others
took some less orthodox steps. After a couple of years
freelancing, rather than moving into the editorial field in
journalism, I was given the rare opportunity to become a music
critic on a national newspaper, on a retainer. For those of you
who dont know what it is, a retainer is a fixed yearly sumpaid
for a certain number of, in my case, concert reviews. Cheap
labour with the prestige thrown in by way of compensation!
To many, the work of a music critic is glamorous, and, in some
respects, I have to admit, it is. I have the rare chance to meet
interesting people, but like any other profession it has its
downside. The concert-going public do not seem to be able to
take on board the fact that when I amreviewing a concert, I am
working. At concerts, people have the habit of descending on
me like vultures to talk music; would they appreciate it if I
pounced upon them at work to enthuse about accountancy,
obscure legal matters? I think not! And also it can be a very
lonely profession; working on your own for days, weeks
sometimes, without human contact except by telephone or
computer. Another drawback is having to write reviews to
deadl ines on a daily basis. And despite what many people
believe, the salary is not that good uniess you occupy one of
the prestigious posts on a national paper.
Yet, it is not all negative! The travel, I must say, I do enjoy
tremendously. On the street near my flat, I was once stopped
and asked to help complete a survey. Washing machine,
madam? No. Microwave? No. Television? J ust. And how many
times do you go abroad per year, madam? About once every
ten days! I never tire of seeing new places, or indeed of revisiting
old friends. The States I visit about three times a year on
average; other countries in Europe about ten to 12 times a
year. With about six of these being the Scandinavian countries.
The rest of the trips tend to be one-off special journeys to
exciting places like Greenland, J apan, Nova Scotia, Iceland, the
Pacific Islands, etc.
31.1 32. C 33. G 34 . C
35. E 36. H 37. C
Questions 38- 4 0
And what is the role of the music critic today? Listening has
always been a talent: now it is a rare and fragile one. The
journalist Michael Ignatieff has recently presented us in the
United Kingdom with a provocative television series on the
three- minute culture. Three minutes, he says, is just about as
long as the average person can concentrate. There is such a
wash of music around us which threatens to become a tidal
wave. Audiences coming out of Londons Festival Hall and
setting out for the journey home, put on their Sony Walkmans
with their overcoats; avid festival-goers, likely to be hearing
three or four recitals a day, pack their cassette tapes and CDs
in their luggage in order not to have to endure silence in their
hotel rooms.
The critics job is to foster the talent of discriminati ng listening
against all odds. People have a real inferiority complex when it
comes to trusting their own ears. Friends and acquaintances
often expect me to tell them what they should think after a
concert. But if I dont, then someone else surely will. A critics
responses or pointers can, at least, perhaps act as disinterested
touchstones amongst the babble of hype and market forces.
38. 3/three-minute culture/ average persons concentration
39. discriminating listening
40. touchstone
Note how the level of difficulty as regards the content of the
speech increases in this section. Again, remember that you
do not have to understand everything to complete the
tasks.
A book for IELTS
165
Reading Exercises
Key to Exercises I - 2 1
A book for IELTS
167
Key to Reading Exercises
Exerci se 1
1. A Sentence 2 contains the function of the building
described.
B Sentence 4 describes the physical structure.
C Sentence 3 contains information on the location
of the building.
D Information on the history of the building is in
Sentence 1.
2. The reason is that each phrase relates to the information
in one sentence only. Each phrase summarises only one
sentence, nof the whole paragraph.
3. The writer wrote the paragraph: to describe the Mussenden
temple. The answer A gives you the purpose for writing
the paragraph. B only gives you the writers purpose for
writing the last sentence. The text contains no inform
ation about whether Frederick Hervey was mad or not.
The writer only states that Hervey was enigmatic.
Therefore, C is not possible as an answer. As for D, it
only describes the writers purpose in writing the second
sentence. It is clear that only A states why the writer
wrote the whole paragraph, rather than just the parts of it.
4. building/folly/library/temple/structure
The word library is probably the main one. Read the
organisation of the second sentence.
5. The synonyms are used to develop the text and reflect
different qualities throughout the paragraph. The writer
uses the different synonyms to bind the text together and
to express the different qualities of the building in each
sentence: folly, an act of madness; temple as tribute to
Mrs Mussenden; and then the main focus, library.
6. It is descriptive. Note that the paragraph is a list of
information:
The building was completed in 1785
The building was erected by Frederick Hervey
Frederick Hervey was enigmatic
Frederick Hervey was Earl of Bristol
Frederick Hervey was Bishop of Derry
and so on. There is no argument, nor opinion in the
paragraph. Learning to recognise the different types of
paragraphs and texts is another important aspect of
learning to read the meaning and organisation of a text.
See Reading Exercises 5 and 10- 13.
7. The most appropriate title is C: The Mussenden Temple.
The title reflects the purpose of the author in writing the
paragraph. (See 3 above) and is a summary of all the
information in the paragraph. The other titles refer only to
parts of the text and cannot, therefore, act as summaries
of the whole paragraph.
In the IELTS exam, exercises where you have to give a
title or heading to a paragraph are quite common. It is a
type of exercise which many candidates find rather
difficult. You can see the title here is the sum of the four
sentences i.e. the function of the building, the physical
structure of the library, the location of the building and the
history of the building.
8. The first sentence gives background information against
which the writer describes the function of the building in
the second.
9. The function of the third sentence is to describe the
geographical location. Into this setting fits the physical
appearance in the fourth sentence.
10. Between the second and third sentences. See the
answers to 8 and 9 above.
11. The first two sentences give non-physical information
about the building (i.e. its background history and
function). The last two sentences give physical
information about the buildings (i.e. its location and
appearance). Notice how you can bring the first two
sentences into one unit and the latter two again into one
unit. You can then add these two together to give you the
title of the passage.
12. The information has been put in a different order. The
most important information in the original text is: The
li brary was bui lt in honour of Mrs Mussenden The
other information given by the writer is subsidiary to this
main point. The information contained in the phrases:...,
completed in 1785,... by the enigmati c Frederick
Hervey, Earl of Bristol and Bishop of Der r y,..., the
Earl s cousin is extra. Note the commas around the
phrase, completed in 1785, and the comma and fuil stop
around ..., the Earl s cousin, to mark off this information
from the main text. You can understand the first sentence
in this explanation without difficulty, but you cannot
understand the additional information on its own. It adds
to the text, but by the organisation in the sentence the
writer shows that it is additional, not central.
You need, therefore, to understand the hierarchy of
information within a sentence and within a text. You need
to recognise what information in a text is important and
what is really just additional or background information.
See Readi ng Exercises 12 and 13.
In the sentence in the exercise, the information was
reorganised with the main information being: was
completed in 1785.
Exerci se 2
a Answer: False. The paragraph talks about drivers and the
opinion they have of themselves, not their opinion of
other matters or people. The text then goes on to talk
about the results of this arrogance. Candidates often
read too quickly and do not look carefully enough at the
exact meaning of the important words in a text. So be
careful!
b Answer: False. The second sentence gives you the focus
of the paragraph: the general effect of drivers having a
high opinion of themselves.
c Answer: False. The paragraph contains two examples
which illustrate drivers high opinion of themselves. The
last sentence is a comparison of a similar situation
outside motoring.
d Answer: True. The second sentence states a general
consequence of the first sentence. In this way, it leads
the reader from the general statement in the first
sentence to the specific examples in sentences 3 to 5
and helps the text to move smoothly from general
statement to focus, to example. It is in this sense a
transition sentence. See e below.
e Answer: True. You could remove the second sentence
and put For example, at the beginning of sentence 3.
The paragraph, however, reads much better with the
sentence than without it, as it helps to direct the reader
through the text.
f Answer: False. As we have seen the organisation of the
paragraph is:
General Result example + example + analogous
statement example
You can look at the text in another way. Sentence 2 is a
general effect of the problem which is mentioned in the
168
A book for IELTS
Key to Reading Exercises
first sentence. Sentences 3, and 4 are specific examples
of effects:
problem/ general specific + specific + analogous
cause effect effect effect example
You can see that the examples are examples of the
effects of the problem/ cause in the first sentence. The
paragraph is, therefore, basically one of cause and effect.
Note that the sentences in the paragraph could be linked
together with the word and. You could put the information
into a list:
Drivers often have an over-inflated opinion of their own
driving abilities and think that most other people on the
road fall well below their own high standards and some
take it upon themselves to show their fellow road users
how to drive and car drivers commonly...
You can see that it would be very difficult to extract
information from large chunks of text like this. Hence, the
need for sentences.
It is in effect, therefore, a list or and paragraph. Look back
at the text in Exercise 1and you will see that it is also a
list paragraph.
g Answer: False. The text does not need any more text
markers. The meaning of the sentences is obvious. Part
of the problem that students have when they read a text,
is the fact that there are no text-markers. You can write a
paragraph as here without obvious or overt markers.
Read the text again and:
i) insert the word then in the second sentence after Some.
ii) insert the phrase For example, at the beginning of the
third sentence.
iii) insert the phrase Moreover, at the beginning of the
fourth sentence.
iv) insert the phrase Similarly (i.e. a similar situation/ For
example,) at the beginning of the fifth sentence.
The organisation of the text is then more obvious: then =
effect; example = example of effect. The academic texts
that you need to be able to read for the IELTS will in
many cases not have these obvious or overt markers. So
you need to learn to read and summarise each sentence
instantly. This comes with practice.
h Answer: True. The paragraph, in fact, answers the
question: What is the effect of drivers high opinion of
themselves? The writer then wrote the paragraph to
answer this question!
i Answer: True. It is important to look at the direction of the
text up to and away from the focus or topic sentence,
when you want to work out the overall meaning of the
paragraph. Remember the meaning of the paragraph is
the sum of the meaning of the sentences ... and
something else. That something else is the direction of
the paragraph as in (f) and (h) above. The statement
made in the focus sentence is supported by examples of
the consequences of drivers opinion of themselves;
hence, the title.
a Answer: False. The first sentence is an example of how
people relieve their frustrations.
b Answer: False. The purpose of the paragraph is to show
the best way to deal with frustrating situations: the last
sentence. In the first three sentences, the writer gives
examples of how people relieve their frustrations. If the
statement in the exercise referred to these three
sentences only, it would be True. The writer does not
think that this is the best way to deal with pent-up anger:
the first three sentences are examples of what not to do.
Against this background, the writer then gives his opinion
about how to deal with the situation. Recognising the
purpose or reason why a paragraph has been written is
important for working out the organisation and then the
title of a piece of text.
Answer: True. The paragraph is one of subjective
argument/opinion. The writer has set out to show that the
way that people normally get rid of their frustrations is
wrong and against this background he proposes his own
solution. Note that the first three sentences are, in fact, a
concession i.e. Although we tend to take out our pent-up
emotions on other people by (Sentences 1-3), I believe a
better way.... The writer puts what other people do first.
Then, against this background he puts his own opinion.
The first three sentences contain specific examples of
how people get rid of their frustration. The fourth acts as
a summary of the previous examples giving specific
examples to support a generalisation. Note that you
could put the fourth sentence at the beginning. Then you
would be arguing from the general to the specific
The type of organisation in this paragraph is quite common
in written texts. For more on paragraph types see
Reading Exerci ses 4 - 11.
d Answer: True. The text reads from particular (specific) to
general.
e Answer: True. It states what the writer thinks against the
previous background. The word But shows that the writer
is making a contrasting statement about the previous
examples of how people deal with frustration. The word
surel y shows that he is making a fairly strong statement.
f Answer: False. Note the difference between the paragraph
in this exercise and the previous two texts. The first three
sentences could be connected by and. Between the first
three sentences and the fourth sentence the connection
is also and. Between the fourth and fifth sentences the
connection is but. This is, therefore, a but paragraph.
Note also that it is impossible to work out the organisation
of the paragraph and the title by reading the first and last
sentences.
g Answer: False. Only two of the titles are suitable. Title (i)
covers only the background information (specific
examples) in the first three sentences and the general
statement in the fourth. It does not take into account the
fifth sentence. Title (ii), The best way to relieve
frustrati on, is also unacceptable. The purpose of the
paragraph was to show that the best way to deal with
frustration is to control it, not relieve it. Title (iii) reflects
the purpose and direction of the paragraph (see a to e).
Note the difference between this title and the previous
one: the title reflects the purpose and focus of the
paragraph and, thus, it appears to be focusing on one
piece of information only. Yet, it is a good title. Title (iv) is
suitable, because the word deal covers both relieving
and controlling.
Exercise 4
1. Answer: (i) G, (ii) L, (iii) A, (iv) K, (v) H, (vi) M , (vii) E
The writer gives examples to explain the focus in the first
sentence. The focus here is not so clear, perhaps, as the
following:
Let us look at the different types of thinker. Some thinkers
content t o ...
The phrase different types of thinker is much clearer, but
do not expect the focus sentence of a paragraph, if there
is one, to be so obvious, or overt.
Exercise 3
A book for IELTS
169
Key to Reading Exercises
2. Answer: A. See 3 below.
3. This is an example paragraph. Note the examples are part
of an explanation.
4 . Answer: No. It is a but paragraph. First, the writer lists
examples, which could all be joined by and (Sentences
(ii), (iii) and (iv)). The information in this list then forms the
background for the more important information, which
comes in the text after the word however. In Sentence
(vi), the writer gives another example and a warning,
Then, in the last sentence, he develops the information in
Sentence (vi) to make a conclusion and to give you the
title.
Reading is very much like writing: in both, you need to
know in which direction you are going. For reading, you
have to follow the signs the writer gives you to extract the
full meaning. In writing, the burden is upon you to give
the signs so that the reader can follow you; and so that
you can follow yourself!
We said above that the text in the exercise is an example
paragraph. It is also a paragraph that argues from
particular to general. Sentences (ii) - (v) give specific
information from which the writer draws a general
conclusion.
5. It is similar to the text in Readi ng Exercise 2, but notice
the difference! The Examples in 2 are also effects. The
paragraph here is also similar to the text in Reading
Exercise 3 where the writer lists specific examples and
arranges them inside a concession (see 3c).
6. The answer is No. See Readi ng Exercise 2 g.
7. From the last two sentences. The title comes from the
reason why the writer wrote the paragraph: to show
which thinkers are the dangerous ones.
Exerci se 5
P aragraph 1
The following are false:
b The paragraph is not descriptive. Look at the text in the first
exercise in this section.
c This is not the reason why the author wrote the passage.
The statement refers only to the first three sentences.
Statement a) gives you the answer.
d The sentence The repercussions are grave is the
transition sentence in the paragraph. It links the situation
described in the first three sentences with the
consequences or repercussions in the last sentence.
h The focus is in the fourth sentence.
j The first two are good summaries of the text, as they
reflect the writers purpose in writing the paragraph. The
last title covers only the information in the first three
sentences.
The following are true:
a The first three sentences act as a background for the
more important information in the last two sentences. The
text is directed towards the conclusion that too much
information affects peoples ability to work. Note how the
last two sentences depend on the first three. Note also
the dramatic effect of the fourth sentence. The shortness
of the sentence brings you up short and makes you
notice it.
e All of the information in the passage can be connected by
and.
f Compare the organisation of this paragraph with the
previous exercises. In Exercise 1, the text is a
description, where the writer has woven a list of
information into a text. The paragraph in Exercise 2 is
one of cause and effect. In Exercise 3, the text is
organised around the principle of concession/contrast
with opinion. Exercise 4 also contains a list of
information. As you read, you should look out for different
types of paragraphs. Then gradually you can recognise
them easily.
g The first three sentences describe the situation and the last
sentence describes the implications/repercussions/
consequences. The fourth sentence acts as a marker
between the problem and the consequences in the last
sentence. The sentence summarises the repercussions
before they are mentioned; it predicts the text which is
coming.
i See the answer for (a) above.
P aragraph 2
a It is an explanation paragraph. The writer explains how
failure and success are linked to each other.
b It is a but paragraph. Notice how the word I nstead marks
and divides the text.
c The focus of the paragraph is in the first sentence.
d The paragraph is similar in organisation to the text in
Exercise 3, but not the same. The information in
Exercise 3 is arranged around a concession/contrast,
here there is just a contrast.
e The last sentence.
f Answer: (iii). When you are trying to work out the title for a
paragraph the first thing you should do is ask yourself:
why did the writer write the paragraph? You can see that
(i) is not suitable because the paragraph shows you how
failure and success are linked. As you have seen, the
focus of the paragraph is in the first sentence and the
rest of the paragraph explains the focus. The last
sentence in the paragraph acts as a conclusion. Note
that in this case, you can work out the title from reading
the first and last sentence. Compare this with the other
paragraphs you have read so far. The other two titles are
purely distracters.
g Answer : (iv). Thi s is the onl y alternati ve which answers
the questi on in f) above.
Title (i) is almost correct, but it talks only about failure and
not about its connection with success. Titles (ii) and (iii)
are obviously wrong.
Exerci se 6
You can see that each sentence has different layers of
meaning.
1. Answer: C. Sentence 1 gives the topic of the paragraph
and helps you organise your reading. It does this by
asking a question, which then obviously has to be
answered.
2. Answer: J. The second sentence answers the question in
the first sentence describing the situation as it is now. It
thus provides some background information, however
brief. The sentence contrasts the fact that writing and
numeracy are taught badly, but thinking is not taught at
all. Note how the sentence expresses all of the meanings
at the same time.
3. Answer: E. This sentence gives more general background
information and states a problem as regards education in
general, not just thinking. It gives more detail about the
170
A book for IELTS
Key to Reading Exercises
information in the second sentence and explains why the
art of thinking is not taught. Note, in particular, that the
sentence states a problem.
The sentence can have other meanings, which are not
mentioned here. It could also be stating a reason, i.e.
why thinking is not taught.
4 . Answer: A. This sentence is similar to the previous one.
The writer is expanding further and explains why thinking
is not taught. Note that this sentence is also stating a
reason again and making a criticism.
5. Answer: B. The writer is now moving back to the central
theme of the paragraph: teaching thinking. The sentence
is again a criticism and, therefore, an opinion. This
sentence is a particularly good example of meaning
operating at different levels.
Note how sentences 3 and 4 give background information
to the main focus of the paragraph.
6. Answer: H. This sentence has many different functions.
The writer is making a proposal in the form of a wish. He
is making a criticism and a complaint, and he is also
being sarcastic. He also believes that his proposal would
solve the problem.
You can see, from this sentence and from 5 above, what
the implications are if you are not able to read meaning.
Look at the following sentence:
To the author, it is regrettable that thinking skills are not
being taught.
The sentence paraphrases part of the information in
sentence 6. Where is the word regrettable? So think
about the meaning of a text!
7. Answer: F. The sentence contains the result or develop
ment of the proposal in the previous sentence! Note that
the result is simultaneously hypothetical and certain, that
is, providing the proposal is taken up.
8. Answer: D. The statement concludes the paragraph.
Note that this is a problem/solution type of paragraph.
Look at the following summary of the text:
Focus/present situation/present situation-general
problem/reformulation o f problem/
specific problem/ solution/proposal/
result/conclusion
Exerci se 7
The functions listed below are not suitable.
1. stating a disadvantage; stating the focus of the
paragraph
2. stating an advantage; stating the main argument for;
making a criticism
3. stating an argument for; making a proposal
4 . stating a disadvantage; stating a reservation
5. stating a subjective argument against; giving an opinion;
stating a reservation
6. summarising the disadvantages
7. stating an argument for; stating an opinion; stating a
tentative result based on a condition
The functions which remain after you remove those in the
Key above act as summaries of the sentences they relate
to. The sumof the functions gives you the meaning of the
paragraph.
The last sentence tells you why the author wrote the
paragraph: to support the use of trolley buses and trams.
Look at the title: A case for trolley buses and trams. It is
easy to make the mistake of reading the first sentence of
the paragraph and thinking that the writer is presenting
arguments against the introduction of trolley buses and
trams. The writer agrees that the arguments against are
strong (Sentence 6) and uses this as background
information to present a statement about the strength of
the argument for.
The organisation of this paragraph may at first sight appear
to be unpredictable and is of a type that can confuse
readers. The writer presents the opposite view to his
own, only to knock it down. If you look carefully enough
you will see he goes from negative to positive, then vice
versa. This is quite a common type of organisation.
You can see that the functions are basically the same as
other paragraphs you looked at.
You may now have begun to realise that sentences have a
limited number of functions, but that each sentence can
have different functions. A writer can also put the
functions in a different order. The repetition of the same
words within a passage is considered bad English. The
repetition of exactly the same structure in every
paragraph is also bad. So you can see why a writer
needs to vary the organisation, even if only slightly.
Sometimes, the organisation is varied by keeping the
same structure between paragraphs, but giving the
sentences in a paragraph extra functions (see Reading
Exercises 4 - 6). Note the multi-purpose aspect of
Sentence 7 above!
If you bear this in mind as you read, you will learn not to
treat each reading passage as something new. You can
approach it with an understanding of structure, and with
this skill you can bring every passage under your control.
Exerci se 8
P assage 1
Sentence 1 is the focus sentence. It is an organising
sentence.
Sentence 2 is describing a suggestion. Note that it is not
making a suggestion.
Sentence 3 is a result, a development, a hypothetical
implication. Note that this sentence functions as a
concession or an although clause.
Sentence 4 is stating a probability, a real implication and a
contrast.
Sentence 5 expresses a reason, a result and a hypothetical
implication. It is also stating a probability.
Sentence 6 expresses a reservation.
Sentence 7 is an objective conclusion.
P assage 2
Sentence 1 is the focus sentence. It is an organising
sentence.
Sentence 2 is making a suggestion; note the writer says
should initiate. Note that the sentence is making, not
describing, a suggestion.
Sentence 3 is stating a fact. It is also a result and a
development. It expresses a reservation. Note that this
sentence functions as a concession or an although
clause.
Sentence 4 is a result, a real implication and a contrast.
A book for IELTS
171
Key to Reading Exercises
Sentence 5 expresses a reason, a result and a real
implication. Note that it is not stating a probability: will
certainly, but a certainty.
Sentence 6 expresses a reservation.
Sentence 7 is a subjective conclusion. It is, therefore,
expressing an opinion
Note how similar, and yet how different, the paragraphs are. The
first paragraph describes a proposal and gives the implications.
It is objective. The paragraph is basically one of recom
mendation and result/implication.
The second paragraph is different in that it makes a proposal;
it does not just describe it, and gives the implications. It is also
subjective. The paragraph is basically one of recommendation
and result/implication. However, the implications are real this
time, and the writer is stating an opinion.
Note Sentence 3 in the second paragraph. It is expressing a
reservation. This is not possible in Paragraph 1!
Exerci se 9
(i) Clonings bright future
1. C, 2. B, 3. A, 4. B, 5. C, 6. A, 7. C, 8. A
(ii) The unacceptable face of cloning
1. B, 2. A, 3. B, 4. C, 5. A, 6. B, 7. B, 8. C
(iii) The dangers of cloning
1. A, 2. C, 3. C, 4. A, 5, B, 6. C, 7. A, 8. B
You should repeat this exercise many times. Try to find and read
the paragraph for each title and, as you do so, block out the
ideas from the other titles. The three paragraphs add up to a
short article on cloning. As you have seen in this exercise and
the previous one, the similarity of the subject matter in a text
can cause problems. If you are aware of this, you can tackle the
problem.
Note: You should be able to read the paragraphs by
predicting the function of the next sentence. Try title (ii)
and think of reasons why cloning is unacceptable.
You will then see how easily the other two alternatives
do not fit in!
Exerci se 10
You can see that the paragraph contains a list of examples to
show how life is moving at a faster pace or rate. Sentences 5,
6, 8, 9 and 10 give examples. Note, however, the fact that there
are no specific words to state that they are examples. Sentence
7 is a result of Sentence 6. The last two sentences are the
conclusion of the paragraph.
Sentence 8 is a general example; the next two sentences give
you more specific information.
Microwaves, computers, trains and planes are quite common
examples.
Exerci se 11
The paragraph is very similar in content to Exercise 7, but you
can see that it goes in a totally different direction. If you read the
title and then read a few of the phrases in the first sentence, you
have an idea of what is coming: rather out-moded forms of
transport; mistakenly. As you go through the text, you can see
that the writer is using negative language to convince you of his
view here:
Trolley buses and trams, rather out-moded forms of
transport, are mistakenly being hailed as the answer to
the ills afflicting modem transport systems. A vast
swathe of South London from Tooting on the Northern
Line to Croydon is being churned up to build a new tram
system. Motorists obviously dont like it, because the
roads are in the process of being ripped up in preparation
for the tramlines being laid. When the trams are finally
up and running, most people will be against the idea,
because the system will lead to more one-way systems,
thus hindering their freedom of movement and most
certainly increasing the congestion that it was designed
to get rid of. Then, when the problems start arising,
they will have to start dismantling the whole network
again at great inconvenience to the motoring public!
Much of the detail is the same, but by changing a few elements
the direction and purpose of the text changes dramatically.
If you did not predict the content exactly, it does not matter. The
main thing is that you got part of the answer and understood the
technique. Leave the exercise for a while and try it again and
see what happens.
The sequence of functions is:
a criticism; background information/
an example; a result/ consequence; a result/
consequence; a result/ a criticism/ a conclusion.
Exerci se 12
1. Answer: E. Look at the following plan of the organisation
of the meaning of the paragraph. Compare the list in
Passage 1in Exercise 10. When you are able to
recognise paragraph types it helps you to read with
organisation and hence more efficiently.
Segregation at secondary level
Probl ems
Problem 1: difficulty functioning
socially as adults
Problem 2: misconceptions
re sex
Problem 3: difficulty with the
opposite sex
Expansion S ' /
girls/romantic nero /
boys/alluring goddess
General subj ect
Focus
A book for IELTS
Key to Reading Exercises
You can see from the scheme above that the paragraph is
not a description of segregation of boys and girls at
secondary level. The paragraph is basically a list or and
paragraph, which contains examples of problems. The
author wrote the paragraph to show that segregation at
this level causes a number of problems.
The problems are also consequences, implications or the
negative effects of segregation. So you can see here
again that there are different levels of meanings when
sentences are placed together in a text. Compare the
texts in the previous reading exercises in this section.
This, obviously, is of great importance, if the IELTS exam
is based on testing meaning.
The only heading which summarises all the information we
have here adequately is E. Note that the distracters H
and L relate only to part of the text i.e. P roblem 2.
2. Answer: K
General subject
Argument against
Explanation
Focus
Supporti ng argument
Segregation at secondary level
Unnatural to some
Segregation not a realistic
environment
Segregated schools better
Girls held back by immature
boys
You can see from the above list that the writer starts with
the opposite opinion to her own (see the paragraph in
Reading Exerci se 7). So it is easy to misread the
direction of the paragraph. However, the word mistakenly
should give you a clue to the direction in which the text is
going: This is the viewpoint of other people; mine is the
opposite and I am going to show it to you.
Note that the information is basically the same as that in
the previous paragraph. However, because the writer has
decided to use it in a different way, the end result is
different. The writer could have put the focus at the
beginning and could have arranged the information in a
different way. However, remember what we said in the
Key to Reading Exerci se 7 about the need to avoid
repetition of the structure of paragraphs.
Is this an and paragraph? The answer is no; it is a
basically a but paragraph. In the first two sentences, the
writer presents an argument which opposes her own.
She then knocks this argument down by presenting her
own opinion, which is the opposite. This relationship in
the text is like that between the general information you
have in an introduction with a general statement and
focus. The first two sentences provide the background for
the focus of the paragraph: the writers opinion.
Some may be tempted to put F as the answer, but
nowhere does it mention that the paragraph is the main
argument, and the writer is for segregation.
Answer: L
As you are reading, always ask yourself why the author
wrote the paragraph. The author wrote it to show that
segregation at this level is unnatural. The main aspect he
deals with is misconceptions about sex:
Level 1 Segregation at secondary level
Level 2 Not exactly natural
Level 3 Misconceptions re sex
Level 4
Girls/romantic hero
Level 5
Boys/alluring goddess
The opposite in co-ed schools
You can see from the scheme above the text is dealing
with only one aspect of segregation. Compare this with
the list of problems in the first paragraph. You can see
that one of the problems from the first paragraph has
been turned into a separate paragraph.
4 . Answer: C.
Now let us look at the paragraph in another way.
Change causes probl ems, not least because it upsets
peopl es routine and makes them feel uneasy. A good
example is the introduction of technology in the
workplace. The Luddite in all of us comes out as we are
faced with adapting to the onslaught of technological
change at work. In the early 19th century, the Luddites
revolted against the introduction of what was new
technology in their time by breaking machinery which
replaced workers. The pace of change today is much
faster, and thereby more unsettling. Thousands of
workers in factories have been replaced by computers
and robots; now voice recognition programmes threaten
to replace secretaries; computerised switchboards
receptionists and computer video packages instructors
and teachers. What area of life is safe from the
advance of machines?
You can see that there is a thread which runs through the
text. Sometimes, it is difficult in another language to see
that thread, because there is a lot of background
information which fills in the detail. The text in bold above
is the foreground information in the paragraph, which
gives you the meaning of the paragraph and hence the
title.
If you are able to read a text and just use the foreground
information as stepping stones, you can read much faster
and more efficiently. Obviously, the more competent you
are at doing this in the IELTS exam the higher your grade
will be in reading.
Note that A is not a suitable title, because it is only a
summary of part of the paragraph (the historical exam
ple). The same applies to I, which is only a summary of
the modern day example of the text. Title D is unaccept
able, because the paragraph is talking about the
unsettling effect of the introduction of new technology.
Title D summarises only part of the text. Note also that
title D applies only to the Historical example, and the
Modern example applies both to factory and office
workers. So it does not cover the meaning of the whole
paragraph.
5. Answer: B. Note again how the diagram below shows you
the thread of meaning of the theme of the paragraph.
Technological change
BelieHUtestroys jobs/ unfounded
Historical Example Modern Day Example
Luddites Computers
No reason to fear technology
As you can see, title B summarises the paragraph. As in
paragraph 4 above, A and D are not suitable titles,
because they are summaries only of parts of the
paragraph. The same again applies to I, which is a
summary only of the modern day example in the text.
Note again how the same background information can be
used to support different foreground information.
A book for IELTS
173
Key to Reading Exercises
Exerci se 13
1. Heading: Hooked on change
The theme is developed by the following:
Change
Yet, there are people who seem to thrive on
change, enjoying the constant flow of challenges.
a situation in which a certain type of person
flourishes.
change is like a drug.
They become addicted
Now go back to the paragraph and read it, looking for the
words and phrases above. You may want to underline
the text with a pencil or put a box around them. Can you
see that the rest of the text provides background
information for the foreground information above? This is
a slightly different way of looking at paragraph headings
from the previous exercise.
2. Heading: Welcome to new technology
The theme is developed by the following:
But the belief that it destroys peoples jobs and
lives is totally unfounded.
It is now clear, however, that, far from destroying
work, many more jobs have been created in
factories
Witness the development of silicon valleys
throughout the world.
The advances in the fi eld of technol ogy
should, therefore, be embraced with open
arms rather than feared.
Now go back to the paragraph and read it, looking for the
words and phrases above. You can see how the thread
of information is very different from the previous
paragraph. Nearly all of the first half of the paragraph is
devoted to providing background information to the
foreground information above. The writer uses the
background information as a setting for the point he
wishes to make in the paragraph. He then draws a
conclusion in the last sentence (in bold above). For more
details as to the difference between the foreground and
background information, look at the previous exercise.
3. Heading: The North/South driving divide
The theme is developed by the following:
standards of driving seem to deteriorate markedly
as you travel down the country.
A much more calm and relaxed manner of driving
is noticeable to those visitors to Northern cities
in areas like the South-east and London
down the M1 from the North,
the nearer you approach London.
In the two to three hours drive South, the journey
changes from a pleasant drive to a mad
aggressive rush as the traffic hurtles towards
London.
Is this yet another example of the differences
between the North and South?
This paragraph has a very obvious thread running through
it right from the beginning. Note here the conclusion in
the last sentence, which is drawn from the total of the
information in the first part of the text. Note how the
summary or purpose of the paragraph provides the
heading. Compare this with the rest of the texts in the
exercise.
4 . Heading: P eace at the wheel
Now, it is hoped that you can see the thread through the
paragraph which gives the heading easily:
how much more relaxing
A calm and relaxed manner of driving
There does not seem to be the same mad rush
and lack of respect for other road users
and feel the traffic gradually slow down,
The tension at the wheel subsides; a car journey
changes into a very pleasant drive at a
respectable pace.
Now go back to the paragraph and read it, looking for the
words and phrases above.
5. Heading: The stupidity of ageism
Look at the theme as it runs through the text below.
Age discrimination is rife among the business
community. The folly inherent in this process is
nothing less than a criminal act. It does not seem to
have dawned on employers that the workplace is
changing. The number of people dealing with
knowledge compared with manual workers is
increasing. In the near future, we may find
companies clamouring over each other to attract
old people as the demographic make-up of the
working population changes. Some companies
already have a policy of employing older people in
their stores and they have seen a marked turn
around in sales. Could this possibly have
something to do with a thing called experience?
You can see from the text above how the foreground
information stands out against the background detail. The
background detail sets off the main or foreground
information. It is not advisable to mark your book with a
highlighter pen, but you could make a photocopy of the
texts in this exercise and mark the foreground information
in pencil. This will show you how the information stands
out, if you know where to look for it.
Being able to recognise the thread of meaning in a text and
to distinguish between background and foreground
information is crucial to reading fast and efficiently.
6. Heading: The need for legislati on to protect older
people
Look at the theme as it runs through the text below.
Age is commonly used as a criterion to prevent
people from entering a job and, indeed, to rid an
establishment of excess personnel. Young people are
seen as being fitter physically and mentally, and as
costing less. The experience of older people is
overlooked. A dose of ageism is needed here, but
ageism where there is discrimination in favour of
old people. Some companies already have a policy
of employing older people in their stores and have
seen a marked turn around in sales. So, perhaps
there is a case for legislating in favour of old
people in the workplace.
174
A book for IELTS
Key to Reading Exercises
The foreground information to give you the paragraph
heading stands out again.
You should repeat Reading Exerci ses 1- 13 as often as
you can in order to absorb the mechanisms they contain.
The information that is contained in them is of much less
importance than the skills they aim to teach. And never
be afraid of using the Key to help you at all times. When
you feel comfortable with the exercises, then repeat them
without using the Key.
1. The highlighted words are nouns, verbs, adverbs and
adjectives. In other words, all the content words are kept
and all the small words are left out. As in speech, the big
words carry the stress in the sentence. They act as the
stepping stones through the text and allow you to skim
the surface of the text.
2. The gaps between the stepping stones are larger, so you
have to run through the text more quickly! You can
increase your reading speed by first reading the text as in
number 1above and then, as you become more
confident, you can decrease the number of words you
read as in number 2.
You can see that in number 2 you effectively have a
summary of the text.
3. The minimum number of words you need in order to have
a summary of the texts are given below.
(a) Participation in the Euro, the new European
currency, hinged on whether the criteria set out in
the Maastricht Treaty were adhered to strictly.
Several countries would like to have seen some of
the qualifying conditions relaxed, but that did not
happen, as the banks were against any slackening
of monetary control. What remains to be seen is
whether the governments concerned can stick to the
stringent monetary goals they have set themselves.
(b) The swingeing cuts introduced by the govern
ment have created quite a fracas, but many people
believe that they are necessary for the future health
of the country. The main target areas appear to be
spending on welfare, defence and the road network.
(c) One member of the public, a Gladys C Roach,
who took part in the survey, stated that she felt it
was dangerous to shop in the department store as it
was so full of tempting food. She added that she
always had to make sure that she went there to shop
only on a full stomach. Otherwise, she would spend
a fortune.
Read the texts above several times. As you do so, look
at the words in bold, but also see the other words. When
you are doing a listening exercise, you can hear all the
words, but you do not usually listen to all of them. Try to
develop this skill with reading.
4. The answers are as follows:
a. cause implication/ result/ consequence
b. statement clarification/ expansion/ explanation
c. cause effect/ implication/ consequence
d. concession contrast
e. action/cause implication/ result/ consequence
This is an even more economical way of reading. You are
here reading the meaning of chunks of texts. This is
exactly what you have already been doing in Reading
Exercises 1- 13. A good way of developing this technique
is now to go back and read the earlier exercises in the
section. As you read, summarise the texts, as in the
exercise you have just read. You will then be able to read
the organisation, meaning and words much more
efficiently.
5. The answers are as follows:
a. Problem firm solution/proposal
b. Problem tentative solution/proposal
c. Problem consequence
d. Statement Reformulation/explanation
Notice how the information is similar, yet the meaning
relationship is different. It shows you how important it is
to be able to read meaning and recognise the information
in a text.
6. The words are in bold below.
This shows, say many teachers, that standards of
English for many secondary school pupils and
university students have declined over recent years.
The answer is, obviously, that the teaching of
grammar should be made compulsory in secondary
school and on relevant teacher training courses.
Note how the words in bold summarise the text. More
importantly note how much you do not need to read to
extract the information.
You can practise these techniques with any text. You could
spend ten to fifteen minutes a day reading newspaper
articles. Underline the stepping stones in one article, or in
another underline only the main words as here. Then go
through the same texts and as you read give each
sentence a name which shows its relationship with the
sentences around it. Over a period of time you will be
able to train your eye to do all three at the same time.
This is obviously a very efficient way of reading.
a the launch of the anti-smoking campaign will fail
miserably.
b (in males) the amount of deep sleep declines with age, thu
leading to a reduction in the bodys rejuvenation process,
c Scumbling, is a simple, but subtle technique.
2.a
New New
A car was driving slowly along a road.
Old New
It turned into the drive of a large white
house.
Old New
The car stopped just short of the front door,
Old New
but the driver did not get out.
A book for IELTS
175
Key to Reading Exercises
New New
Her first acting break was doing a voice-over
in a major film in a spy film.
Old New
This led to a string of similar jobs
doing work on adverts.
New New
Mr Maguire made a number of predictions for the
future of further education in the UK.
Old New
His forecasts are seriously flawed.
Old New
They are much too optimistic to be credible.
New New
A woman with
a manic grin
entered a building.
Old New
The building collapsed. When the dust settled,
Old New
she walked into another building.
New New
Her grin was now even more hideous.
New New
The government
version of events
s was not believed by anyone.
Old New
It was seen by most people
as a cover-up.
Old New
The whole affair serves to illustrate the fears
people have of politicians
inclination to abuse power.
3. Answer: Statistics show that the threat of violence drives
young people away from home.
Block 1: According to the statistics available on
homelessness,
Block 2: what drives young people away from home is
Block 3: the threat of violence from those within the
household.
Note how the answer makes the information in the three
blocks above more accessible.
4 . (a) Answer: Mavis.
(b) Answer: Brother and sister.
5. Answer: The rules were laid down by Mrs Cartlebury.
Notice how easy it is to extract the information from the
text. A good way to train yourself is to filter the
information and discard what is not useful for your
answer. Here all the other names but Cartlebury are
irrelevant. Reading is also about learning about how not
to look at every piece of information as equal.
Exerci se 16
1. comfortably.
2. connecting/connection.
3. modernise the company.
4. the rubbish pit.
5. soon run into trouble
6. foolproof
7. the Italian Renaissance.
8. rise in crime
9. most pressing aspects.
10. sides of an argument.
The words in the original texts have not been given so you
will not be tempted to concentrate on them!
Exerci se 17
1. Sentences a and b do not mean the same. The first
sentence only says that the man bit into the dogs ear. It
does not say he bit it off. Notice also ear/ears!
2. A common confusion among students. Sentence a means
that J oseph was smoking and he stopped. Sentence b
means that J oseph was doing something and he stopped
in order to smoke. Note that the infinitive is connected
with the future (I want to go home; I would like to help
you) and the -ing form here with past experience. The
sentences do not have the same meaning.
3. The sentences do not have the same meaning.
4 . The sentences do not have the same meaning. The word
should indicates that the sentence is a suggestion,
proposal etc; in Sentence b the phrase It is necessary
does not convey the same meaning.
5. This is an interesting one. The sentences have the same
meaning and paraphrase each other. However, the
phrase A variety of has two meanings, namely: (i) various
and (ii) a group/type of. If, in a text, the phrase A variety
of in Sentence b had only meaning (ii), there is a strong
possibility that it might not paraphrase sentence a!
Meaning and words are not the same!
6. The sentences have the same meaning.
7. Although Sentence b is a paraphrase of Sentence a,
Sentence a does not paraphrase Sentence b\ Note that
there are two pieces of information in Sentence a going
to rain and soon. Sentence b only focuses on the first
piece of information; not both! This is identical to the first
example in the exercise. Remember, in the reading tests,
to read primarily from the sentence in the exercise to the
text. Remember that the sentence in the exercise may
be testing a discrete point in a text, not a large chunk. In
this pair of sentences, you can see clearly how narrow
this point can be.
8. This pair of sentences is rather interesting, as it illustrates
clearly the problem candidates have with IELTS. Sent
ence a has the same meaning generally as Sentence b.
Sentence a summarises Sentence b and is a good
example of a paraphrase as a summary. However,
Sentence b does not summarise Sentence a. This
obviously confuses students, because they expect the
meaning to be exact in both directions!
176
A book for IELTS
Remember some sentences in the test exercises may have
exactly the same meaning as the information in the text,
as in 6 above.
9. The sentences do not have the same meaning as each
other. A final contract and What was approved in the end
do not mean the same thing.
10. Note the difference between the sentences:
secondary/primary. So the meaning is not the same.
11. They are the same. Note how different the words are!
12. The sentences have the same meaning and they also
paraphrase each other. This one is difficult. The first
sentence means that, roughly speaking, there is, say, a
5% chance that the accused did not commit the murder
and, say, a 95% chance that he did. The second
sentence means that there is, say, a 95% chance that he
did commit the murder and, say, a 5% chance that he
didnt.
13. The sentences dont have the same meaning. The phrase,
Everyone is aware is the opposite of the phrase, It is not
widely appreciated. Moreover, the phrase got better does
not tell you the extent of the improvement. So you cannot
say whether it is significant or not.
14. The two sentences have the same meaning and also
paraphrase each other. Note, however, that Sentence b
can mean either that he may be more than 65 years of
age or less than 65 years old.
15. The two sentences have the same meaning and para
phrase each other. Note the word priceless. Students
often confuse the meaning of words like this, e.g. value
less, limitless, powerless and so on. Check their meaning
in a dictionary.
Note: You can see the difficulty that meaning can
cause. Basically, an exercise sentence may have the
same meaning as a sentence in a reading passage.
However, the sentences in the test exercises may also
paraphrase or summarise discrete points of information
in the text. In this instance, the summary does not need
to contain all of the information as in some of the
examples above. So, remember that your analysis does
not work both ways. This causes a lot of confusion for
students, because a paraphrase is often explained as
just a word or phrase with the same meaning.
A paraphrase has basically two main forms:
it is a phrase, sentence or expression with the
same meaning, which you can use to replace
another phrase etc.
a summary of the meaning of a piece of text.
A summary states a larger text in a shorter form.
In both cases, the substitute sentence etc. in the exercise
uses different words, expressions, or the same words in
another way, but carries the same meaning as particular
points of information in the original text.
Exerci se 18
Eight of the sentences have matching texts with the same
meaning.
1. Answer: m. Note that j is not suitable because it talks
about the future Project not the future of the Project. Also
the time scale is different.
2. Answer: f. It was the speed of the change that surprised
the government, not the reversal of their fortunes. So c is
not correct. At a first glance, many students think that 2
Key to Reading Exercises
and c have the same meaning, because superficially they
deal with the same idea. Note that sentence 2 can refer
to either good or bad fortune, but c to only bad fortune. In
the exam, you need to be careful about jumping to
conclusions too quickly.
3. Answer: g. Note e is not correct, because it says that it is
completely unknown. Sentence 3, however, says that it is
not completely obvious. Note that I is also not correct. It
has the opposite idea of Sentence 4 : compare
previous/second.
5. Answer: n. Note the distracter d.
8. Answer: o. The distracter h is the opposite of Sentence 8.
9. Answer: k. Compare 12, which, at first glance, has the
same meaning as both. Sentence 12, however,
expresses an opinion about what happened: it criticises
the government (should have acted). The other two
sentences describe the fact that the government was
criticised!
10. Answer: b. Note the distracter p.
14 . Answer: a.
Exerci se 19
1. j small (healthy)
p big loss (healthy profit)
[not h: publishing does not turn the statement into a
contradiction.]
2. I crawled slowly by (sped past).
[not i: slightly covered, because this has the same meaning
flecked.]
3. t old (new).
[not m: hampered and hindered mean the same thing.]
4 . g depl orable (commendable).
5. a dupli city (honesty)
c atypical (typical)
6. e (not sanguine enough) too optimistic
r pessimisti c (optimistic).
7. o true (apocryphal).
8. f As he lay dying (In the very middle of his life)
9. There are no contradictions for this sentence.
Exerci se 20
1. Answer: J. Because Sentence G is a question many
students may be tempted to put it as an answer.
However, this question does not have the same meaning
as the original text. The question in the text indicates that
there is a difference: What... ? The question in G asks
whether there is a difference.
2. Answer: L. Notice how Sentence A talks about
information not knowledge.
3. Answer: P . The distracter here is Sentence M.
4 . Answer: H. Sentence D is obviously wrong.
5. Answer: I. Sentence K covers the information in
Sentences 5 and 6.
6. Answer: C. Sentence K covers the information in
Sentences 5 and 6
A book for IELTS
177
Key to Reading Exercises
7. Answer: N.
8. Answer: E.
9. Answer: Q. The distracter here is sentence F. It is wrong,
because limited is the opposite of endless.
Note that B is not a sentence and cannot replace
sentence 1. It is a title for the whole passage! Note also
that O is not suitable as a paraphrase of any of the
sentences as it summarises Sentences 1- 5.
Exerci se 21
1. a Not Gi ven. To find something rewarding means to find
something satisfying. So the statement does not give any
information about how much money lecturers are paid.
b No. Notice the original sentence says Many not
All lecturers.
c Not Gi ven. The sentence does not tell you whether
the majority of lecturers get satisfaction from their work.
It does not say what proportion of the total Many
represents.
2. a Not Given. The sentence states that computers are
expensive (despite the cost), but does not say whether
they are becoming more expensive, becoming cheaper
or whether the cost is static.
b Yes. See despite their cost.
c No. If computers are gaining in popularity, then they
must have been less popular in the past than they are
now.
3. a Not Given. The sentence on'y tells you that the
number is increasing, but does not tell you what
proportion of the total this represents.
b Yes. People are becoming more affluent.
c Not Given. The sentence does not mention anything
about the cost of cars.
4 . a Yes. Schools have been getting better.
b No. The sentence contradicts the original text,
c Not Given. This sentence means that educational
standards were unsatisfactory before and now they have
improved. The sentence also implies that they were
unsatisfactory before and are still unsatisfactory. The
original sentence does not tell you about the
satisfactory/unsatisfactory state of the educational
standards before.
5. a Yes. Unemployment does affect the male/female roles
and hence the way families operate.
b Not Given. The original sentence says nothing about
the relationship between family members where the
woman has a job, and men and women usually having
traditional roles.
c No. Unemployment does affect the role of a man in the
family.
6. a Not Given. There is no mention of the governments
desire either way.
b No. If the hazards are well publicised it means that
they are well known. If you had the word widely rather
than well in the original, you would not know if the
publicity had been successful or not.
Note that if the original sentence had said publicised well,
you would not know whether the publicity had reached
many people. You would only know that the publicity
material was good, or that it had been well handled.
c Yes.
7. a Yes.
b Not Gi ven,
c Not Given.
8. a Not Given. There is no mention of people writing to
politicians about animals becoming extinct. Note address
here means to tackle/deal with.
b Yes.
c No. It is only recently that they have been looking at
the problem; they have definitely not been fighting
against it.
9. a Not Given. Most people would be amazed, (if they
realised ...) clearly means that people are not amazed.
Also the text does not mention gardeners; nor does it tell
you whether they are amazed or surprised.
b Not Given. You can perhaps guess that it is impos
sible to count the different types of insect life in a garden,
but the text does not tell you that this is the case!
c Yes. This one is obvious.
10. a Not Given. We do not know from the text whether all
houses were heated in the past. All we can say is that an
unspecified number were not heated adequately.
b Not Given. The text does not say whether our lives are
better now compared with the past.
c Yes. Two things today are better than they used to
be: to name but two.
Exerci se 22
1. a Yes. Notice how the sentence summarises the
information in the last two sentences.
b Not Given. The text doesnt mention anything about
this at all.
c Not Given. The text does not quantify the number of
people.
2. a Not Given. The text, does not tell you anything about
part-time students.
b Not Given. The author thinks that financial support from
parents is a possibility for some students, not all
students. However, note the text does not say whether
the parental financial support is easily available. The
information in the statement is therefore not given.
c Yes. See the first two sentences.
3. a Not Given. The text says that the young and fit throw
themselves with enthusiasm into .... However, it does not
say whether the activities mentioned should be attempted
only by young people. In other words it does not tell you
what the author thinks.
b Yes. ...the physical challenges many such activities
involve.
c No. Look at the opening sentence.
4 . a Not Given. There is no mention of high-rise flats in
the text.
b Not Given. There is no mention of the information in this
statement in the text.
c Not Given. The text does not tell you how people
died.
5. a Yes. See the end of the text.
b No. The text says: that all students encounter throughout
their academic career.
c No. The text says many theories.
178
A book for IELTS
A book for IELTS
179
Key to Reading Tests
Test 1 P assage 1
QUESTI ONS 1- 6
1. Answer: distinct races. It is better to have both words, but it would also be possible to have the word races
on its own.
2. Answer: albas. The clue is in the example, Alba x semiplena, For Questions 2,3 & 4, you need to be care
ful. The temptation is to put the names of the roses in the order that they occur in the second paragraph, i.e.
gallicas, albas and damasks. Doing that would not test whether you can find your way round the text! In fact,
you need to use the other information given at 5 and 6 to help you work out the names in Questions 2-4.
3. Answer: damasks. The clue lies in the phrase Origin obscure.
4. Answer: gallicas. The marker here is 13th Century.
5. Answer: (highly) scented petals. You can have two words here and leave out the words in the brackets.
6. Answer: recorded.
This exercise is a summary of the second paragraph. It is basically checking whether you understand the organisation
of the paragraph, i.e. it is a classification paragraph with information about different types of roses. The technique you
need to use here is one of basic skimming and scanning. As you are reading the paragraph, you should scan or look out
for organisational features: the writer organises the paragraph around the phrases: diversity and antiquity and three
distinct races:
Before examining the cultural advantages of shrub roses, mention should be made of their
diversity and antiquity. There are three distinct races of rose, which can be traced
back to the Middle Ages, the gallicas, the albas, and the damasks. Gallica roses were
first recorded in the 13th century, and probably the most famous of all, Gallica officinalis,
is among the flowers depicted on the famous Ghent Altarpiece, painted by the Flemish artist
Jan Van Eyck in the 14th century. Another gallica, Rosa mundi, with its characteristic red
and white petals has been cultivated for at least six centuries. Albas too have a long history.
Alba semiplena is the worlds oldest working5rose and is still grown in the Kazanluk region
of Bulgaria for its highly scented petals, which are harvested each June to make the
perfume, attar of roses. Damasks, as the name implies, were thought to have come from
Damascus. Their origin is more obscure, but they are certainly related to wild roses still
growing in parts of the Middle East and Iran. There are in cultivation more recently
introduced varieties of roses too, such as Bourbons, hybrid musks, and hybrid perpetuals
as well as rugosas, which originate in the Far East.
You can see how the words in bold type help you to read. The writer wanted to present the information in a way that
makes the detail easily accessible. The phrase diversity and antiquity is the first stage of the process of organisation;
the phrase is the focus of the paragraph, not cultural advantages. The phrase three distinct races then gives the writer
a peg on which to hang the next layer of details: gallicas, albas and damasks. At the next stage, under each of the
three headings, he organises detail about the antiquity and diversity of each type of rose. The words in bold, therefore,
summarise the paragraph for you. So, if you are able to train yourself to read the organisation of a text, you can scan
more efficiently and learn to look from the top down onto the organisation of the text rather than from the bottom up. Most
people, and not just students, are so caught up in the detail, that they read a text as if they were drowning. So, to prevent
a text from drowning you, learn to skim the surface information and dip into the detail when you need to. This applies to
all reading and is a strategy you should train yourself to develop.
Another strategy to help you read this text is to learn to read the organisation of the question. If you look at the diagram
for Questions 16, you can see that the structure of question number 1 gives you a clue to the organisation of the
exercise: There are..., namely: The question is asking you to classify the central information in the paragraph, or reduce
it to a list. It is checking whether you understand the organisation or skeleton of this type of text.
Note that the second paragraph is a digression from the main focus of the text: cultural advantages as mentioned in
paragraph 1. See also the first sentence of paragraph 2 and again the first sentence of paragraph 3.
Note how the organising words: diversity and antiquity, three distinct races, gallicas, albas and damasks do not
stand out in the second paragraph. They are hidden by the detail until you are able to recognise their importance as
organising words within the paragraph. Once you highlight them, the organisation jumps out at you, as above. Now go
back to the original passage in the exercise and skim the surface of the text to see if you can pick out the organising
words. You may have to do it several times to feel comfortable with it. Then try it on other parts of this text and other
passages. (See also Reading Exercises 10-12.)
180
A book for IELTS
Key to Reading Tests
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you are able to skim a text to recognise the organisation.
- whether you are able to skim a text to recognise a specific type of organisation i.e. classification.
- whether you can analyse a text from the top down without being dragged down by detail which
is irrelevant to the question.
- whether you can summarise a text.
QUESTI ONS 7- 13
7. Answer: benefit. You need a noun here; beneficial (adjective) does not work. The word advantage does
not work here either. The word advantage appears in the original text, but you cannot use it. If the text read
...and soils, features which are an advantage to..., it would be acceptable.
8. Answer: area available. You need to be careful here. The answer is a paraphrase of the word space in the
original text. Spacing is to do with the arranging of the layout of the plants.
9. Answer: Most. This is a translation of the majority of in the passage, but the word majority alone does not
fit here. If you use the word majority, the text should read: The majority of.
10. Answer: blossom. The word is a paraphrase of the word flower in the text. A difficult one. If you read the
sentence, you can see that a verb is needed here for the text to make sense. This sentence is a paraphrase
of the first part of the second sentence in the fourth paragraph. The word spread fits grammatically in the
sentence itself, but the sentence is not then a paraphrase of the original text: the passage does not say that
the roses spread. The word spread in the passage refers to the extent, diameter, circumference of the rose
bush, as it grows.
11. Answer: in the end. This phrase paraphrases the word eventually in the original text. The word also does
not work here. The sentence does not give additional information (also). The sentence states a fact (In fact)
about what happens when shrub roses are not cut back regularly. It is, therefore, also a development of the
phrase without having to be cut back. Compare the original text.
12. Answer: across. The phrase up to three metres across paraphrases with a spread of two to three
metres. The word circumference would not work here as you would need to say in circumference. The
same would apply to the word diameter, if it were in the list.
13. Answer: dictates. This sentence summarises the penultimate paragraph.
Note that this exercise tests your understanding of a section of text. It checks whether you are able to understand a
paraphrase of the text and again tests if you can dip into the organisation for detail. The exercise is basically organised
around the cultural advantages first mentioned in the first paragraph.
Note that in the exam you may have a summary, as in 7- 13, where there is no Wordlist. Then you will have to take the
words from the text. See P ractice Test 2, Reading P assage 2 and P ractice Test 3, Reading P assage 1.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you can summarise a text.
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase of words and ideas.
QUESTI ONS 14 and 15
14 . Answer: B. If you look at the penultimate paragraph, you can see that the writer is talking about shrub
roses. It is not clear whether the phrase of all in probably the most intensely fragrant rose of all refers to
shrub roses or all roses. The writer of the article didnt know when he was asked!
15. Answer: D. The first reaction for many students is to give A as the answer. The sentence then would mean
that all shrub roses have a short but spectacular flowering season. The word many in the text shows you
that there are other flowering seasons. Like A, alternatives B and C, each only covers one group of shrub
roses.
A book for IELTS
181
Key to Reading Tests
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase of words and ideas.
- whether you are able to understand specific points in the text.
Summary of questi ons
Notice that you had two summarising sections and a section looking at specific points. Why? The
reason is because the texts lend themselves to this type of question. Therefore, as you read the other
passages in this book, and elsewhere, you can try to predict what type of questions would test the way
the passage is written. Of course, the questions in this reading passage could be replaced by others,
but they might not have been able to test your understanding of the text quite so well. Could you
replace Questions 1- 6 with Yes, No, Not Given questions?
Test 1 P assage 2
QUESTI ONS 16 and 17
16. Answer: 80. The answer is at the end of the fourth paragraph. You simply need to scan the text for the
words Lex Report and also for a percentage.
17. Answer: 90. The answer is at the beginning of the fifth paragraph. Again like number 16, you simply need to
scan the text for the words RAC Survey and also for a percentage.
These two questions are particularly easy as you just have to scan the text for references to particular items. The questions
do not ask you to analyse any particular part of the text.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan for specific information.
QUESTI ONS 18- 23
18. Answer: Yes. The answer to this question is in the seventh paragraph:
The 1991 Road Traffic Act takes a very dim view indeed of dangerous and careless driving and, as with
assaults, provides stiff custodial sentences for those guilty of such crimes. To date, however, there is no such
offence in the statute books known as Road Rage. There can be assaults or criminal damage followed or
preceded by dangerous driving, but no offence that incorporates both - a change in the law which the public
are crying out for in the face of increasing anarchy on the roads.
The statement in the exercise is basically a paraphrase of the text in italics. When you are scanning, you need to look
out for references to Road Rage and information about whether it breaks the law, violates the law, or is a violation of the
law. To do the first is not easy, because the phrase Road Rage occurs many times in the passage. To scan for the latter
is even more difficult, because you are searching for an idea that appears in another form. It is like seeing a person whom
you do not know very well out of context or wearing different clothes. It is sometimes difficult to recognise them.
Scanning a text for ideas in the form of a paraphrase rather than specific words or phrases requires an advanced level
of vocabulary and flexibility in English. If you are aware of the need to develop this skill, it will help you in doing not just
this type of exercise, but many of the other exercises you have to deal with in the IELTS exam.
19. Answer: Yes. The answer to this question is in the second paragraph:
A psychologist, employed by the Royal Automobile Club (RAC) defines Road Rage, thus: unchecked
behaviour designed to cause harm to another road user; behaviour which is not normally in the behavioural
repertoire of the person. Road Rage is an altering of an individuals personality whilst driving caused by
a process of dehumanisation. This dehumanisation is caused by road use frustrations and an artificial
sense of insulation, protection and empowerment provided by the car. This leads the person to behave in a
way designed to cause harm or endanger other road users.
Note that again you have to scan the text to find information relating to the psychologist and then the idea of cars making
drivers feel artificially safe.
182
A book for IELTS
Key to Reading Tests
Note that the statement in the exercise does not check whether the text mentions the idea of empowerment. It is checking
only the discreet point about an artificial sense of insulation, protection. Some students may want to put No as the
answer here, because the statement in the exercise does not cover the idea of empowerment. The statement is,
however, a paraphrase of only part of the statement in the text.
20. Answer: Not Given. The writer mentions that he is a motorcycle instructor, (The end of paragraph 3), but
nowhere in the passage does he say that he thinks motorcycling is exciting or safe.
21. Answer: Not Given. The answer is in the fourth paragraph:
The report states that a survey carried out by Lex confirms that up to 80% of motorists have been the victims
of road rage and that driver confrontation is on the increase.
The statement in the exercise is almost a paraphrase of the text. The words is rising mean the same as is on the
increase. This statement is different from the Not Given in number 20 above. In number 20, there was no reference as
to whether motorcycling is exciting or safe.
Here the text mentions driver confrontation (conflicts between drivers); is on the increase (the incidence...is rising).
The sentence in the exercise, however, qualifies the increase by saying it is rising rapidly. The text itself does not give
you any information about the quality, e.g. rate/size, of the increase. It is important to note here that the exercise asks
you to decide if there is any information about the statement in the original text. You, therefore, have to look at the
statement as a whole.
Students often ask how they can change a statement to make the answer Yes or No. To make the statement in the
exercise into No you would have to make the statement contradict or disagree with the original text. You could do this
by finding an opposite word for one of the words in the sentence. The most obvious one is rise. If you remove the word
rapidly from the sentence and change rising to diminishing or decreasing, then the answer would be No:
The Lex Report states that the incidence of conflicts between drivers is decreasing.
To make the answer Yes, then all you have to do is remove the word rapidly from the exercise sentence:
The Lex Report states that the incidence of conflicts between drivers is rising.
You would also have a No answer if you had a word in the original text which contradicted rapidly, e.g. slowly.
22 Answer: Not Given. See the first sentence of paragraph 5. The writer mentions that the RAC has much to
say about it (Road Rage), i.e. it talks about the quantity of the survey, but the writer does not talk about the
quality i.e. whether the survey is thorough, or otherwise.
23. Answer: No. The answer is at the end of the first paragraph:
To many people the term Road Rage describes a relatively modem concept of drivers getting worked up
due to some incident whilst on the road and resorting to physical violence or damage to property. Most
people would say that this has only really become a problem in the last five years or so. It has certainly
become of great media interest in recent times, but it has, in fact, been part of motoring for quite some time
now.
The latter part of the text in bold states what the writer thinks, while the first sentence states what many people think,
not the writer.
Note that the questions are not in the sequence that the information appears in the text. Do not always expect the
questions to be in order.
For help with this type of question, see Reading Exercises 18- 22.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan for specific information.
- whether you can recognise an idea which is expressed in another way.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase.
- whether you are able to analyse a small part of a text and not allow the information around it to
interfere with your analysis.
- whether you are able to juggle several pieces of information at the same time.
QUESTI ONS 24 - 27
24 . Answer: uphill struggle. You need to scan the text for the word professionals. See the fourth paragraph
from the end.
A book for IELTS
183
Key to Reading Tests
25. Answer: Stiffer penalties/Stiffer sentencing. The first answer is in the third paragraph from the end. The
sentence is a simple paraphrase and again you scan the text for the word courts. For Stiffer sentencing
see the last sentence of the text.
26. Answer: male preserve. The answer is in paragraph 9. The sentence is a paraphrase of the words in bold
below:
Most of us probably imagine violence on the road to be an entirely male preserve, as men are naturally more
competitive and aggressive, especially when it comes to driving.
It is a little bit more difficult to scan the text for the information here, as it is an idea that you are looking for rather than a
specific marker like a word or phrase as in 24 or 25.
27. Answer: interest and reporting. The answer is in paragraph 8. To find the answer, you scan the text for the
words Association of Chief P olice Officers. The phrase causing unnecessary anxiety does not fit in
here, because to fit the phrase into the blank space you would have to make the word media into a noun
and put an article in front of it: the media. In the exercise sentence, media is an adjective and is the clue to
the answer. The text says:
There have been suggestions from the Association that media interest and reporting are, in fact, creating
the problem by causing unnecessary anxiety in the minds of the motoring public in a direct analogy with fear
of crime.
The sentence in the exercise is a paraphrase of the text in italics. The phrase causing unnecessary anxiety tells you
how the problem is created, whereas media interest and reporting tells you what the Association think are responsible
for creating driver confrontation.
Note that as in the previous section the questions are not in the order that the information appears in the text.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan for specific information.
- whether you can recognise information or an idea which is expressed in another way.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase.
- whether you are able to analyse a small part of a text and not allow the information around it to
interfere with your analysis.
QUESTI ONS 28 and 29
28. Answer: C. The answer to this question is in paragraph 9. The alternative is a paraphrase of the text:
Women can be more aggressive in cars than they ever would be when theyre walking along the street.
Alternative A is not correct, because the text does not say that cars make all women stronger. It says:
It makes some women feel stronger than they really are.
As for B, can contains the idea of sometimes, not frequently. Answer D is wrong, because the opposite is
possibly true:
...you could even argue that smaller or weaker people, who might be victims when they are out of their cars,
often feel they can even things up a bit when they are behind the wheel.
Remember the text is talking about women here.
29. Answer: B. The answer is in the last paragraph. The inclination for many students is to give D as the answer.
This is a value judgement, as it implies that you have a standard against which to measure the writers
statement in the last paragraph. If you choose too pessimistic, you are judging the statement against your
own opinion. The question asks you to summarise the writers view; you are not expected to give your own
opinion unless you are asked to do so.
C is wrong because the text does not indicate whether the author is depressed about the situation or not.
A is obviously wrong.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan for specific information.
- whether you can recognise information or an idea which is expressed in another way.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase.
- whether you are able to analyse a small part of a text and not allow the information around it to
interfere with your analysis.
184
A book for IELTS
Key to Reading Tests
QUESTI ONS 30- 33
30. Answer: x. The answer to this question is in paragraph D. The marker in the text to look for is the effigy of
Queen Elizabeth 1. There are two distracters here. Number vi is not correct, because the text says the
effigy was dismissed (considered) as a poor copy (replica), not that it was a poor copy. Distracter ii is
wrong, because the effigy was not completely restored.
31. Answer: iv. The answer to this question is in paragraph C. The marker in the text to look for is the name of
the church. Note that iv summarises the idea of how suitable the replacement for St Peters was as argued
in the first three sentences of the paragraph. The distracter here is i; the text says that it was not regarded
then as an act of vandalism.
32. Answer: vii. The answer to this question is in paragraph E.You need to look in the text for a reference to a
comprehensive assessment of the past or the same idea expressed in another way. The complete sentence
is a summary of the last paragraph. The distracter here is viii; note that it is not the validity of the works, but
the restoration work...the physical reality of the works exhibited that is being compared.
33. Answer: v. The answer to this question is in paragraph B. The marker in the text to look for is the word
restoration and references to its meaning, which occurs at the beginning of paragraphs B and C. The clues
here are in the words modern and narrow; paragraph B gives the modern meaning and paragraph C
gives you the wider meaning.
The difficulty in this exercise is that the first part of all the sentences ends in a verb, with three ending in was and one
with is. This means that you cannot just try to fit the two parts together by looking at the grammar. You have to understand
the meaning of the text that they summarise.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise information or an idea which is expressed in another way.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase.
- whether you are able to analyse a small part of a text and not allow the information around it to
interfere with your analysis.
- whether you are able to summarise a text.
QUESTI ONS 34 - 36
34 . Answer: A. The answer to this question is in paragraph B:
...with the campaign of comprehensive repair.... This programme of work, covering the entire
building both inside and out...
The distracters C and D are obviously wrong, which leaves B. The word conscientiously does not mean
the same as self- consciously.
35. Answer: C. The answer to this question is in the second sentence of paragraph A. Notice the word but in
the sentence, which shows you that a contrast is about to be made with the transformation and change just
mentioned.
36. Answer: B The answer to this question is in paragraph D, the last sentence. This question also relates to
number 33. It shows you that the writer supports the idea of the wider meaning of restoration.
Question type: The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise information or an idea which is expressed in another way.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase.
- whether you are able to analyse a small part of a text and not allow the information around it to
interfere with your analysis.
A book for IELTS
185
Key to Reading Tests
QUESTI ONS 37- 4 0
37. Answer: iv. You need to read each paragraph to extract the central meaning. In other words, you need to
work out why the author wrote the paragraph (See Reading Exercises 11 and 12) and to find the direction
of the paragraph (See Reading Exercises 6- 10). If we look at the organisation, we can see, the first two
sentences deal with the change the Abbey has experienced over the past 900 years: transformed/change
and change. The second sentence also mentions a permanent aspect of the building during the period: the
fact that the Abbey has not lost its identity. These first two sentences provide the background information to
the focus of the paragraph in the third sentence. Here the theme of change is taken up again: this process
of change deserves chronicling. This sentence is in effect the foreground information or most important
information in the paragraph (See Reading Exercises 10- 12). It is as if all the other details in the paragraph
dance around this point. The fourth and fifth sentences describe elements of change. The last sentence
concludes the paragraph by repeating the theme in the third sentence, i.e. the foreground information of the
paragraph.
The main purpose of the paragraph
is to show that the changes that have
taken place in the Abbey are worth
telling or deserve chronicling:
3- \
Change worth I
recording J
V
f 4.
I Elements
V of change
You see you need to read meaning not just words!
38. Answer: v. Again, you need to ask yourself why the author wrote the paragraph. He wrote it to explain what
restoration means by giving the example of the Abbeys repair scheme (campaign of...repair) at the end of
the seventeenth century, which was all-embracing (comprehensive) and unusual (exceptional) for its time.
The title neatly summarises the paragraph. Notice how the information is built up: the phrase campaign of
comprehensive repair in the first sentence. Then the point is taken up again in the second sentence and
expanded.
When you first look at this reading passage, you see that the paragraphs have letters at the beginning. This
indicates that there is likely to be a question on paragraph headings. As you are reading a passage for the
first time write down a brief heading of your own. Then when you do the exercise you can compare what you
have written with the exercise.
39. Answer: vi. The focus of the paragraph is in the phrase but respecting the meaning and ethos of the
building, which occurs at the end of the first sentence. The next sentence gives a good example of this, i.e.
St Peters in Rome. The last sentence then states how the Abbey was restored, but its meaning was kept.
So the heading reflects why the author wrote the paragraph.
4 0. Answer: ii. This is an easy one. The word example occurs in the first sentence, giving the focus of the whole
paragraph. Many students attempt all questions in the order they occur on the question paper. This means
that they waste a lot of time on the questions that they cannot do. You could give a title to this question
easily and then attempt the more difficult ones.
Remember it is not enough to just to read the first and last sentence of a paragraph to work out a heading.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text and knit together the information.
- whether you can summarise information or an idea.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase.
- whether you are able to analyse a small part of a text and not allow the information around it to
interfere with your analysis.
186
A book for IELTS
Key to Reading Tests
Test 2 P assage 1
Questi ons 1- 3
1. Answer: substituting (some) words. The answer is in the third sentence of the first paragraph. The
sentence in the exercise checks whether you understand what the writer means by translating, i.e. that it is
not just a matter of replacing words in one language for words in another language. It is more than that: it is
about translating sense.
Note that in the text, it says substituting one set of words for another. In the exercise, you can use only a
maximum of three words, so the word words summarises one set of words.
Note that you cannot say substitution of words here, because you would need to have the definite article,
the. You would then have four words.
2. Answer: a purpose. The answer is in the first sentence of the second paragraph. The sentence here is a
summary or paraphrase of the paragraph. In that sense, it is like a paragraph heading. The phrase whether
... or instructive covers the different types of text, the purpose of which the translator must consider.
Note you cannot have its purpose because of the latter half of the sentence: that the translator ... Nor
can you have the purpose.
3. Answer: (very) sparse. The answer is in the first sentence of the fourth paragraph. Two types of reader are
covered in the fourth paragraph: readers with good knowledge and sparse knowledge. If you remove the
word only from the statement in the exercise, you could have both good and (very) sparse. With only, you
can have only the latter.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan for specific information.
- whether you can recognise information or an idea which is expressed in another way.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase.
- whether you are able to analyse a small part of a text and not allow the information around it to interfere
with your analysis.
Questi ons 4 - 6
4 . Answer: B. This is a paraphrase of the information in the second sentence of the fourth paragraph:
It has been said that everything is translatable on condition that the two languages belong to cultures that
have reached a comparable degree of development.
A is not correct, because the text talks about the development of cultures, not of languages. C is not correct,
because the reference in the text is to the reader being up- to- date with the requisite technical
knowledge. The reader being up-to-date in this way is incidental to the cultures being of the same level of
development. The question posed by the writer here is an afterthought to the main part of the sentence. D is
not correct, because the text mentions that the translator has to balance the writers and the readers
expectations; it does not talk about the translators.
5. Answer: A. The answer is in the third sentence of the fifth paragraph:
However, this is not to ignore the fact that there might well be instances in which a text - awkwardly written
in the original - could be made more accessible by the translator.
Answer A gives you a paraphrase of the text. B is not correct, because the writer says it would be wrong to
over- simplify an erudite piece of prose. So, making something overly simple is not advised. C and D are
not correct, because the writer advises against making an amusing text ponderous.
6. Answer: A. The answer is in the first sentence of the sixth paragraph. Notice the writers paraphrase of the
word style: how she says it. Compare this with the paraphrase of the word style in the multiple choice i.e.
the way in which a writer says something. Alternatives B, C and D are not correct, because they are not
aspects which are stated as being important when translating. Allusions and subliminal messages (B and C)
are examples of what makes up style. They provide information which is subordinate to A. Alternative D is
wrong, because the text compares the translators job to doing a jigsaw puzzle, because she has to solve
appropriately the problems a text represents. The text does not say that it is important.
A book for IELTS
187
Key to Reading Tests
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase of words and ideas.
- whether you are able to understand and analyse specific points in the text.
Questi ons 7- 10
7- 10. Answer: A/C/D/F (in any order).
A is mentioned in paragraph 2, the first sentence of the paragraph: considers the purpose of the said text.
C is mentioned in paragraph 5. A translation should . . . mirror that of the original, but the translator also
has to make a judgement about making a text clearer, or more accessible . .. I t is a question of
judgement. (See number 5 above and 13 below). D is mentioned in the first sentence of paragraph 3:. . .
needs to consider who the readers of the translated text will be. F is mentioned in paragraph 4 in the
last sentence.
If you look at the last few words in the first paragraph you can see how the writer organised the text: and
asked herself a number of questions. The judgements that the translator has to make as she answers the
questions help organise the text. A is like a summary of paragraph 2; C summarises paragraph 5; D
summarises paragraphs 3 and 4; and F relates again to paragraph 4. The judgements are, therefore, like
headings that summarise the main body of the text.
As regards the distracter B, a poem is mentioned in the first sentence of paragraph 6, but nothing is said
about whether a translator has to decide if poetry is important or not. As for E, it is incorrect, because the
translator does not have to make a judgement about this. In paragraph 7, it says: The target language, for
the best results, should be her mother- tongue . . meaning that translating is best done into the mother
tongue. Moreover, the writer is not putting this forward as a point on which a decision needs to be made, it is
important to read the options carefully to make sure that they contain exactly the same information as the
text.
G is not mentioned in the text and H is wrong. See paragraph 5: it would be wrong to oversimplify. The
decision, in any case, would be whether to simplify rather than oversimplify.
Question type.The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase of words and ideas.
- whether you are able to understand and analyse specific points in the text.
- whether you can recognise the function of points in a text.
- whether you are able to summarise a text.
Questi ons 11- 14
11. Answer: culture and truth. The answer is in the fourth sentence in paragraph 1.
12. Answer: certain characteristics/the same expectations. The answer is in paragraph 3. Note that both
answers are possible.
13. Answer: style and register. The answer is in paragraph 5. This question asks you about the focus of the
fifth paragraph. Compare C in questions 7-10 above. Notice how questions 5, 7-10 and 13 examine
different aspects of the information in paragraph 5.
14. Answer: the whole text. This question takes you back to paragraph 1, the last sentence.
In short answer questions such as these, the important thing to remember is to scan the text and look for the
clues you have been given in the question: words or phrases that often appear in the same or similar form in
the text.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase of words and ideas.
- whether you are able to understand and analyse specific points in the text.
- whether you can recognise the function of points in a text.
188
A book for IELTS
Key to Reading Tests
Test 2 P assage 2
Questi ons 15-20
15. Answer: offshoot. The answer here is in paragraph D, in the first sentence. The word offshoot is a
paraphrase of the word branch in the text. The distracter here is the word offspring, which does not mean
the same as branch.
16. Answer: in vogue. The answer here is in paragraph A: For the past few years one of the buzz t erms__
The rest of the paragraph then shows how fashionable/common combinatorial chemistry is.
17. Answer: appearing. The information for this part of the summary is again in paragraph A. There is no
particular word there which the word appearing paraphrases.
18. Answer: follow religiously. The answer here is in paragraph B: These reviews all have the same format.
And then the paragraph describes the repeated formula of the paragraph. Note that the word religiously
means faithfully/exactly here. The distracter usually follow does not paraphrase exactly the meaning of the
phrase quoted above.
19. Answer: Once. The answer here is in paragraph E: After the development of solid phase peptide
synthesi s___The word Once is a paraphrase of the word After.
20. Answer: limitless. The answer here is in paragraph E, in the last sentence: The numbers of possible
sequences are truly innumerable!
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- -whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you are able to scan a text to recognise the organisation.
- whether you can analyse a text from the top down without being dragged down by detail which is
irrelevant to the question.
- whether you can summarise a text.
Questi ons 21-25
All the answers to complete the flow chart are found in paragraphs I and J. This summary covers a much smaller part
of the text than the previous exercise and is more precise.
21. Answer: (polypropylene) mesh sacs.
22. Answer: thermal sealing/being thermally sealed. Note that you have to change the words here slightly to
fit the wording of the chart. The diagram already mentions the fact that the sacs are closed, and you are
being asked to say here how that happens.
23. Answer: resin beads. Note that here you are being asked to state what the solid supports are, or are
made of.
24 . Answer: pot to pot. Note that you cannot use the word reagent here; you are only allowed to use three
words. Note also that the word pot on its own is not enough.
25. Answer: characterised and purified.
Note that this section tests the same skills as Questions 15- 20.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you are able to scan a text to recognise the organisation.
- whether you can analyse a text from the top down without being dragged down by detail which is
irrelevant to the question.
- whether you can summarise a text.
Questi ons 26-28
The answers to this section are found in paragraph B. Note that the sections are not in the order in which the information
appears in the passage.
26. Answer: F. Description B is not possible, because the first director mentioned in the original text is not
directly involved in research: a person who has not worked at the bench for years- - - - -
A book for IELTS
189
Key to Reading Tests
27. Answer: E. The distracter here is A. The text does not say that the second contributor is typically a director
of a technology business park , but a director whose company is situated in a new business park.
28. Answer: C. The distracter for this one is D. The original text does not say whether the third category of
contributor is an amateur or not. The text also says that the chemist can probably synthesise a few
thousand compounds per week; not that they do.
Note that the details in the exercise and the text are very similar. This means that you have to jump back and
forth between the two as you juggle the information.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you are able to scan a text to recognise the organisation.
- whether you can analyse a text from the top down without being dragged down by detail which is
irrelevant to the question.
- whether you can summarise a text.
- whether you able to juggle bits of information between the text and the exercise at the same time.
Questi ons 29
29. Answer: A. The answer to this question is in paragraph C. It is important to read the multiple choice
answers here very carefully, as you are juggling lots of small pieces of information within a short area of text.
If you then answer the question too quickly, you can easily match the wrong bits of information.
Question type: The question in this section tests:
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase of words and ideas.
- whether you are able to understand specific points in the text.
Test 2 P assage 3
Questi ons 30
30. Answer: C. The answer is in paragraph six. A is not correct, because four- wheel- drive vehicles are listed
among essential travelling companions (the last paragraph). The text does not say that they connect
towns. B is not correct, because the writer was referring to the earliest travellers to Iceland (also in the last
paragraph). D is not correct, because the text does not say that the entire island is connected or served by a
fleet of coaches.
Note that the question refers to the end of the text.
Question type: The question in this section tests:
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase of words and ideas.
- whether you are able to understand specific points in the text.
Questi ons 31- 36
31. Answer: Yes. The answer is in paragraph 2 in the third sentence. The statement is a paraphrase of the
phrase:. . . landscape is constantly being carved . . .
32. Answer: No. The answer is in paragraph 3. At the end of paragraph 2, the writer mentions that Iceland was
a Danish colony. Then in the next paragraph it states that the island gained full independence in 1944. So
Iceland is no longer a colony of Denmark.
33. Answer: No. The answer is in paragraph 2. There is a double negative in the statement; not dissimilar =
the same, but the text says that Iceland and Scandinavian countries are not similar, so the statement
contradicts the information given in the text. It is very important to check negative statements carefully,
especially when there are double negatives such as this.
190
A book for IELTS
Key to Reading Tests
34 . Answer: Yes. The answer is in the last sentence of paragraph 1:
... those who recoil in horror at the bleak lava fields which surround its airport may never return.
35. Answer: Not Given. The answer is in paragraph 1. In the text, it talks about those once intoxicated
by i t . . . , but we do not know if those are the majority or not; the text does not say how many people.
36. Answer: Not Given. The text nowhere states whether the author of the article is intoxicated by Iceland or
not. The writer is talking about the reactions of other people. She starts with a quote from the poet W.H.
Auden and goes on to describe the reactions of other people to Iceland, but we do not know what the writer
thinks about Iceland.
Note how the questions in this section jump around the text.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan for specific information.
- whether you can recognise an idea which is expressed in another way or a paraphrase.
- whether you are able to analyse a small part of a text and not allow the information around it to interfere
with your analysis.
Questi ons 37- 39
37. Answer: flourishing and (internationally) respected. The answer is in the first sentence of the fourth
paragraph. You need to scan the text for the words movie business/film industry.
38. Answer: (the) geysers. The answer is in the second sentence of the third paragraph. In this case, it is not
possible to give any more information about the geysers without exceeding the word limit given.
39. Answer: (a) sense of danger. The answer is in the second sentence of the fourth paragraph. As soon as
you find I celandic art by scanning the text, it is easy to find the answer required.
Note the exercise asks for a maximum of FOUR words. In the exam, always read the instructions in each
exercise. Do not assume that they are the same as the books you read as you were preparing for the exam.
Note that, in this section, you have to jump around the text to find the answer to the questions.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan for specific information.
- whether you can recognise information or an idea which is expressed in another way.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase.
- whether you are able to analyse a small part of a text and not allow the information around it to interfere
with your analysis.
Questi ons 4 0 & 4 1
4 0. Answer: limit damage. The answer is in the last sentence of the fourth paragraph. Be careful about the
grammar in this type of gapfill. It is not possible to write damage limitation, as a noun does not fit the
grammar of the sentence. A verb is needed here. Remember that the exact words you need do not always
appear in the text; particularly where filling gaps in a text is concerned, you may have to change the form of
some words.
4 1. Answer: protecting and developing. The answer is in the second sentence of the fifth paragraph. Note the
change in the form of the verbs. Note you cannot use nouns here, as you would have to write: the
protection and development of.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan for specific information.
- whether you can recognise information or an idea which is expressed in another way.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase.
- whether you are able to analyse a small part of a text and not allow the information around it to interfere
with your analysis.
The answers to questions in some of the reading texts in the IELTS exam may be like those above;
not always one after the other.
A book for IELTS
191
Key to Reading Tests
Questi ons 1- 5
1. Answer: xii. Remember to ask yourself why the writer wrote this paragraph. The paragraph explains what
the Alexander technique is about. The key words here are: I t is a technique for the elimination o f ...
habits of misuse , which are described as having negative effects.
2. Answer: x. Again, why did the author write the paragraph? She wrote it to show how the Alexander
Technique teaches people how to use themselves better. This applies to everyone (all), both able-bodied
and disabled people alike.
3. Answer: iv. The author wrote the paragraph to show how the Alexander Technique is adapted to suit
different disabilities. The text gives two examples of how the approach varies according to the particular
problem:
The approach and what results can be expected to vary greatly depending directly on eliminating tension
habits that have developed to compensate for the loss of disability. For the stroke patient, especially if
lessons are commenced early after the stroke, the Alexander Technique can play an important role in
rehabilitation and mobility retraining. With a blind person, the work is likely to focus on eliminating insecurity
leading to stiff and overcautious walking, balancing difficulties and poor head poise.
4. Answer: ii. The author wrote this paragraph to show the connection between tension and everyday
activities (daily routine):
Working with the disabled pupil, the Alexander teacher can offer help with everyday activities, things that
the average person takes for granted, such as the ability to brush ones teeth, shave, tie ones shoelaces or
cut a slice of bread. By looking at compensatory tension patterns, the teacher can, in many instances, help
the disabled person find a new means whereby they can perform these everyday tasks.
5. Answer: viii. The paragraph is about helping carers to help the people they are looking after:
In this respect, the lessons may extend to include the disabled persons carer ....
The rest of the paragraph then deals with this point.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text and knit together the information.
- whether you can summarise information or an idea.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase.
- whether you are able to analyse a small part of a text and not allow the
- information around it to interfere with your analysis.
For more details about this type of exercise look at Questions 37-40 in Reading Test 1. Compare the
differences in the paragraphs in this text and the exercise in Test 1. Can you see any difference in the type
of paragraph? Look at Reading Exercises 10-13.
Questi ons 6- 14
In this type of exercise, you should always check that the form of the words fit the sentence structure of the
summary.
6. Answer: re- educated. This is the only word which fits the blank space here. The word re- education occurs
in the first sentence of the text, but to fit the grammar you need to change the form of the word.
7. Answer: reflex mechanisms/ reflexes. The words occur in the first sentence of paragraph B. The first
answer given is the better of the two.
8. Answer: in harmony/harmoniously. The answer is in the second paragraph, the third sentence. The
adjective harmonious (paragraph A) does not work here, because you need an adverb (harmoniously) or
an adverbial phrase.
9. Answer: eliminated. The word elimination occurs in paragraph A and eliminating in paragraph D. You
need to change the form of the word here to fit the grammar of the summary.
10. Answer: use. The Alexander technique is about better use of ourselves. See paragraph B.
11. Answer: the disabled. See the title of the article and throughout the text.
12. Answer: requirements/disability. For the answer, you need to jump to the latter part of paragraph G. Again
you need to change the form of the word here to fit the grammar of the text. The verb require needs to be
changed to make it into a noun. You may put disability here as well, but it is repetitive.
192
A book for IELTS
Key to Reading Tests
13. Answer: factors. The text mentions the word factors in paragraph G, the first sentence. The word effects
is not suitable, because it would not summarise the text in paragraph G.
14 . Answer: a challenge/challenging. The answer is in the last sentence of paragraph G. Note that this
exercise tests your understanding of the whole text. It checks whether you are able to understand a
paraphrase and again tests if you can dip into the organisation for detail. The exercise is basically organised
around the main points covered by the writer.
In Reading P assage 1 P ractice Test 1, you had a similar summary with a Word List. In the exam, you may
have either. It is better, therefore, to practise both types of exercise.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you can summarise a text.
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase of words and ideas.
- whether you are able to scan a text to recognise the organisation.
Question 15
15. Answer: Not Given. In paragraph D, it says:
For the stroke patient, especially if lessons are commenced early after the stroke, the Alexander Technique
can play an important role in rehabilitation and mobility retraining.
The text tells you the Technique can play an important role, but it does not give information about the
success rate of the Technique with stroke patients.
Question type. The question in this section tests:
- whether you are able to scan for specific information.
- whether you can recognise an idea which is expressed in another way or a paraphrase.
- whether you are able to analyse a small part of a text and not allow the information around it to
interfere with your analysis.
Test 3 P assage 2
Questions 16- 19
In these short answer questions, the answers do not need to be full sentences. All you have to do is find the
necessary information, usually a short phrase, in the text.
16. Answer: science and technology. The answer is in the first sentence of the second paragraph:
History may well dub the 1900s The Century of Change - the era when science and technology forged a
permanent partnership and unleashed the first products of their unique alliance on a largely illiterate,
earthbound civilisation.
17. Answer: measurement. The answer is in the second sentence of the third paragraph.
Even if you do not know the word elusive, all you have to do is scan the text for the phrase speed of
change and the volume of knowledge. What the two things have in common is the fact that they could nol
be measured, i.e. measurement was elusive: they defied measurement.
18. Answer: rampant stress. The answer is in the penultimate sentence of the third paragraph.
Note that inexorable change and cut- throat competition are not the main contributory factors here. They
cause the stress which management consultants are then called in to address. Hence, the growth in their
business.
19. Answer: benefit. The answer is in the third sentence of the fourth paragraph. The text reads: P rogress
implies change with benefit. This means that change does not have benefit. Note that you do not have to
write change with benefit as the word change is already in the question.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan for specific information.
- whether you can recognise an idea which is expressed in another way or recognise a paraphrase.
A book for IELTS
193
Key to Reading Tests
- whether you are able to analyse a small part of a text and not allow the information around it to interfere
with your analysis.
Questions 20- 23
20. Answer: B. The answer is in paragraph 4, the fourth sentence:
It reflects action taken only after management has considered relevant past experiences, current priorities
and future objectives.
A and C are too limited in their reference to only one time. D is not specific enough, as it does not include
current priorities.
21. Answer: B. The answer is in paragraph 4, the fifth sentence:
Change for changes sake may reflect the response of a novice manager
The phrase Change for changes sake shows that the novice manager carries out change without having
any particular reason for doing so. A is not the right answer, as change for changes sake does not mean
always changing. There is no reference in the text to how often changes are made. C is not correct, as the
text says that change without benefit leads to low staff morale, not that the latter is something that managers
want to increase. D is not the right answer, because an advisory committee are not colleagues, i.e. people
you work with.
22. Answer: A. The answer is in paragraph 5, the third sentence:
Many in the worldwide audience viewed and listened from the comfort of their homes.
B is not correct, because it is the other way round! C is not correct, because it was the astronauts that joked,
not people in general. D is not correct, because the text does not compare science fiction and Christmas in
the sense that one became like the other. The text means that they had similar characteristics.
23. Answer: C. The answer is in paragraph 6:
that such accidents, although unfortunate, were also inevitable.
A is not correct, because the text says that it was the second moon expedition that showed that nothing is
exciting anymore, not the space shuttle explosion. B is not correct, because there is no reference in the text
to TV. D is not correct, because the text says that the astronauts knew the risks, but this does not mean that
they were to blame.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase of words and ideas.
- whether you are able to understand specific points in the text.
Questions 24 - 28
These questions are a variation on the Yes/ No/ Not Given format. In the exam, it is very important that you
read the instructions carefully and that you write the appropriate letter on your answer sheet.
24. Answer: C. The answer is in paragraph 7:
. .. computer-based programmes are replacing textbooks, blackboards and tutors.
Note that the exercise is only asking about teachers (tutors); it is not asking about textbooks and
blackboards as well.
25. Answer: F. The answer is in paragraph 8:
. .. will open the door to a future filled with a kaleidoscope of scientific and technical wizardry.
The vocabulary here may be a problem, but the tense is clear.
26. Answer: NG. The answer is in paragraph 7:
Factors such as the need for skilled and costly support services are rarely discussed.
In the text, there is no time reference regarding this development, even when it is discussed.
27. Answer: C. The answer is in paragraph 7:
The principles of learning are established: the way they may be best used in different settings and the results
evaluated will vary with client needs.
The answer here is tricky. The will here is not the will of the future, but has basically the same meaning as
the Present Simple i.e. every time it happens.
194
A book for IELTS
Key to Reading Tests
28. Answer: C. The answer is in paragraph 9: The time has come to ... (i.e. now).
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan for specific information.
- whether you can recognise an idea which is expressed in another way or a paraphrase.
- whether you are able to analyse a small part of a text and not allow the information around it to interfere
with your analysis.
Test 3 P assage 3
Questions 29- 32
When matching opinions, statements or topics to people it is important to scan the text to find the name of
the person. The answer you are looking for will then be easy to locate.
29. Answer: C. The answer is in paragraph D. The sentence in the exercise is a paraphrase of the information
in the last two sentences of the paragraph:
However, one point that is well understood is that a national minimum wage could cause a run of
differential-maintaining pay claims. The fact that the beneficiaries of a minimum wage usually lack
bargaining power (Lucas 1995) and that they are unlikely to be a reference group for any sector of
organised labour, takes the edge off this argument.
30. Answer: D. The answer is in paragraph B. The sentence is a paraphrase of the findings of Card & Krueger
in the third sentence:
A review of such studies by Card and Krueger (1995) concluded that minimum wages had no effect on
employment.
31. Answer: B. The answer is in paragraph C. The sentence in the exercise is a paraphrase of the information
in the last sentence of the paragraph:
Certain types of service industry, for example, can show positive employment effects (Alpert 1986).
32. Answer: A. The answer is in paragraph B. Note the sentence in the exercise uses a negative to paraphrase
the information in the text. Remember here that you are scanning for an idea rather than just specific words:
you are not scanning for the words does not have a positive effect as regards teenagers, but the idea
that the minimum wage has a negative effect as regards teenagers. So be careful about just scanning for
specific words.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase of words and ideas.
Questions 33- 39
33. Answer: low paid workers. The answer is in paragraph D. You can scan the text here for the words save/
saving and benefits.
34 . Answer: bad employers. The answer is in paragraph D. You can scan the text here for the word
subsidise/ subsidy.
35. Answer: certain/ some service industries. The answer is in paragraph C Note how this answer is
connected with 31 above. In 31, your ability to find the source of the information was being checked. Here it
is your ability to see how this information fits into the summary that is being tested.
36. Answer: development of training. The answer is in paragraph D. Note you have to change the form of the
words: develop to development and add the preposition of. Note that you cannot use the phrases better
market functioning/ more competitive conditions (in the same paragraph), as they do not fit the grammar
of the text; you would have to leave out the word the in the diagram. Note also the word even in the diagram
and where it occurs in the text.
Note the division here in the organisation of the information. In 33 to 36 above, the information relates
basically to the positive aspects of a minimum wage. The details that you are looking for in 37 to 39 are
about the negative effects.
A book for IELTS
195
Key to Reading Tests
37. Answer: differentials. The answer is in paragraph D.
38. Answer: out of business. The answer is in paragraph C.
39. Answer: teenagers. The answer is in paragraph B. Note how this particular question is testing different
details re teenagers to that tested in number 32 above.
The specific references within each paragraph have been omitted on purpose. This will give you extra
practice in scanning a text for information.
When completing diagrams it is important first to look carefully at the diagram so that you understand what
kind of information is missing in each case. It is also important to look carefully at the diagram itself,
particularly the directions of arrows and other connections between the various parts or boxes. As in
questions 29 to 32 you will need to scan the text to find the information given in the diagram, and then look
around this to locate the answer required.
Remember also to pay attention to the word limit set.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you can summarise a text.
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase of words and ideas.
- whether you are able to scan a text to recognise the organisation.
Questions 4 0- 4 2
4 0. Answer: B. The answer is in paragraph D:
Critics of the minimum wage would, of course, argue that it only benefits people who have a job.
A is not correct, because the cost of services is not referred to directly, although service
industries are (paragraph C):
. . . but, more importantly, showing the strategic processes which managers use to cope with an imposed
rise in the price of labour.
C and D are not mentioned as being effects of the minimum wage.
4 1. Answer: D. The answer is in paragraph E: . . . they are best executed through local rather than national
government, (fiscal counterbalance =adjustments in taxation). A is obviously then not correct. B and C are
not correct, because the type of taxation is not specified in the text.
4 2. Answer: C. The answer is again in paragraph C:
the dearth of studies based on local labour markets and on those of specific industries.
Even if you do not know the meaning of the word dearth, you can work out that it has a negative meaning by
the reference to a criticism. A, B and D are all obviously incorrect.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase of words and ideas.
- whether you are able to understand specific points in the text.
196
A book for IELTS
Key to Reading Tests
Test 4 P assage 1
Questions 1- 7
The answers to the questions in this section relate only to paragraph 2.
1. Answer: protostars.
2. Answer: plasma.
3. Answer: nuclear fusion.
4 . Answer: helium.
5. Answer: a red giant,
6. Answer: maintain (mechanical) equilibrium.
7. Answer: the Main Sequence.
Be careful about the numbers here!
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you can summarise a text.
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase of words and ideas.
- whether you are able to scan a text to recognise the organisation.
Questions 8- 11
8. Answer: C. The answer to this question is in paragraph 3:
so that they are squashed into closer proximity with each other, until a limit is reached where they resist
any further compression. This phenomenon is called degeneracy, and is a manifestation of the Pauli
Exclusion Principle.
So A is incorrect. B is wrong, because:
The temperature is so great that degeneracy cannot then be maintained. . .
(See the end of the third paragraph). D is wrong, because degeneracy happens to all stars.
9. Answer: C. The answer is in the first sentence of paragraph 3: The Pauli Exclusion Principle states that no
two identical particles can occupy the same quantum state. A is obviously a distracter; the Principle does not
say anything about stars being the same or different. Alternative B is not true. The author uses the example
of low mass stars to illustrate the Principle and the phenomenon of degeneracy (See the third sentence in
the third paragraph and the subsequent text). D is wrong, because:
. . . this pressure . . . remains constant while the temperature continues to increase.
10. Answer: B. The answer is in the first sentence of the penultimate paragraph. Alternative A is not correct,
because the statement applies to all stars. C is not correct, as it again happens to all stars. As regards D,
only smaller stars undergo a helium flash (See the first sentence of paragraph 4).
11. Answer: C. The answer is in the first paragraph: Their journey along the evolutionary path, and ultimate fate
at stellar death, is determined by their initial mass,. . . So it is their mass when they are first formed (their
initial mass), which affects their development throughout their lives.
Note the answers to the questions are not in the same order as the information occurs in the passage.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase of words and ideas.
- whether you are able to understand and analyse specific points in the text.
Questions 12- 14
You can answer the questions in this section simply by scanning the text to find the references to the different solar
masses.
12. Answer: white dwarfs. See the beginning of the fifth paragraph.
A book for IELTS
197
Key to Reading Tests
13. Answer: neutron stars. See paragraph 6.
14 . Answer: Black Holes. See the penultimate paragraph.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase of words and ideas.
- whether you are able to understand and analyse specific points in the text.
Test 4 Passage 2
Questions 15-20
As you read the passage for the first time, you should try to write down beside the paragraph a quick heading of your
own. You should try, however, not to spend a lot of time doing this. If you cannot think of a title immediately, you should
continue reading. When you come to do the exercise, you will also find that some paragraphs are easier to do than others,
so do them first.
For each of the paragraphs, ask yourself the same question: why did the writer write the paragraph? See also Reading
P assage 3, P ractice Test 1and Reading P assage 1, P ractice Test 3. Please also see Reading Exercises 10-13.
If there is an example, cross it from the list before you do the exercise. You then reduce the number of alternatives you
have to look at.
15. Answer: iv. The writer wrote this paragraph as an introduction. The purpose of the paragraph is to show
what envy means. Note that xiii is not acceptable, because it refers to only part of the paragraph i.e. the
second sentence, and not the whole paragraph.
Always remember that the title is a brief summary of the whole paragraph and reference to part of the
paragraph is not acceptable. If you have problems with this look at Reading Exercises 10-13.
16. Answer: vii. The paragraph talks about (a) the Swahili in Coastal East Africa, (b) their views about envy and
(c) how the Swahili deal with envy: they try to convince people that there is no reason to envy someone
elses success. Note that (a) and (b) lead up to the focus of the paragraph.
This title is also a paraphrase of the title of the whole article. The distracter here is (x).
17. Answer: xiv. Note that the paragraph is about the Evil Eye and the fact that it is a universal or global
phenomenon. The paragraph mentions some parts of the world where pendants depicting the Evil Eye are
worn to protect the wearer against Envy. It does not say that the wearing of the pendant is a global remedy.
It says that the Evil Eye is universal, but the text only refers to parts of Europe where the wearing of a
pendant is a way of repelling envy. So iii is not acceptable. Note also how v refers to only part of the text.
18. Answer: ii. This is an easy one as the paragraph is devoted to a particular example of envy. The first few
sentences are only by way of introduction.
19. Answer: ix. Note that the paragraph is not limited to poor societies. The example given at the end of the
paragraph could happen in rich as well as poor societies.
The writer is saying that the idea of limited good holds true for both poor and rich societies. It does not matter
that the main part of the paragraph talks about poor societies. If you, therefore, choose xv as your answer,
you are only summarising part of the paragraph, i.e. poor societies.
It is a common mistake for students to choose a title which covers part of a paragraph - you need to be able
to hold all the parts of the paragraph together to arrive at the correct title. Compare number 15 above.
20. Answer: xii. It is tempting to put i as the answer, but again it is only a summary of part of the text, sentences
2 and 3. The paragraph also talks about what envy is and in this sense it is similar to paragraph A. However,
the paragraph talks about something more than what envy is iv; it talks about envy as opposed to other
feelings, namely: jealousy, love, and gratitude and ambition.
Questi on type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text and knit together the information.
- whether you can summarise information or an idea.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase.
- whether you are able to analyse a small part of a text and not allow the information around it to interfere
with your analysis.
198
A book for IELTS
Key to Reading Tests
Questi ons 21- 24
You can answer the questions in this section in two ways. You can look for the Concepts, or you can look
for the names. In fact, when you look through the questions before you read through the passage for the first
time, you should automatically notice that you are going to have to match names with theories and give titles
to paragraphs. As you read, therefore, you should mark the names in some way. Our advice is to put a light
box in pencil around each name as you read. Then it will be easy to identify the names and match them with
the concepts.
Note that one of the people mentioned in the passage does not occur in the exercise.
21. Answer: v. The answer is in paragraph C. You just have to scan the text for the name and then check the
paraphrases against the concepts in the exercise. You can also scan the text for the idea, but this is more
difficult, as you are trying to match an idea that is expressed in a different way, even if just slightly. Note how
the previous exercise can help you with this particular answer. The heading for paragraph C tells you what is
in that paragraph. It shows you the value of being able to summarise a chunk of text and see the
organisation. You then know where to find it quickly.
As in all tests, if you can find the principles which govern the testing, then you have a greater chance of
succeeding in that test.
22. Answer: i. The answer is in paragraph F. The same methods apply here as for 21 above. Notice again how
the previous exercise helps you around the text. Read the paragraph heading, then the first sentence of the
paragraph and then the name attached to the Concept. Did you do this exercise without reference to the
information you gathered as you did the previous exercise?
23. Answer: vii. The answer is in paragraph G. Note here how the information you gathered in the previous
exercise is still able to help you. While you were looking for a heading for paragraph G, did you consider the
heading (i) as a possibility? If you looked at it, you then might have remembered it, when you came to do this
exercise.
This exercise gives you a clear example of how information is organised in an extended piece of text. You
should, as you read generally, always look for markers that help you organise your reading of a text: here it
is themes, which are more difficult, as they require you to collect together larger chunks of information (See
Reading Exercises 10- 13); and names which act like pegs to hang information on. Look at the other
passages in this book and read them for the organisation. Do you remember Reading Exercises 1- 5? Also
look back at the Key to Questions 1- 6 in P ractice Test 1 Reading P assage 1.
24 . Answer: ii. The answer is in paragraph D. Notice the inter-relationship between the spread of envy and
illness.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase of words and ideas.
Questi ons 25- 28
25. Answer: More fortunate/ Successful/ P owerful/ P rosperous. For the first answer see the dictionary
definition in paragraph A. Compare this with the distracter heading for this paragraph in the first set of
questions for this text. For the second, see the last sentence of paragraph B. For the word P owerful see the
last sentence of paragraph E. For P rosperous see the word prosper Paragraph A.
26. Answer: source of harm. See the second sentence of paragraph C.
27. Answer: dangerous pastime. The answer is at the beginning of paragraph B.
28. Answer: minimise personal success. The answer is again at the beginning of paragraph B.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
- whether you can recognise information or an idea which is expressed in another way.
- whether you are able to analyse a small part of a text and not allow the information around it to interfere
with your analysis.
A book for IELTS
199
Key to Reading Tests
Test 4 P assage 3
Questions 29-33
29. Answer: C. The answer is in paragraph 5. The condition that needs to be met is in the first sentence and the
result or implication is in the last sentence of the paragraph:
If you, or a colleague, have a problem with some aspect of work share i t with everyone in the
tea-room. One of your colleagues will, doubtless, have had similar difficulties in the past and will have found
a ridiculously simple solution. To your surprise, you will discover he is more than happy to share his
experience and answers with you over a cup of tea. Both of you wi l l then go back to your desks with
added commi tment and make a posi ti ve contri bution to the work of the group.
Note how the sentence in the exercise summarises the two parts of the text, and the paragraph. Notice the
clues: P rovi ded... / I f . . . both give you a condition, which is followed by a result/implication:. .. will work
h a r d e r w i l l then go back-----
30. Answer: F. The answer is in paragraph 7.
Who wil l be trained? Keen, eager, people: the raw recruits. Rel eased from the i nhibiti ons of the office
environment in the rel axed atmosphere of a tea-room, they have the confidence to ask dumb
questions. This is, in fact, the best pl ace to fi nd soluti ons to probl ems; and conduct training. In the
tearoom, ol d hands, freed temporaril y from the modern technologies they often do not fully understand,
wil l invari abl y offer advice.
Note again how the exercise sentence summarises the text. The sentence paraphrases the information to
show you the underlying meaning/ organisation of the text in bold: a condition followed by an implication.
31. Answer: G. The answer is in paragraph 4.
What will the Boss say, however? If he has any sense, he will al so come and j oi n you. Perhaps, he
supports another team? You can discuss the merits of the players and show him how competently you can
present a case. He wi ll reali se that the tearoom is an i deal pl ace for informal meetings with hi s staff,
where any number of day-to-day problems can be sorted out over a cup of tea, and where anyone who
needs a tender warning about something can be quietly given it without the march to The Office. ....
Again the meaning is made clearer/ summarised by the sentence in the exercise.
32. Answer: A. The answer is in the last paragraph.
But l et us say we al l ow staf f to enjoy staggered breaks. The morning coffee is between 10.00 and 11.00.
Lunch is sometime between 12.00 and 2.00. Afternoon tea is between 3.00 and 4.00. The tea-room can
then be used by ti me-consci ous executi ves to have thei r meetings. And si nce the room is requi red
for refreshment, these meetings must never overrun, unless they are schedul ed after afternoon tea...
Who wants to work late anyway?
Note the phrase let us say we allow staff to enjoy = I f we allow . Note also the implication in the text is
expressed by:. .. can then be used by . must never over-run ...
33. Answer: D. The answer is in paragraph 4:
. . . can be quietly given it without the march to The Office. If, as a consequence, the communicati on
process improves, the boss may even dispense with a layer of middle management twi xt you and
himself. He will then no longer need to have expensive 'Off Site Meetings where his middle managers
experience Free Expression. He can spend some of the savings on light refreshments for his staff to enjoy!
Note how the conditions and implications summarise the main points in the text. The writer is trying to
convince the reader of the merits of having a tea- room. He sets out to show that, if certain conditions are
met, there will be a number of implications for the workplace.
Note that the conditions are in a different order to what they are in the text.
Note how the text lends itself to this kind of summary rather than a gap-fill exercise.
Questi on type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you can summarise a text.
- whether you are able to scan a text for specific information.
200
A book for IELTS
Key to Reading Tests
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase of words and ideas.
- whether you are able to scan a text to recognise the organisation.
Questions 34-38
34. Answer: Not Given. The text says at the end of paragraph 4:
He can spend some of the savings on light refreshments for his staff to enjoy!
However, nowhere in the text does the writer say that a variety of snacks should be provided in
tea- rooms. The statement in the exercise is stating an opinion about all tea-rooms, whereas the text is
giving an implication, /7the boss gets rid of a layer of management. They are not talking about the same
thing, even though the ideas are similar!
35. Answer: Yes. The answer is in paragraph 1:
but how do they manage to make one packet of chocolate digestives last one whole week?
36. Answer: Yes. The answer is in paragraph 3, in the first sentence.
37. Answer: No. The answer is in paragraph 6 in the second sentence:
They are normal people in their everyday lives, but there are
38. Answer: Yes. The answer is in paragraph 7:
in the relaxed atmosphere of a tea-room, they have the confidence to ask dumb questions.
Look at Reading Exercises 17-22 and the Key to P ractice Test 1Reading P assage 2.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan for specific information and ideas.
- whether you can recognise an idea which is expressed in another way.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase.
Questions 39-42
39. Answer: damned few. The answer is in paragraph 2
40. Answer: light refreshments. The answer is in paragraph 4 in the last sentence. See number 34 above.
41. Answer: cringe. The answer is in the penultimate sentence of paragraph 8.
42. Answer: modern technologies. The answer is in paragraph 7.
Question type. The questions in this section test:
- whether you are able to scan for specific information.
- whether you can recognise information or an idea which is expressed in another way.
- whether you can recognise a paraphrase.
- whether you are able to analyse a small part of a text and not allow the information around it to interfere
with your analysis.
A book for IELTS
201
K ey to
S ection on W riting
I
A book for IELTS
203
Key to Section on Writing
Section on Writing - Graphs and Diagrams for Task 1
Exercise 1
1. The data in the chart can be dividod into three categories just like the example at the beginning of the exercise. The three
main groups are physical, mental, and other i.e. the activity does not fit exactly into either of the other two categories. The
physical group can be further sub-divided into two types: light exercise i.e. Walking, Playing with children and heavy
exercise: DIY, Visiting a sports centre, Gardening. The other1group includes Evening classes and Voluntary work.
Note that Playing with children and Gardening could come into either the heavy or light work category.
2. You can see that the information on the chart is presented in a different way from Figure 1, but the activities are the same.
So they can be divided into the same categories. Now that you can see the data in categories, it is easy to compare across
the charts. For example, you can compare Gardening in both charts under physical activity and, say, Walking and see the
differences.
3. You can group the information in this chart in several ways: team sports and individual sports; sports that can be played anywhere
and sports that require special conditions e.g. hang-gliding; and cost: expensive sports like sub-aqua and cheap sports like
football. You can also describe the data across the three categories just mentioned!
4. At first sight, the data in the graph is difficult to analyse. In the previous bar charts, the information is neatly packaged in blocks
and because of the number of items, they are easy to classify. The appearance of the line graphs is more complex. They go
through one another and it is difficult to see patterns, but the patterns and organisation are there, nonetheless.
The first obvious pattern is that the value of two of the companies goes up and the third down. Grouping the former two
together, you can see that the trend for the Berk Corporation is steadily upwards, while that for F&B Enterprises is more
irregular. The pattern for the former can be divided into two parts: a sharp rise in share price within the first year and a half
followed by a period of relative stability. Each of these two periods can then be subdivided. For example, the price for the
first period increases slightly and then it rockets. Can you divide the line for the Berk Corporation? Look for gradual and
sharp rises.
Note also how the price appreciation for SPQF LTD in the first year partly mirrors that for the Berk Corporation and how the
rise and fall are repeated with the decline in the third year dividing into two sections: a dramatic plunge followed by a more
gradual decline.
You can see that the same principle of patterns applies between the graphs and within sections of the graphs.
5. You can divide the items into two groups: beef versus the other three, i.e. fall and relative rise. Within the larger group
there is a difference in the consumption between poultry and the other two.
There is another pattern. The total amount of protein consumed over the period declines steadily. Add the totals at the
beginning and at several points in the middle and then at the end.
You may be able to see more patterns than are mentioned here. If you can, then that is very good. Hopefully, you can see
that once you find a framework within which to work, it is easier to write about the information.
Exercise 2
A 4, 6, 8, 12
Note the different words to describe the fall: collapse, plummet, fall steeply and plunge. The verb fall by itself does not describe
completely enough the drama of the graph.
B 3,7,17; C 1,11,16; D 9,15; E 14; F 2; G 10,18; H 5,13
See also Exercise 8.
Exercise 3: The correct chart is D.
Exercise 4
204
A book for IELTS
Key to Section on Writing
Exercise 5
Compare your answer with the line graph below.
400 j
Months of the year
Now you can try to describe the line graph above and check your answer with the model in the exercise!
Exercise 6
1. The relationship between coal and natural gas. This is called an inverse relationship.
2. Other main features are:
The rise in natural gas, which first overtakes coal in mid 1992 and then petroleum for part of 1995.
The minor peaks in coal at the end of/beginning of 1993/1994 with corresponding dips in the consumption of
nuclear and hydro-electricity.
The relative stability of the consumption of petroleum over the period.
The slight increase in the use of Nuclear and hydro-electricity.
The amount of energy consumed at the beginning of the period is not much different from that at the end. So over the
period the amount of energy consumed is relatively constant.
Rises in one energy source are mirrored by falls in another, e.g. coal/gas, coal/nuclear and hydro-electricity.
3. You can divide the energy sources into two types, fossil: petroleum, coal, natural gas and
non-fossil: nuclear and hydro-electricity.
4. Look for a pattern. Nuclear and hydro-electricity is below the line, coal above, and so on.
5. No, not unless you are asked to do so.
6. The Present Simple and the Simple Past. You use the Present Simple when you are describing the graph as you are
looking at it. Remember that the information on the graph remains the same. It doesnt change. It is like a fact: Water boils
at 100 degrees Centigrade. See the answer to number 2 above. You can use the Simple Past by way of contrast to talk
about the dates. In the middle of 1992, coal was overtaken by natural gas and then in 1995 natural gas outstripped
petroleum to become the main source of energy.
7. Consumption can be divided into two parts: the relative stability of 1992/93 and the more erratic behaviour in the
subsequent years.
8. Consumption: use, usage; the amount consumed
Fall: decline, drop. (Not: fall down).
Rise: increase, climb, go up (Not: rise up).
Exercise 7
Look at the corrected text below. The changes are in bold.
1. The graph shows the energy consumptionfrom fossil and non-fossil fuels in the UK in million tonnes of oil/coal equivalent from
1992 to I995.
2. A striking feature of the graph is the rise in the use of natural gas. Gas consumption was steadily upwards, overtaki ng coal
towards the end of 1992 and finally outstripping petroleum in 1995 to become, for a period, the second most common
energy source.
3. This increase coincided with a drop in the use of coal during the period 1992 to 1995. At the beginning of 1992, coal
consumpti on stood at approxi mately 65 million tonnes. In the first quarter of 1992, there was a brief, steady climb and,
A book for IELTS
205
Key to Section on Writing
from then until the beginning of the third quarter in 1995, the trend was markedly down. The fal l, at first, was quite steep.
From the end of 1993, consumption was steady with two minor peaks at the end of 1993 and 1994, which corresponded
with two dips in the use of nuclear and hydro-electricity. Then from the beginning of 1995 coal consumption resumed its
decline.
4. As can be seen, petroleum was the main source of energy throughout the period with little or no change in the amount
consumed. The use of non-fossil sources of energy, i.e. nuclear and hydro-electricity, over the period i ncreased gradually
with no dramatic rises or falls.
5. Despite the variations, the overall amount of energy consumed during the period shown on the graph was little changed
at the end of 1995.
Note:
Some of you will be surprised to learn the text above is too long. It contains 245 words, when the exam only requires
at least 150. You could remove about 60 or 70 words quite easily.
The changes in the text above include avoidance of repetition. Look at paragraph 2 and check for synonyms of words
like rise and fall. For example the last word in paragraph 3 has been changed to decli ne to avoid the repetition of the
word fall.
The above text is not the only answer. You could divide the four energy sources into two groups: fossil i.e. petroleum,
natural gas and coal; and non-fossil, nuclear and hydro-electricity.
The text does not contain all of the information contained in the graph. Look at the comprehension questions in Exercise 6.
Note the complex sentence in paragraph 2:
Gas consumption was steadily upwards, overtaking coal towards the end of 1992 and finally outstripping petroleum
in 1995 to become, for a period, the second most common energy source.
Note the change from popular to common in paragraph 2.
Exercise 8
1. Answer: F and C
2. Answer: M and L
3. Answer: Kand N
4. Answer: E and D
5. Answer: Band K
6. Answer: K and C/M/P
7. Answer: H and O
8. Answer: G and I
9. Answer: J and I
10. Answer: C/M/P and F
Exercise 9
In each case below, where there are two possibilities the first answer is the better one.
1. m as can be seen from the chart
e in the chart
2. r double the estimate for the period
o which is twice as much as the estimated figures
3. s before picking up
k before they went up
4. f outstripping projections by a wide margin
z doing better than expected
5. t proved
v were
6. i being
7. c those
p they were
8. I forecast for the period
n which were predicted for the period
9. h declined further
x went down
10. j November saw a noticeable turnaround
a in November the number of shoppers
increased again
11. y during which time they did better than the
figures predicted
g outperforming the figures predicted
12. u hitting a peak
13. q reveal a marked shift
w show that there was a change
14. d experienced a hefty fall
b fell by a large amount
Note the di fference between 4 and 11.
206
A book for IELTS
Key to Section on Writing
Exercise 10
Read the version below.
The prediction is that European Internet music sales will go up a lot over the period which the graph covers. They will rise
erratically at first and will then leap in two stages to reach a high of $3900 million in 2012, before going up to a new peak of
$8000 million at the end of 2014. Album sales, on the other hand, which will climb at first until the end of 2006, are then set
to drop steadily throughout the next five years, before they bottom out and end the period a lot below $1000 million.
With European cinema attendances, there are two diverging forecasts. The first estimate is for numbers to rise steadily
between the year 2003 and 2008, and increase from just below 900 million visitors to 1200 and the biggest jump in cinema
people is projected to be in the year 2008. But, the second forecast is different. The projection for the first three years of the
period shows a rise, but after that cinema attendances will fall to below 400 million people.
You can see that the above version is not as good as the original. Most students at a high grade will write a text somewhere
between the two versions! Read the two texts several times so that you can see the difference clearly.
Exercise 11
7. A compari son of the borrowings for 1996 and 1997 shows that they (9) fall into three categori es. (12) On the one
hand, those for fiction and the other category fell, (13) the former by 50% from 30% of borrowings to 15% and (8) the
latter again by 50% from ten per cent to five per cent.
6. By contrast, borrowings of childrens books, romance and sci-fi all rose (14 ) by varying degrees. Childrens increased by
several percentage points, (4 ) whereas books taken out from the romance section rose by 50% between the two years. The
number of books borrowed by those reading science-fiction (10),however, went up threefold.
3. I n the third category come non-fiction and crime, neither of which saw any rise.
The contents of the library are (1) in no way reflected by the books that are taken out in either of the years. (2) For
example, sci-fi books make up five per cent of the books in the library, while in both years borrowings exceed this amount,
by three times as we have seen in 1997. Take non-fiction (5) as another example. Lendings in both years stand at five per
cent, (11) whereas 20 per cent of the books fall into this category.
Exercise 12
1. Blank 2. d
3- j
4. f 5. Blank 6. Blank
7.g
8. h 9. a 10. e 11. c 12. Blank
13. Blank 14. i 15. b
Exercise 13
The sentences below contain the corrections. Can you find them?
1. There was a sharp decrease in the number of people attending the theatre over the period.
2. The increase in the incidence of petty crime has continued in spite of the measures introduced.
3. The charts indicate that the price of the various types of cars fell considerably.
4. It was predicted that industrial production in Western countries will/would level out, while that in the so-called Tiger economies
will/would rise in the early 90s.
5. The price of computers has been dramatically reduced over the period.
6. As regards noise pollution, a fairly big rise in the number of complaints was recorded for 1997.
7. As can be seen, the rate of increase slowed over the last five years of the period.
8. In 1974, its output began to stage a gradual recovery.
9. Between February and May, the income was fairly erratic.
10. It is estimated that the number of cars on the road will plunge when road pricing is introduced.
11. Sales hit a peak in late summer and then fell back in the subsequent months.
12. There were, according to the graph, no significant changes in sales from 1973 to 1976.
13. The rate of inflation dropped slowly, but surely, in the early 80s.
14. The main characteristic of the bar chart is the large drop in male students applying. The birth rate rose quite
slowly over the period.
15. The birth rate rose quite slowly over the period.
Exercise 14
1.b 5. a, e, h, n, o 6. e, h n 8. i 9. e, h, j, n, o; not q
12. e, h, n, p 13. e, n 14. d 17. f, m18. f, m
A book for IELTS
207
Key to Section on Writing
Exercise 15
1. fall down. Students often user this instead of fall. A person or a house, for example, falls down.
2. Has declined; has dropped; has been reduced; has been dropped; has gone down; has decreased. These simple verbs cause a
lot of confusion. You can divide the verbs in the list into three types: (i) decline, go down, fall, subside, deteriorate. All of
these verbs are intransitive i.e. they do not take an object, and so you cannot use them in the passive, (ii) reduce. This verb
needs an object when it is active i.e. it is transitive. Therefore, you can use it in the passive, (iii) drop, decrease and slow
down. These verbs are both transitive and intransitive. You can, therefore, use them in the active and passive: they dropped
the price; the price has dropped and the price has been dropped. You cannot use the verb reduce in the same way!
3. The second one is the correct answer. Dip and dramatically do not go together.
4. a) you need to use falling instead of dropping.
b) cost of living
c) plummet is the wrong word here; you cannot use the word plummet as a noun. You need to use a noun like fall.
d) deterioration is the wrong word. The word deterioration usually relates to quality rather than number s , e.g. the situation
deteriorated; the value of the dollar deteriorated against the euro. You would have to use fall, decrease etc.
e) diminution is the wrong word; should be a word like decrease, fall etc.
f) You should use trend rather than tendency.
5. Whereas/Whilst
6. To be erratic; to go up and down; to be volatile; to be unstable; to go through a period of instability; to go through an erratic
period; to experience a period of instability/volatility.
7. There was no change in the birth rate over the period. Note the change from verb to noun. Try to vary your writing like this. It
makes it less repetitive. You can express stability as follows: to remain stable, to be stable, experience/go through a period
of stability, not to fluctuate,
8. Deteriorate and decline. For deteriorate see 4d above; note that value etc can plunge etc, but the word deteriorate cannot
interchange with the other words in all situations. As for decline, it is neutral in that it does not really indicate the quality of
the fall; the other words relate to a sharp fall.
9. You could use the following phrases as synonyms: the teenage crime rate; crime rate among teenagers; teenage crime
rates; the number of crimes committed by teenagers; the number of crimes committed by young people in their teens.
10. Regarding; With regard to; Concerning; As for; Where______ is concerned; when it comes to________; Turning to; In the
case of; To turn to. These words and phrases are important, because they help connect information. They are especially
helpful, when you describe charts or when you are referring to items in a list, e.g. in an essay title because they point to the
items.
11. Illustrates; plots.
Exercise 16
1. Possible answers are as follows:
After that, the information is collated and sent out electronically to other agents.
At the next stage, the information is collated and sent out electronically to other agents.
The next step/stage is to collate the information and send it out electronically to other agents.
Subsequently, the information is collated and sent out electronically to other agents.
The information is then collated and sent out electronically to other agents.
Following that, the information is collated and sent out electronically to other agents.
2. characteristic, feature, aspect. Note that the word aspect is not always a synonym for the first two words.
3. The number of companies who registered approval of the new currency rose with an increase of more than 35%.
Or rose by 35%
4. ... in the first three months followed by a steady decline ...
5. Both are correct. At first sight, the second sentence appears incorrect, but it is possible for the management of the
cinema to have increased attendance. The agent is not mentioned.
6. You would normally say rise(s) or fall(s).
7. The word prophesy does not fit in here.
8. It is forecast that the number of people on waiting lists will rise steadily in the coming years.
9. No. It sounds odd, because you have projected and in the coming years, both referring to the future. It is probably better to
leave out the word projected.
10. The word interesting makes the statement subjective. The word significant is more neutral.
11. The fall in investment in science is almost the same as that for training.
The fall in investment in science is not that different from that for training.
The fall in investment in science almost exactly mirrors that for training.
The fall in investment in science is mirrored by that for training.
208
A book for IELTS
Key to Section on Writing
12. All of the sentences depend on the emphasis you wish to put on the particular parts of the information Sentence a is
probably the simplest of the alternatives given.
13. ... is not as big/large/great as that for science.
Exerci se 17
Reconstructed text.
The data in the table relating to passenger death rates by mode of land transport in Great Britain between 1981 and 1993
can be divided into three categories.
The first group, consisting of cars, vans and bicycles experienced a significant reduction in the rate of road death over the
period under study. For example, death among the car and van users declined by more than half, falling from 6.1 per billion
passenger kilometres to 3.0 and 3.8 to 1.7, respectively. Cycling, however, despite a significant decrease from 56.9 per
billion to 41.3, remained the second most dangerous type of land transport.
In the second category, comprising motorcycles and rail, the rate dropped slightly between 1981 and 1993. Motorcycling
was the most dangerous type of transport, averaging more than twice as many fatalities as cycling, and more than twenty
times as high as cars.
Regarding the third group, buses and coaches, the road death rate almost trebled over the period under review.
Nevertheless, buses and coaches were still the second safest type of vehicular transport.
Exerci se 18
As (17) can be seen from the maps, the area of Barton Bingham (6) changed significantly between 1937 and 1995.The
road bisecting the area (16) was straightened and on both sides various developments (7) took place. On the north side,
the manor house (8) was converted into a health farm and part of the surrounding scrubland and adjacent woodland
(1) became a golf course. The area immediately adjacent to the road (3) gave way to housing along its entire length.
On the south side of the road, a railway station (5) was constructed in 1990, which (15) was connected by a minor road to
the main thoroughfare. In 1991, the disused railway line (10) was reopened, with a bridge (4 ) being built across the road.
In the scrubland to the east of the lake, a leisure complex (11) was completed and opened in 1993. In addition, the area of
agricultural land which (2) exi sted in 1937 (13) was halved to make way for the construction of a new hospital and a car
park both also with road access to the main highway. A farmhouse (14 ) was buil t on the remaining agricultural land. Next to
the agricultural land, the marshes that (12) were there in 1937, (9) were turned over to a wildfowl sanctuary.
Notes
Note the different words which are used to avoid repeating the word change: convert, become, turn over to, give way to.
Note that you cannot replace 3 with 9. This is not just because 9 is in the plural. The expression give way to has the idea
that the land was surrendered to something bad or negative. The expression turn over to is suitable in both cases.
Now try to write a description of the changes in the maps without looking at the text in the exercise.
Exerci se 19
The sequence of texts is: I, d, o, a, j, k, c, i, b, g
Sentences e, f, h, m, n, are distracters.
Note that the language in the diagram is in the present simple. This is like looking at a graph and describing the graph as a
picture. You are concerned here with the sequence of the events not the time.
When you write the description and add the dates the tense has to be the simple past, because the text is describing a
specific sequence of events in the past. For practice, you could try to write a description of how a documentary is made
rather than how a specific documentary was made. Compare the language here with the language in the next 5 exercises.
Exerci se 20 : The suggested answer is:
To create a daily newspaper the necessary material is taken from two sources, timber and recycled paper, and then passed
through a series of machines.
Trees are cut down to provide timber. In the first machine, the bark is removed and then the timber is chopped up into small
pieces. These chippings are put into a mechanical refiner, and subsequently a hydrapulper where they are mixed with water
and made into a pulp. At the next stage, the pulp is put into a blend chest where it is mixed with pulp from recycled paper.
This mixture is then refined, cleaned and screened, before going into a large piece of machinery where it is made into rolls
of paper.
Once the newspaper has been printed, it is distributed. After the reader has finished with the paper, it is recycled. The
recycling process first involves the paper being put into a hydrapulper to turn it into a pulp. A de-in king cell then extracts the
ink. After that, the solution is put into the blend chest: and the whole process is repeated.
Note that the tense is used is mainly the present simple and most of the verbs are in the passive. Compare the tenses in Ex. 19.
A book for IELTS
209
Key to Section on Writing
Secti on on Wri t i ng - Essay Wri t i ng f or Task 2
Exercise 21
1. B; 2. F; 3. C; 4. K; 5.0; 6. P; 7. H 8. J 9. N 10. R
Exercise: 22
1. A; 2. B, C, D, H; 3. E; 4. None. You could adapt A; 5. None. Again you could adapt A;
6. D; 7. B, C; 8. G; 9. B, C, D, H; 10. F
Exercise 23
1. Answer: D/N. The question in the focus means: what is your opinion? Note that the general subject in the essay title is
presented in such a way that it gives you two sides of an issue. If you think about it, it is difficult to give an opinion about
something unless it has an element of controversy and at least two sides to it. Would you ever have a question like: Water
boils at 100?C at sea level. Where do you stand on this matter?/ To what extent do you agree? etc.
2. Answer: D/N. See number 1above.
3. Answer: G. Some people make the mistake of writing about the disadvantages and the advantages. A danger can be a
disadvantage, but a disadvantage may not be a danger! Moreover, you are usually asked to write about advantages and
disadvantages, not disadvantages and .. Note also that the question has two elements to the focus: dangers and
advantages. Note how the explanation gives you synonyms for these words.
4 . Answer: H. Be careful when you are reading the essay title. It is easy to miss the word not here. The focus has one element
and note the synonym for disadvantage.
5. Answer: F. Note the focus has two elements: problems and opinion.
6. Answer: L. You are being asked a question here, which requires you to give a Yes/No answer: your opinion.
7. Answer: B. There are two elements to the focus here: dangers and your opinion. Note the synonym for dangers.
8. Answer: M. Note the question two elements in the focus: opinion and reservations.
9. Answer: J. There are three elements to the focus: arguments for, against and opinion.
10. Answer: C. You are being asked a question which requires you to answer yes or no, hence your opinion. The word should
here also indicates that your opinion is required. Note how the two questions mirror both sides of the issue as presented in
the general subject. When you give your opinion it is possible to give your views 100% on one side; 60% on one side, 40%
on the other; and so on. There are different ways of asking you for your opinion as we have seen here: What is your
opinion? Where do you stand? Do you feel ? Should ? Or should ? To what extent do you agree? How far do you agree?
They are basically all the same, but the last two just point out to you that there is a range of opinion i.e. you can give your
opinion 100%, 60%/40% and so on. The question is helping you! Note also the exam cannot always ask:. What is your
opinion!
Exercise 24
Version B is obviously the better of the two. Version A is too short; it contains only 167 words. Version B contains 299 words.
The text in bold is the text which has been omitted in Version A.
1. In many countries, a charge is levied for entrance to museums and art galleries, but, in some instances, entrance is free.
2. Where a charge is, in fact, levied, the argument is that the up-keep of such institutions is not cheap and while the
tax- payer mi ght be expected to provide some funds, it is only fair that some contribution should come by way of an
entrance fee or, at least, a voluntary contribution. An exception is usually made for certain categories of people, like the
unempl oyed, the elderl y, the disabled, school chil dren and students, on the grounds of fi nanci al hardship.
3. P ersonall y, however, I beli eve that, if people are made to pay to visit museums and art galleries, then this is effectively a
tax on education. People should be encouraged to visit such institutions, as they contain a weal th of materi al rel ating not
only to the history and culture of their own countries, but also of other civi li sati ons. They can, of course, obtain
i nformati on from books fi lms etc, but this is nothi ng to seeing the real objects.
4. Moreover, children who have visited a museum or a gallery with their school may not be able to go again with their parents,
if there is an entrance fee. So a fee, in my opinion, would act as a deterrent to people wanting to visit a museum.
5. Often people want to spend maybe only half an hour in a museum rather than spending a long time to justify paying a fee.
Thi s would deter many people, myself included, from vi si ti ng museums. Having said this, however, I am not
against voluntary charges or people being encouraged to make donati ons.
6. So, all in all, my personal view is that people should not have pay to visit museums and art galleries.
P aragraph 2. You can see that Version A has 3 extra pieces of text: the first two phrases frame the argument in a much better way
and the third piece of text gives examples.
210
A book for IELTS
Key to Section on Writing
P aragraph 3. There are two extra pieces of text here. The first one clearly highlights that this is the writers opinion. The second text
provides further evidence for the writers opinion/ argument.
P aragraph 4 . The additional text provides further evidence and highlights the writers opinon.
P aragraph 5. Again, the additional text provides further evidence.
If you go back and read Version A again, you will now see that it is superficial and lacks evidence.
Moreover it does not frame the writers opinions well.
Section on Wri ti ng - Wri t i ng Tests
TEST 1
Writing Task 1
Model answer: 163 words
It is estimated that UK yearly private car sales will increase over the period covered by the chart, rising in two stages to
reach a high of almost three and a half million by the year 2014, from a starting point of 1.5 million in 2003. The sale of
company cars, by contrast, will barely change over the period, climbing from just under 250,000 cars in 2003 to just under
500,000 in the year 2014. The only year where sales are expected to exceed the 500,000 mark is 2010.
As regards motorcycle sales in the UK, the predicted trend is steadily upwards with yearly sales rising from just over 150,000 in
2003 to approximately 400,000 units in 2014. Between 2003 and 2005 the increase in sales is expected to be fairly steep,
followed by a moderate rise over the next five years. Then, after 2011 sales are set to accelerate at much the same pace
thefirst two years of the period.
Writing Task 2
Model answer: 319 words
The use of prisons as a means to combat crime has always been a matter of debate and is becoming more so as prison
populations increase, and crimes become more violent.
Some people believe that prisons are merely a breeding ground for criminals, and are, therefore, not doing the job they are
supposed to do. They point to the incidence of re-offending among former prison in-mates and the rise in the seriousness of
crimes committed by re-offenders as evidence for their case. They maintain that young people enter prison for minor
offences and come out equipped with the skills to commit more serious crimes. For this group the prison process is
not working.
Others are of the opinion that prisons are not harsh enough. They argue that prisoners lead a life of luxury inside at the
expense of the taxpayer, quoting estimates of the high cost of keeping people inside compared with staying in luxury hotels.
Another argument put forward is that, for many criminals, prisons are a soft option, as they are often released after serving
only a small portion of their sentence to ease the over-crowding in jails. Prisons are, therefore, not seen as a deterrent.
I am personally inclined to agree with the latter viewpoint. I feel that, to make penal institutions more effective, the regime
needs to be much harsher than at present, with no sentence remission. It is unrealistic to think that this would be a panacea
for all the ills of prisons. However, at the same time, this increased harshness should be coupled with an attack on the
causes behind crime. Poverty is often quoted as a factor behind criminal activity as is a lack of education, but there are rich
criminals as well as well-educated ones. By generally improving the standard of living and the quality of life for everyone,
and at the same time making prisons very harsh regimes, such institutions will become effective.
TEST 2
Writing Task 1
Model answer: 198 words
The charts show the answers to two questions as part of a public survey on mobile phones. The first bar chart reveals that
the disapproval rating for mobile phones is higher among females than males by quite a large margin, 70 per cent for the
former as against 45 for males. Compared to the public as a whole, women object more to mobile phones. As far as the
'Yes responses are concerned, men outstrip women by more than 50 per cent. The difference is smaller when it comes to
the 'Dont know replies, but with males again being higher in this category.
In answer to the second question in the survey, a large percentage of both men and women feel that mobile phones could
damage the health of their children, roughly 45% and 55% respectively. /4s in answer to the first question, womens attitude
to mobile phones is more negative than the general public in the All category. For both men and women, the No replies
make up just under 30% in answer to this question with men exceeding women. /4s for the Dont know responses, for
women it is approximately 20%, while for men the figure is higher, at about 27%.
A book for IELTS
211
Key to Section on Writing
Writing Task 2
Modal answer: 319 words
Mercy killing is a highly contentious issue, giving rise to strong emotions on both sides of the debate.
Some people believe that ending the suffering of fellow human beings is an act of mercy and as such should be enshrined in
law. Admittedly, there are instances where people are experiencing appalling suffering and the only way out seems to be to
end that suffering. However, are we as human beings able to decide when the life of another person should be ended?
Surely not! That would be presumptuous in the extreme. And who is to guarantee that people will not be murdered in the
name of euthanasia so that someone can have access to their personal wealth.
Whilst I am prepared to admit that the arguments put forward by advocates of euthanasia are forceful, I personally feel that
it is totally unacceptable to take another persons life. Doctors are bound by oath to preserve the life of their fellow human
beings and as such should not be forced into a situation where they are legally bound to terminate a life.
And what about the possibility of a mistake being made and the wrong person being killed? The advocates of euthanasia
will no doubt say that there will be safeguards to guarantee that this will not happen. But there is a whole catalogue of
human error that flies in the face of this argument: babies have been switched, people given the wrong doses of medicine,
wrong limbs removed. The list is endless. There is also the possibility that a cure could become available just as, or just
after, a person has been killed.
Once we have embarked upon the slippery slope of euthanasia, who knows where it might lead. There are some things in
life that are best left well alone and, in my opinion, this is one of them. Once we start who knows where it might lead to.
TEST 3
Writing Task 1
Model Answer: 164 words
As can be seen from the maps, the area of Laguna Beach witnessed considerable change over the 40-year
period from 1950 to 1990.
In 1950, there were only a few beach huts at the back of the beach between the sand dunes and the woodland, but, by
1970, these had been replaced by villas. By 1990, the villas themselves, in turn, had given way to a hotel with an adjacent
swimming-pool. The dunes, which occupied the area on the western side of the beach, remained until 1970. Then between
1970 and 1990, they were replaced with landscaped gardens.
To the east of the beach, the track which originally led to the beach huts became a main road. The woodland, which in 1950
covered the area south of the track, had been cleared by 1970 to make way for a caravan park. This, in turn, had been
converted into a carpark by 1990, and, in addition, a surfing school appeared on the beach itself.
Wri ting Task 2
Model answer: 345 words
Stress and stress-related illnesses seem to be an unavoidable consequence of the life most of us now lead. There are,
of course, many forces at play here.
The main contributing factor is the growing complexity of the modern world, which is compounded by the undoubted speed of
change that pervades all aspects of our lives. Not very long ago people were guaranteed a job for life, but this is now no
longer the case. In fact, people may be obliged to change career more than once in their life-times. The root cause here is
the pace at which technology is developing. Furthermore, the use of computers now means that we have to work faster and
are at the same time expected to be more accurate. The speed of development also means that we are constantly living in a
state of change, having to update more and more frequently.
Another cause is population growth, which puts more pressure on our immediate environment. For example, the roads and
public transport are becoming more crowded and there are ever longer queues for hospitals and other services. As
resources become more scarce, they also become more expensive, which adds to the pressure. The easy availability of
goods puts enormous pressure on everyone, but especially families with children. Of course, the media only serves to
compound the problem with the constant barrage of advertising directed at the public.
Although there are many factors behind the stress in our lives, and they are continuing to grow, there are several courses of
action open to everyone. The most important of these is education. Health services could, for example, embark upon a
massive stress-awareness campaign to make individuals and families aware of some of the contributing factors. This would
increase peoples threshold of coping with and managing stress. Employers could also be involved by running relaxation
classes and making work less stressful for their employees, and themselves.
The problem is there and is growing, but solutions are available and as in all previous situations, human beings have the
capacity to adapt and survive.
212
A book for IELTS
A book for IELTS
213
Key to Speaking Section
Exerci se 1
Topic Card A
e, c, g, d, f, a, b
Topic Card B
wood/river/l reland
child/family visit
beautiful/stunning
keep secret/special friends
magical, peaceful,
Topic Card C
teacher
secondary school
patient/caring/good teacher
learnt a lot/strong/knowledgeable
Topic Card D
noise
always annoying
stops concentration
use earplugs/get angry
irritating/selfishness of those making noise
Topic Card E
was 21
Sierra Leone/ West Africa
by myself
so different/countryside/people/ food/pace of life
met good friends.
Topic Card F
day left secondary school
became adult
parents took me out
shopping/dinner
hope so-first big job etc
Topic Card G
vegetable curry/rice
twice a week
vegetables, spices etc
make it myself/restaurant
reminds me of home
Exercise 2
1. G. 2. C 3. F 4. D 5. E 6. A 7. I 8. H 9. B
Exerci se 3
A. 6 B. 7 C. 10 D. 8 E. 3 F. 9
G. 5 H. 2 1.1 J . 4
You can see that the oral exam is unpredictable. As was mentioned in the Introduction to the Speaking Section, students
often prepare for the exam by learning mini-speeches by heart. Then, when they are asked a question which they are
not prepared for, they cannot handle the situation.
So to prepare for the Oral, it is better just to speak with friends or in class.
Exercise 4
A. v
H. i
B. v C. i
J . i
D. v
K. vi
E. i
L. iii
F. i
M. vii
G. ii
214
A book for IELTS
Key to Speaking Section
Exercise 5: Put meaning into your future
1. (a), (c), and (d) 2. (a) and (b) 3. (a), (c), and (d) 4. (a), (c), and (d) 5. All the alternatives are correct.
6. (a) and (c) 7. (a) and (c) 8. (a), (b) and (c) 9. (a) and (c) 10. (b) and (d) 11. (a) 12. (d) 13. (b), (c) and (d)
14. (a), (b) and (d)
Appendix: Seeing the future
Example 1. I am having a party
Now
__________ I t I ___________________
The tense is the Present Continuous. Why? Because (i) the writer/speaker has made an arrangement before Now; (ii)
the arrangement is true at the time of writing/speaking; and (iii) the event will take place at a fixed time in the future (near
or distant)
Example 2 Ill have finished university by
Now----------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1
__________ * i
The tense is the Future Perfect Simple. This is a combination of the Simple Future and the Present Perfect and therefore
combines the two elements of these two tenses. You can use the tense to show that something will have happened
before a particular point of time in the future.
Example 3 Ill be studying at university.
Now --------------------------------- 1
_______ * _____ F 1 i_________
The tense is the Future Continuous. Like II above this is a combined tense. It combines the future and the idea of
continuous action. You use it for an activity which will be in progress around a certain point of time in the future.
Example 4 First, I spend a year working in an English speaking country;
Now ___________________j
_____* _____J 7n___________
Now
then, I go back home.
J _____r r i
This is the Present Simple. It is used when you want to show that the events in the future are fixed like part of a time-table.
Example 5 Now Imgoing to start working once I finish university.
m 1______
The going to Future. You use this future when you want to show that you intend to do something which is based on
present information. For example, your nose may be ticklish and you feel you are going to sneeze. You might say: Im
going to sneeze. In the end, however, you may not sneeze. You could not say here: Imsneezing.
Example 6 Ill become a doctor!
Now ___________
______ t 1____________
This is the Simple Future. You use this tense to show that you are making a simple prediction. When you use the Simple
Future, you show that you are not planning your action. Your decision is spontaneous.
A book for IELTS
215
Key to Speaking Section
Another example is the following exchange:
A: Ive got a headache.
B: Oh, Ill get you an aspirin.
B does not really have time to think when making the response. It is spontaneous.
There are of course other ways of expressing the Future in English, but these are the most common forms that you are
likely to use as you are speaking in the final section of the oral exam.
Other forms you may want to look up: Its likely that
Its probable that
Ill probably be
I may
I might
I might just
I may well
Theres a chance I will/ might
If all goes well,
216
A book for IELTS

You might also like